* gdb.texinfo (C and C++): Add Decimal Floating Point format
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
66 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
67 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
88 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
89 @sp 2
90 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
91 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
92 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
93 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
94
95 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
96 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
97 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
98 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
99 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
100 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
101
102 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
103 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
104 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
105 @page
106 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
107 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
108 software in general. We will miss him.
109 @end titlepage
110 @page
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
120 @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Stack:: Examining the stack
137 * Source:: Examining source files
138 * Data:: Examining data
139 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146 * Altering:: Altering execution
147 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
153 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158
159 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
160
161 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
162 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
163 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
164 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
165 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
166 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
167 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
168 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
169 @value{GDBN}
170 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
171 how you can copy and share GDB
172 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
173 * Index:: Index
174 @end menu
175
176 @end ifnottex
177
178 @contents
179
180 @node Summary
181 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
182
183 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
184 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
185 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
186
187 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
188 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
189
190 @itemize @bullet
191 @item
192 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
193
194 @item
195 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
196
197 @item
198 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
199
200 @item
201 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
202 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
203 @end itemize
204
205 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
206 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
207 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
208
209 @cindex Modula-2
210 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
211 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
212
213 @cindex Pascal
214 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
215 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
216 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
217 syntax.
218
219 @cindex Fortran
220 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
221 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
222 underscore.
223
224 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
225 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
226
227 @menu
228 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
229 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
230 @end menu
231
232 @node Free Software
233 @unnumberedsec Free Software
234
235 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
236 General Public License
237 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
238 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
239 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
240 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
241 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
242 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
243
244 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
245 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
246 from anyone else.
247
248 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
249
250 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
251 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
252 include with the free software. Many of our most important
253 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
254 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
255 when an important free software package does not come with a free
256 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
257 gaps today.
258
259 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
260 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
261 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
262 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
263 them from the free software world.
264
265 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
266 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
267 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
268 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
269 contract to make it non-free.
270
271 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
272 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
273 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
274 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
275 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
276 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
277 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
278
279 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
280 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
281 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
282 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
283
284 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
285 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
286 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
287 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
288 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
289 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
290 community.
291
292 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
293 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
294 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
295 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
296 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
297 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
298 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
299 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
300 of the manual.
301
302 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
303 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
304 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
305 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
306 manual to replace it.
307
308 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
309 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
310 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
311 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
312 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
313 the free software community.
314
315 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
316 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
317 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
318 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
319 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
320 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
321 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
322 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
323 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
324
325 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
326 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
327 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
328 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
329 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
330 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
331 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
332 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
333
334 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
335 published by other publishers, at
336 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
337
338 @node Contributors
339 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
340
341 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
342 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
343 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
344 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
345 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
346 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
347 blow-by-blow account.
348
349 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
350
351 @quotation
352 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
353 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
354 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
355 @end quotation
356
357 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
358 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
359 releases:
360 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
361 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
362 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
363 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
364 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
365 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
366 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
367 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
368 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
369
370 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
371 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
372
373 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
374 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
375 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
376 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
377 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
378
379 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
380 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
381 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
382
383 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
384 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
385
386 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
387
388 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
389 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
390 support.
391 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
392 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
393 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
394 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
395 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
396 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
397 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
398 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
399 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
400 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
401 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
402 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
403 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
404 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
405 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
406 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
407
408 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
409
410 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
411 libraries.
412
413 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
414 about several machine instruction sets.
415
416 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
417 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
418 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
419 and RDI targets, respectively.
420
421 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
422 command-line editing and command history.
423
424 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
425 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
426
427 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
428 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
429 symbols.
430
431 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
432 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
433
434 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
435
436 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
437 processors.
438
439 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
440
441 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
442
443 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
444
445 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
446 watchpoints.
447
448 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
449
450 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
451
452 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
453 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
454
455 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
456 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
457 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
458 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
459 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
460 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
461 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
462
463 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
464 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
465
466 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
467 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
468 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
469 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
470 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
471 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
472 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
473 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
474 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
475 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
476 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
477 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
478 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
479 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
480 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
481
482 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
483 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
484
485 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
486 Hat.
487
488 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
489 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
490 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
491 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
492 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
493 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
494
495 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
496 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
497 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
498 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
499 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
500 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
501 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
502 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
503 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
504 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
505 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
506 Weigand.
507
508 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
509 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
510 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
511 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
512
513 @node Sample Session
514 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
515
516 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
517 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
518 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
519
520 @iftex
521 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
522 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
523 @end iftex
524
525 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
526 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
527
528 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
529 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
530 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
531 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
532 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
533 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
534 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
535 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
536 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
537
538 @smallexample
539 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
540 $ @b{./m4}
541 @b{define(foo,0000)}
542
543 @b{foo}
544 0000
545 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
546
547 @b{bar}
548 0000
549 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
550
551 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
552 @b{baz}
553 @b{Ctrl-d}
554 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
555 @end smallexample
556
557 @noindent
558 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
559
560 @smallexample
561 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
562 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
563 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
564 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
565 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
566 the conditions.
567 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
568 for details.
569
570 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
571 (@value{GDBP})
572 @end smallexample
573
574 @noindent
575 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
576 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
577 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
578 that examples fit in this manual.
579
580 @smallexample
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
586 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
587 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
588 @code{break} command.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
592 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
593 @end smallexample
594
595 @noindent
596 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
597 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
598 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
602 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
603 @b{define(foo,0000)}
604
605 @b{foo}
606 0000
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
611 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
612 context where it stops.
613
614 @smallexample
615 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
616
617 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
618 at builtin.c:879
619 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
620 @end smallexample
621
622 @noindent
623 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
624 the next line of the current function.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
628 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
629 : nil,
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
634 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
635 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
636 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
637
638 @smallexample
639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
640 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
641 at input.c:530
642 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
647 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
648 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
649 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
650 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
651 stack frame for each active subroutine.
652
653 @smallexample
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
655 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
656 at input.c:530
657 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
658 at builtin.c:882
659 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
660 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
661 at macro.c:71
662 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
663 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
664 @end smallexample
665
666 @noindent
667 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
668 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
669 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
670
671 @smallexample
672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
673 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
675 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
676 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
678 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
679 : xstrdup(rq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
686 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
687 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
688 (@code{print}) to see their values.
689
690 @smallexample
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
692 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
694 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
699 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
700 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
704 533 xfree(rquote);
705 534
706 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
707 : xstrdup (lq);
708 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
709 : xstrdup (rq);
710 537
711 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
712 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
713 540 @}
714 541
715 542 void
716 @end smallexample
717
718 @noindent
719 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
720 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
721
722 @smallexample
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
724 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
726 540 @}
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
728 $3 = 9
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
730 $4 = 7
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
735 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
736 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
737 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
738 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
739 assignments.
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
743 $5 = 7
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
745 $6 = 9
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
750 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
751 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
752 example that caused trouble initially:
753
754 @smallexample
755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
756 Continuing.
757
758 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
759
760 baz
761 0000
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
766 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
767 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
768
769 @smallexample
770 @b{Ctrl-d}
771 Program exited normally.
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
776 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
777 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
778
779 @smallexample
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
781 @end smallexample
782
783 @node Invocation
784 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
785
786 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
787 The essentials are:
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
791 @item
792 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
793 @end itemize
794
795 @menu
796 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
797 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
798 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
799 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
800 @end menu
801
802 @node Invoking GDB
803 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
804
805 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
806 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
807
808 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
809 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
810
811 The command-line options described here are designed
812 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
813 options may effectively be unavailable.
814
815 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
816 specifying an executable program:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
820 @end smallexample
821
822 @noindent
823 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
824 specified:
825
826 @smallexample
827 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
831 to debug a running process:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
835 @end smallexample
836
837 @noindent
838 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
839 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
840
841 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
842 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
843 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
844 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
845 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
846
847 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
848 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
849 option processing.
850 @smallexample
851 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
852 @end smallexample
853 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
854 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
855
856 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
857 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} -silent
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
865 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
866
867 @noindent
868 Type
869
870 @smallexample
871 @value{GDBP} -help
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
876 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
877
878 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
879 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
880 @samp{-x} option is used.
881
882
883 @menu
884 * File Options:: Choosing files
885 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
886 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
887 @end menu
888
889 @node File Options
890 @subsection Choosing Files
891
892 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
893 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
894 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
895 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
896 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
897 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
898 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
899 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
900 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
901 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
902 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
903 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
904 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
905
906 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
907 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
908 argument and ignore it.
909
910 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
911 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
912 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
913 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
914 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
915
916 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
917 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
918 @c it.
919
920 @table @code
921 @item -symbols @var{file}
922 @itemx -s @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--symbols}
924 @cindex @code{-s}
925 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
926
927 @item -exec @var{file}
928 @itemx -e @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--exec}
930 @cindex @code{-e}
931 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
932 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
933
934 @item -se @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--se}
936 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
937 file.
938
939 @item -core @var{file}
940 @itemx -c @var{file}
941 @cindex @code{--core}
942 @cindex @code{-c}
943 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
944
945 @item -pid @var{number}
946 @itemx -p @var{number}
947 @cindex @code{--pid}
948 @cindex @code{-p}
949 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
950
951 @item -command @var{file}
952 @itemx -x @var{file}
953 @cindex @code{--command}
954 @cindex @code{-x}
955 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
956 Files,, Command files}.
957
958 @item -eval-command @var{command}
959 @itemx -ex @var{command}
960 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
961 @cindex @code{-ex}
962 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
963
964 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
965 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
966
967 @smallexample
968 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
969 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
970 @end smallexample
971
972 @item -directory @var{directory}
973 @itemx -d @var{directory}
974 @cindex @code{--directory}
975 @cindex @code{-d}
976 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
977
978 @item -r
979 @itemx -readnow
980 @cindex @code{--readnow}
981 @cindex @code{-r}
982 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
983 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
984 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
985
986 @end table
987
988 @node Mode Options
989 @subsection Choosing Modes
990
991 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
992 batch mode or quiet mode.
993
994 @table @code
995 @item -nx
996 @itemx -n
997 @cindex @code{--nx}
998 @cindex @code{-n}
999 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1000 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1001 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1002 Files}.
1003
1004 @item -quiet
1005 @itemx -silent
1006 @itemx -q
1007 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1008 @cindex @code{--silent}
1009 @cindex @code{-q}
1010 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1011 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1012
1013 @item -batch
1014 @cindex @code{--batch}
1015 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1016 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1017 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1018 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1019 in the command files.
1020
1021 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1022 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1023 make this more useful, the message
1024
1025 @smallexample
1026 Program exited normally.
1027 @end smallexample
1028
1029 @noindent
1030 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1031 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1032 mode.
1033
1034 @item -batch-silent
1035 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1036 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1037 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1038 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1039 for an interactive session.
1040
1041 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1042 messages, for example.
1043
1044 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1045 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1046
1047 @item -return-child-result
1048 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1049 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1050 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1051
1052 @itemize @bullet
1053 @item
1054 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1055 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1056 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1057 @item
1058 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1059 @item
1060 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1061 the exit code will be -1.
1062 @end itemize
1063
1064 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1065 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1066 interface.
1067
1068 @item -nowindows
1069 @itemx -nw
1070 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1071 @cindex @code{-nw}
1072 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1073 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1074 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1075
1076 @item -windows
1077 @itemx -w
1078 @cindex @code{--windows}
1079 @cindex @code{-w}
1080 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1081 used if possible.
1082
1083 @item -cd @var{directory}
1084 @cindex @code{--cd}
1085 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1086 instead of the current directory.
1087
1088 @item -fullname
1089 @itemx -f
1090 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1091 @cindex @code{-f}
1092 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1093 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1094 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1095 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1096 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1097 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1098 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1099 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1100 frame.
1101
1102 @item -epoch
1103 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1104 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1105 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1106 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1107 separate window.
1108
1109 @item -annotate @var{level}
1110 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1111 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1112 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1113 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1114 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1115 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1116 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1117 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1118 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1119
1120 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1121 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1122
1123 @item --args
1124 @cindex @code{--args}
1125 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1126 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1127 This option stops option processing.
1128
1129 @item -baud @var{bps}
1130 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1131 @cindex @code{--baud}
1132 @cindex @code{-b}
1133 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1134 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1135
1136 @item -l @var{timeout}
1137 @cindex @code{-l}
1138 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1139 for remote debugging.
1140
1141 @item -tty @var{device}
1142 @itemx -t @var{device}
1143 @cindex @code{--tty}
1144 @cindex @code{-t}
1145 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1146 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1147
1148 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1149 @item -tui
1150 @cindex @code{--tui}
1151 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1152 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1153 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1154 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1155 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1156 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1157 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1158
1159 @c @item -xdb
1160 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1161 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1162 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1163 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1164 @c systems.
1165
1166 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1167 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1168 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1169 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1170 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1171 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1172
1173 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1174 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1175 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1176 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1177 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1178 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1179
1180 @item -write
1181 @cindex @code{--write}
1182 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1183 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1184 (@pxref{Patching}).
1185
1186 @item -statistics
1187 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1188 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1189 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1190
1191 @item -version
1192 @cindex @code{--version}
1193 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1194 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1195
1196 @end table
1197
1198 @node Startup
1199 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1200 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1201
1202 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1203
1204 @enumerate
1205 @item
1206 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1207 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1208
1209 @item
1210 @cindex init file
1211 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1212 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1213 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1214 that file.
1215
1216 @item
1217 Processes command line options and operands.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1221 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1222 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1223 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1224 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1225 @value{GDBN}.
1226
1227 @item
1228 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1229 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1230
1231 @item
1232 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1233 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1234 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1235 @end enumerate
1236
1237 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1238 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1239 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1240 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1241 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1242 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1243
1244 @cindex init file name
1245 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1246 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1247 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1248 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1249 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1250 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1251 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1252 the file to the standard name.
1253
1254
1255 @node Quitting GDB
1256 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1257 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1258 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1259
1260 @table @code
1261 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1262 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1263 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1264 @itemx q
1265 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1266 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1267 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1268 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1269 error code.
1270 @end table
1271
1272 @cindex interrupt
1273 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1274 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1275 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1276 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1277 until a time when it is safe.
1278
1279 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1280 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1281 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1282
1283 @node Shell Commands
1284 @section Shell Commands
1285
1286 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1287 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1288 just use the @code{shell} command.
1289
1290 @table @code
1291 @kindex shell
1292 @cindex shell escape
1293 @item shell @var{command string}
1294 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1295 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1296 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1297 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1298 @end table
1299
1300 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1301 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1302 @value{GDBN}:
1303
1304 @table @code
1305 @kindex make
1306 @cindex calling make
1307 @item make @var{make-args}
1308 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1309 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1310 @end table
1311
1312 @node Logging Output
1313 @section Logging Output
1314 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1315 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1316
1317 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1318 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1319
1320 @table @code
1321 @kindex set logging
1322 @item set logging on
1323 Enable logging.
1324 @item set logging off
1325 Disable logging.
1326 @cindex logging file name
1327 @item set logging file @var{file}
1328 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1329 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1330 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1331 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1332 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1333 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1334 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1335 @kindex show logging
1336 @item show logging
1337 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1338 @end table
1339
1340 @node Commands
1341 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1342
1343 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1344 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1345 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1346 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1347 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1348
1349 @menu
1350 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1351 * Completion:: Command completion
1352 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1353 @end menu
1354
1355 @node Command Syntax
1356 @section Command Syntax
1357
1358 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1359 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1360 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1361 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1362 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1363 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1364
1365 @cindex abbreviation
1366 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1367 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1368 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1369 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1370 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1371 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1372 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1373
1374 @cindex repeating commands
1375 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1376 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1377 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1378 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1379 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1380 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1381 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1382
1383 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1384 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1385 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1386
1387 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1388 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1389 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1390 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1391 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1392
1393 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1394 @cindex comment
1395 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1396 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1397 Files,,Command Files}).
1398
1399 @cindex repeating command sequences
1400 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1401 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1402 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1403 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1404 for editing.
1405
1406 @node Completion
1407 @section Command Completion
1408
1409 @cindex completion
1410 @cindex word completion
1411 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1412 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1413 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1414 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1415
1416 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1417 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1418 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1419 enter it). For example, if you type
1420
1421 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1422 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1423 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1424 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1425 @smallexample
1426 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1427 @end smallexample
1428
1429 @noindent
1430 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1431 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1432
1433 @smallexample
1434 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1435 @end smallexample
1436
1437 @noindent
1438 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1439 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1440 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1441 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1442 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1443 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1444
1445 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1446 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1447 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1448 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1449 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1450 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1451 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1452 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1453 example:
1454
1455 @smallexample
1456 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1457 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1458 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1459 make_abs_section make_function_type
1460 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1461 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1462 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1463 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1464 @end smallexample
1465
1466 @noindent
1467 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1468 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1469 command.
1470
1471 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1472 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1473 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1474 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1475 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1476
1477 @cindex quotes in commands
1478 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1479 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1480 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1481 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1482 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1483 @value{GDBN} commands.
1484
1485 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1486 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1487 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1488 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1489 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1490 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1491 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1492 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1493 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1494 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1495 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1496
1497 @smallexample
1498 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1499 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1500 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1501 @end smallexample
1502
1503 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1504 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1505 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1506 place:
1507
1508 @smallexample
1509 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1510 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1511 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1512 @end smallexample
1513
1514 @noindent
1515 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1516 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1517 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1518
1519 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1520 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1521 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1522 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1523
1524
1525 @node Help
1526 @section Getting Help
1527 @cindex online documentation
1528 @kindex help
1529
1530 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1531 using the command @code{help}.
1532
1533 @table @code
1534 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1535 @item help
1536 @itemx h
1537 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1538 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1539
1540 @smallexample
1541 (@value{GDBP}) help
1542 List of classes of commands:
1543
1544 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1545 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1546 data -- Examining data
1547 files -- Specifying and examining files
1548 internals -- Maintenance commands
1549 obscure -- Obscure features
1550 running -- Running the program
1551 stack -- Examining the stack
1552 status -- Status inquiries
1553 support -- Support facilities
1554 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1555 stopping the program
1556 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1557
1558 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1559 commands in that class.
1560 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1561 documentation.
1562 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1563 (@value{GDBP})
1564 @end smallexample
1565 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1566
1567 @item help @var{class}
1568 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1569 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1570 help display for the class @code{status}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1574 Status inquiries.
1575
1576 List of commands:
1577
1578 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1579 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1580 info -- Generic command for showing things
1581 about the program being debugged
1582 show -- Generic command for showing things
1583 about the debugger
1584
1585 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1586 documentation.
1587 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1588 (@value{GDBP})
1589 @end smallexample
1590
1591 @item help @var{command}
1592 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1593 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1594
1595 @kindex apropos
1596 @item apropos @var{args}
1597 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1598 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1599 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1600
1601 @smallexample
1602 apropos reload
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 results in:
1607
1608 @smallexample
1609 @c @group
1610 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1611 multiple times in one run
1612 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1613 multiple times in one run
1614 @c @end group
1615 @end smallexample
1616
1617 @kindex complete
1618 @item complete @var{args}
1619 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1620 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1621 command you want completed. For example:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 complete i
1625 @end smallexample
1626
1627 @noindent results in:
1628
1629 @smallexample
1630 @group
1631 if
1632 ignore
1633 info
1634 inspect
1635 @end group
1636 @end smallexample
1637
1638 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1639 @end table
1640
1641 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1642 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1643 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1644 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1645 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1646 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1647
1648 @c @group
1649 @table @code
1650 @kindex info
1651 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1652 @item info
1653 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1654 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1655 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1656 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1657 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1658 @w{@code{help info}}.
1659
1660 @kindex set
1661 @item set
1662 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1663 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1664 @code{set prompt $}.
1665
1666 @kindex show
1667 @item show
1668 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1669 @value{GDBN} itself.
1670 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1671 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1672 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1673 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1674
1675 @kindex info set
1676 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1677 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1678 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1679 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1680 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1681 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1682 @end table
1683 @c @end group
1684
1685 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1686 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1687
1688 @table @code
1689 @kindex show version
1690 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1691 @item show version
1692 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1693 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1694 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1695 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1696 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1697 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1698 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1699 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1700 @value{GDBN}.
1701
1702 @kindex show copying
1703 @kindex info copying
1704 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1705 @item show copying
1706 @itemx info copying
1707 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1708
1709 @kindex show warranty
1710 @kindex info warranty
1711 @item show warranty
1712 @itemx info warranty
1713 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1714 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1715
1716 @end table
1717
1718 @node Running
1719 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1720
1721 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1722 debugging information when you compile it.
1723
1724 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1725 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1726 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1727 kill a child process.
1728
1729 @menu
1730 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1731 * Starting:: Starting your program
1732 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1733 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1734
1735 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1736 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1737 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1738 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1739
1740 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1741 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1742 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1743 @end menu
1744
1745 @node Compilation
1746 @section Compiling for Debugging
1747
1748 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1749 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1750 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1751 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1752 and addresses in the executable code.
1753
1754 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1755 the compiler.
1756
1757 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1758 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1759 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1760 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1761 executables containing debugging information.
1762
1763 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1764 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1765 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1766 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1767 in pushing your luck.
1768
1769 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1770 @cindex debugging optimized code
1771 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1772 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1773 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1774 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1775 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1776 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1777
1778 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1779 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1780 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1781 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1782 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1783
1784 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1785 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1786 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1787
1788 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1789 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1790 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1791 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1792 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1793 provides macro information if you specify the options
1794 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1795 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1796 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1797 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1798 @option{-g} alone.
1799
1800 @need 2000
1801 @node Starting
1802 @section Starting your Program
1803 @cindex starting
1804 @cindex running
1805
1806 @table @code
1807 @kindex run
1808 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1809 @item run
1810 @itemx r
1811 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1812 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1813 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1814 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1815 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1816
1817 @end table
1818
1819 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1820 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1821 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1822 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1823
1824 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1825 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1826 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1827 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1828 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1829 divided into four categories:
1830
1831 @table @asis
1832 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1833 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1834 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1835 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1836 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1837 the arguments.
1838 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1839 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1840 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1841
1842 @item The @emph{environment.}
1843 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1844 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1845 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1846 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1847
1848 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1849 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1850 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1851 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1852
1853 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1854 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1855 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1856 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1857 set a different device for your program.
1858 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1859
1860 @cindex pipes
1861 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1862 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1863 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1864 wrong program.
1865 @end table
1866
1867 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1868 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1869 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1870 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1871 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1872
1873 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1874 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1875 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1876 your current breakpoints.
1877
1878 @table @code
1879 @kindex start
1880 @item start
1881 @cindex run to main procedure
1882 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1883 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1884 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1885 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1886 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1887 procedure, depending on the language used.
1888
1889 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1890 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1891 the @samp{run} command.
1892
1893 @cindex elaboration phase
1894 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1895 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1896 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1897 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1898 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1899 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1900 will remain to halt execution.
1901
1902 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1903 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1904 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1905 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1906 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1907
1908 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1909 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1910 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1911 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1912 elaboration code before running your program.
1913 @end table
1914
1915 @node Arguments
1916 @section Your Program's Arguments
1917
1918 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1919 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1920 @code{run} command.
1921 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1922 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1923 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1924 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1925 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1926
1927 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1928 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1929 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1930 the program, not by the shell.
1931
1932 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1933 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1934
1935 @table @code
1936 @kindex set args
1937 @item set args
1938 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1939 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1940 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1941 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1942 it again without arguments.
1943
1944 @kindex show args
1945 @item show args
1946 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1947 @end table
1948
1949 @node Environment
1950 @section Your Program's Environment
1951
1952 @cindex environment (of your program)
1953 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1954 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1955 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1956 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1957 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1958 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1959 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1960
1961 @table @code
1962 @kindex path
1963 @item path @var{directory}
1964 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1965 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1966 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1967 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1968 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1969 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1970 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1971
1972 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1973 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1974 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1975 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1976 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1977 @var{directory} to the search path.
1978 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1979 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1980
1981 @kindex show paths
1982 @item show paths
1983 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1984 environment variable).
1985
1986 @kindex show environment
1987 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1988 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1989 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1990 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1991 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1992
1993 @kindex set environment
1994 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1995 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1996 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1997 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1998 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1999 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2000 null value.
2001 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2002 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2003
2004 For example, this command:
2005
2006 @smallexample
2007 set env USER = foo
2008 @end smallexample
2009
2010 @noindent
2011 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2012 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2013 are not actually required.)
2014
2015 @kindex unset environment
2016 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2017 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2018 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2019 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2020 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2021 @end table
2022
2023 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2024 the shell indicated
2025 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2026 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2027 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2028 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2029 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2030 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2031 @file{.profile}.
2032
2033 @node Working Directory
2034 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2035
2036 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2037 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2038 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2039 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2040 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2041 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2042
2043 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2044 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2045 Specify Files}.
2046
2047 @table @code
2048 @kindex cd
2049 @cindex change working directory
2050 @item cd @var{directory}
2051 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2052
2053 @kindex pwd
2054 @item pwd
2055 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2056 @end table
2057
2058 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2059 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2060 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2061 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2062 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2063 current working directory of the debuggee.
2064
2065 @node Input/Output
2066 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2067
2068 @cindex redirection
2069 @cindex i/o
2070 @cindex terminal
2071 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2072 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2073 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2074 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2075 running your program.
2076
2077 @table @code
2078 @kindex info terminal
2079 @item info terminal
2080 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2081 program is using.
2082 @end table
2083
2084 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2085 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2086
2087 @smallexample
2088 run > outfile
2089 @end smallexample
2090
2091 @noindent
2092 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2093
2094 @kindex tty
2095 @cindex controlling terminal
2096 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2097 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2098 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2099 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2100 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2101
2102 @smallexample
2103 tty /dev/ttyb
2104 @end smallexample
2105
2106 @noindent
2107 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2108 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2109 that as their controlling terminal.
2110
2111 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2112 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2113 terminal.
2114
2115 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2116 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2117 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2118 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2119
2120 @cindex inferior tty
2121 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2122 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2123 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2124 program.
2125
2126 @table @code
2127 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2128 @kindex set inferior-tty
2129 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2130
2131 @item show inferior-tty
2132 @kindex show inferior-tty
2133 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2134 @end table
2135
2136 @node Attach
2137 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2138 @kindex attach
2139 @cindex attach
2140
2141 @table @code
2142 @item attach @var{process-id}
2143 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2144 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2145 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2146 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2147 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2148
2149 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2150 executing the command.
2151 @end table
2152
2153 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2154 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2155 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2156 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2157
2158 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2159 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2160 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2161 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2162 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2163 Specify Files}.
2164
2165 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2166 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2167 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2168 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2169 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2170 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2171 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2172
2173 @table @code
2174 @kindex detach
2175 @item detach
2176 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2177 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2178 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2179 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2180 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2181 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2182 executing the command.
2183 @end table
2184
2185 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2186 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2187 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2188 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2189 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2190 Messages}).
2191
2192 @node Kill Process
2193 @section Killing the Child Process
2194
2195 @table @code
2196 @kindex kill
2197 @item kill
2198 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2199 @end table
2200
2201 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2202 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2203 is running.
2204
2205 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2206 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2207 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2208 outside the debugger.
2209
2210 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2211 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2212 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2213 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2214 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2215 breakpoint settings).
2216
2217 @node Threads
2218 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2219
2220 @cindex threads of execution
2221 @cindex multiple threads
2222 @cindex switching threads
2223 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2224 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2225 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2226 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2227 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2228 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2229 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2230
2231 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2232 programs:
2233
2234 @itemize @bullet
2235 @item automatic notification of new threads
2236 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2237 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2238 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2239 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2240 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2241 @end itemize
2242
2243 @quotation
2244 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2245 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2246 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2247 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2248 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2249 like this:
2250
2251 @smallexample
2252 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2253 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2254 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2255 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2256 @end smallexample
2257 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2258 @c doesn't support threads"?
2259 @end quotation
2260
2261 @cindex focus of debugging
2262 @cindex current thread
2263 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2264 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2265 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2266 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2267 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2268
2269 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2270 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2271 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2272 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2273 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2274 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2275 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2276 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2277 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2278 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2279
2280 @smallexample
2281 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2282 @end smallexample
2283
2284 @noindent
2285 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2286 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2287 further qualifier.
2288
2289 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2290 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2291 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2292 @c program?
2293 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2294 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2295 @c threads ab initio?
2296
2297 @cindex thread number
2298 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2299 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2300 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2301
2302 @table @code
2303 @kindex info threads
2304 @item info threads
2305 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2306 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2307
2308 @enumerate
2309 @item
2310 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2311
2312 @item
2313 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2314
2315 @item
2316 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2317 @end enumerate
2318
2319 @noindent
2320 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2321 indicates the current thread.
2322
2323 For example,
2324 @end table
2325 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2326
2327 @smallexample
2328 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2329 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2330 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2331 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2332 at threadtest.c:68
2333 @end smallexample
2334
2335 On HP-UX systems:
2336
2337 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2338 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2339 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2340 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2341 thread in your program.
2342
2343 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2344 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2345 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2346 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2347 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2348 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2349 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2350 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2351 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2352 HP-UX, you see
2353
2354 @smallexample
2355 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2356 @end smallexample
2357
2358 @noindent
2359 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2360
2361 @table @code
2362 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2363 @item info threads
2364 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2365 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2366
2367 @enumerate
2368 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2369
2370 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2371
2372 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2373 @end enumerate
2374
2375 @noindent
2376 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2377 indicates the current thread.
2378
2379 For example,
2380 @end table
2381 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2382
2383 @smallexample
2384 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2385 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2386 at quicksort.c:137
2387 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2388 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2389 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2390 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2391 @end smallexample
2392
2393 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2394 Solaris-specific command:
2395
2396 @table @code
2397 @item maint info sol-threads
2398 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2399 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2400 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2401 @end table
2402
2403 @table @code
2404 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2405 @item thread @var{threadno}
2406 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2407 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2408 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2409 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2410 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2411
2412 @smallexample
2413 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2414 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2415 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2416 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2417 @end smallexample
2418
2419 @noindent
2420 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2421 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2422 threads.
2423
2424 @kindex thread apply
2425 @cindex apply command to several threads
2426 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2427 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2428 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2429 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2430 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2431 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2432 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2433 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2434 @end table
2435
2436 @cindex automatic thread selection
2437 @cindex switching threads automatically
2438 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2439 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2440 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2441 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2442 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2443 thread.
2444
2445 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2446 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2447 programs with multiple threads.
2448
2449 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2450 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2451
2452 @node Processes
2453 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2454
2455 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2456 @cindex multiple processes
2457 @cindex processes, multiple
2458 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2459 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2460 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2461 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2462 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2463 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2464 will cause it to terminate.
2465
2466 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2467 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2468 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2469 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2470 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2471 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2472 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2473 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2474 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2475 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2476
2477 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2478 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2479 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2480 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2481
2482 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2483 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2484
2485 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2486 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2487
2488 @table @code
2489 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2490 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2491 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2492 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2493 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2494
2495 @table @code
2496 @item parent
2497 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2498 unimpeded. This is the default.
2499
2500 @item child
2501 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2502 unimpeded.
2503
2504 @end table
2505
2506 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2507 @item show follow-fork-mode
2508 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2512 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2513 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2514
2515 @table @code
2516 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2517 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2518 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2519 retain debugger control over them both.
2520
2521 @table @code
2522 @item on
2523 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2524 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2525 independently. This is the default.
2526
2527 @item off
2528 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2529 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2530 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2531 is held suspended.
2532
2533 @end table
2534
2535 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2536 @item show detach-on-follow
2537 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2538 @end table
2539
2540 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2541 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2542 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2543 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2544 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2545
2546 @table @code
2547 @kindex info forks
2548 @item info forks
2549 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2550 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2551 position (program counter) of the process.
2552
2553
2554 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2555 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2556 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2557 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2558 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2559
2560 @end table
2561
2562 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2563 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2564 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2565 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2566
2567 @table @code
2568 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2569 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2570 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2571 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2572 allowed to run independently.
2573
2574 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2575 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2576 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2577 and remove it from the fork list.
2578
2579 @end table
2580
2581 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2582 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2583 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2584 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2585 the child process's @code{main}.
2586
2587 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2588 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2589
2590 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2591 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2592 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2593 argument.
2594
2595 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2596 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2597 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2598
2599 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2600 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2601
2602 @cindex checkpoint
2603 @cindex restart
2604 @cindex bookmark
2605 @cindex snapshot of a process
2606 @cindex rewind program state
2607
2608 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2609 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2610 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2611 later.
2612
2613 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2614 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2615 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2616 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2617 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2618
2619 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2620 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2621 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2622 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2623 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2624 start again from there.
2625
2626 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2627 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2628
2629 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2630
2631 @table @code
2632 @kindex checkpoint
2633 @item checkpoint
2634 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2635 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2636 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2637
2638 @kindex info checkpoints
2639 @item info checkpoints
2640 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2641 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2642 listed:
2643
2644 @table @code
2645 @item Checkpoint ID
2646 @item Process ID
2647 @item Code Address
2648 @item Source line, or label
2649 @end table
2650
2651 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2652 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2653 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2654 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2655 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2656 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2657 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2658
2659 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2660 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2661 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2662 the debugger.
2663
2664 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2665 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2666 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2667
2668 @end table
2669
2670 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2671 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2672 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2673 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2674 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2675 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2676 previously read data can be read again.
2677
2678 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2679 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2680 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2681 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2682 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2683 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2684
2685 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2686 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2687 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2688 different execution path this time.
2689
2690 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2691 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2692 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2693 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2694 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2695 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2696 potentially pose a problem.
2697
2698 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2699
2700 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2701 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2702 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2703 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2704 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2705 next.
2706
2707 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2708 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2709 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2710 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2711 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2712
2713 @node Stopping
2714 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2715
2716 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2717 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2718 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2719
2720 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2721 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2722 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2723 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2724 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2725 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2726 explicitly request this information at any time.
2727
2728 @table @code
2729 @kindex info program
2730 @item info program
2731 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2732 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2733 @end table
2734
2735 @menu
2736 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2737 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2738 * Signals:: Signals
2739 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2740 @end menu
2741
2742 @node Breakpoints
2743 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2744
2745 @cindex breakpoints
2746 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2747 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2748 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2749 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2750 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2751 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2752 program.
2753
2754 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2755 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2756 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2757 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2758 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2759 call).
2760
2761 @cindex watchpoints
2762 @cindex data breakpoints
2763 @cindex memory tracing
2764 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2765 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2766 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2767 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2768 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2769 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2770 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2771 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2772 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2773 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2774 same commands.
2775
2776 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2777 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2778 Automatic Display}.
2779
2780 @cindex catchpoints
2781 @cindex breakpoint on events
2782 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2783 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2784 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2785 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2786 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2787 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2788 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2789
2790 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2791 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2792 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2793 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2794 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2795 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2796 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2797 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2798 enable it again.
2799
2800 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2801 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2802 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2803 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2804 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2805 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2806 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2807
2808 @menu
2809 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2810 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2811 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2812 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2813 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2814 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2815 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2816 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2817 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2818 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2819 @end menu
2820
2821 @node Set Breaks
2822 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2823
2824 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2825 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2826 @c
2827 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2828
2829 @kindex break
2830 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2831 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2832 @cindex latest breakpoint
2833 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2834 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2835 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2836 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2837 convenience variables.
2838
2839 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2840
2841 @table @code
2842 @item break @var{function}
2843 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2844 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2845 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2846 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2847
2848 @item break +@var{offset}
2849 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2850 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2851 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2852 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2853
2854 @item break @var{linenum}
2855 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2856 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2857 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2858 code on that line.
2859
2860 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2861 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2862
2863 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2864 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2865 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2866 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2867 functions.
2868
2869 @item break *@var{address}
2870 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2871 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2872 information or source files.
2873
2874 @item break
2875 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2876 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2877 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2878 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2879 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2880 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2881 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2882 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2883 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2884 inside loops.
2885
2886 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2887 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2888 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2889 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2890 existed when your program stopped.
2891
2892 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2893 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2894 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2895 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2896 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2897 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2898 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2899
2900 @kindex tbreak
2901 @item tbreak @var{args}
2902 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2903 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2904 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2905 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2906
2907 @kindex hbreak
2908 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2909 @item hbreak @var{args}
2910 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2911 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2912 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2913 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2914 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2915 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2916 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2917 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2918 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2919 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2920 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2921 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2922 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2923 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2924 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2925 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2926 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2927 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2928
2929
2930 @kindex thbreak
2931 @item thbreak @var{args}
2932 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2933 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2934 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2935 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2936 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2937 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2938 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2939 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2940
2941 @kindex rbreak
2942 @cindex regular expression
2943 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2944 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2945 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2946 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2947 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2948 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2949 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2950 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2951 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2952
2953 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2954 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2955 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2956 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2957 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2958 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2959
2960 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2961 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2962 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2963 classes.
2964
2965 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2966 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2967 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2968
2969 @smallexample
2970 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2971 @end smallexample
2972
2973 @kindex info breakpoints
2974 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2975 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2976 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2977 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2978 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2979 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2980 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2981 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
2982
2983 @table @emph
2984 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2985 @item Type
2986 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2987 @item Disposition
2988 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2989 @item Enabled or Disabled
2990 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2991 that are not enabled. An optional @samp{(p)} suffix marks pending
2992 breakpoints---breakpoints for which address is either not yet
2993 resolved, pending load of a shared library, or for which address was
2994 in a shared library that was since unloaded. Such breakpoint won't
2995 fire until a shared library that has the symbol or line referred by
2996 breakpoint is loaded. See below for details.
2997 @item Address
2998 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
2999 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3000 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. A breakpoint with several locations will
3001 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3002 @item What
3003 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3004 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3005 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3006 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3007 @end table
3008
3009 @noindent
3010 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3011 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3012 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3013 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3014 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3015 valid location.
3016
3017 @noindent
3018 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3019 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3020 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3021 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3022 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3023
3024 @noindent
3025 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3026 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3027 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3028 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3029 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3030 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3031 @end table
3032
3033 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3034 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3035 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3036 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3037
3038 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3039 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3040
3041 @itemize @bullet
3042
3043 @item
3044 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3045 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3046
3047 @item
3048 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3049 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3050
3051 @item
3052 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3053 several places where that function is inlined.
3054
3055 @end itemize
3056
3057 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3058 the relevant locations.
3059
3060 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3061 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3062 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3063 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3064 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3065 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3066 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3067
3068 For example:
3069
3070 @smallexample
3071 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3072 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3073 stop only if i==1
3074 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3075 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3076 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3077 @end smallexample
3078
3079 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3080 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3081 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3082 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3083 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3084 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3085 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3086 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3087 that belong to that breakpoint.
3088
3089 @cindex pending breakpoints
3090 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3091 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3092 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3093 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3094 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3095 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3096 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3097 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3098 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3099 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3100 is not yet resolved.
3101
3102 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3103 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3104 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3105 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3106 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3107 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3108
3109 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3110 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3111 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3112 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3113
3114 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3115 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3116 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3117
3118 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3119 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3120 address specification to an address:
3121
3122 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3123 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3124 @table @code
3125 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3126 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3127 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3128
3129 @item set breakpoint pending on
3130 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3131 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3132
3133 @item set breakpoint pending off
3134 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3135 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3136 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3137
3138 @item show breakpoint pending
3139 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3140 @end table
3141
3142 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3143 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3144 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3145
3146 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3147 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3148 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3149 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3150 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3151 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3152 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3153 breakpoints.
3154
3155 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3156
3157 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3158 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3159 @table @code
3160 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3161 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3162 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3163 breakpoint must be used.
3164
3165 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3166 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3167 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3168 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3169 @end table
3170
3171
3172 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3173 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3174 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3175 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3176 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3177 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3178 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3179 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3180
3181
3182 @node Set Watchpoints
3183 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3184
3185 @cindex setting watchpoints
3186 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3187 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3188 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3189 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3190 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3191
3192 @itemize @bullet
3193 @item
3194 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3195
3196 @item
3197 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3198 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3199 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3200
3201 @item
3202 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3203 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3204 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3205 @end itemize
3206
3207 @cindex software watchpoints
3208 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3209 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3210 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3211 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3212 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3213 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3214 culprit.)
3215
3216 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3217 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3218 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3219
3220 @table @code
3221 @kindex watch
3222 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3223 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3224 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3225 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3226 to watch the value of a single variable:
3227
3228 @smallexample
3229 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3230 @end smallexample
3231
3232 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3233 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3234 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3235 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3236 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3237 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3238
3239 @kindex rwatch
3240 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3241 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3242 by the program.
3243
3244 @kindex awatch
3245 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3246 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3247 or written into by the program.
3248
3249 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3250 @item info watchpoints
3251 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3252 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3253 @end table
3254
3255 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3256 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3257 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3258 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3259 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3260 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3261
3262 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3263 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3264 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3265 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3266 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3267 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3268 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3269 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3270
3271 @table @code
3272 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3273 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3274 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3275
3276 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3277 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3278 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3279 @end table
3280
3281 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3282 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3283 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3284
3285 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3286
3287 @smallexample
3288 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3289 @end smallexample
3290
3291 @noindent
3292 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3293
3294 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3295 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3296 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3297 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3298 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3299 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3300 will print a message like this:
3301
3302 @smallexample
3303 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3304 @end smallexample
3305
3306 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3307 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3308 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3309 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3310 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3311 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3312 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3313 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3314
3315 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3316 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3317 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3318 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3319 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3320 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3321
3322 @smallexample
3323 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3324 @end smallexample
3325
3326 @noindent
3327 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3328
3329 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3330 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3331 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3332 expression with separately allocated resources.
3333
3334 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3335 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3336 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3337 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3338 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3339 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3340 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3341 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3342 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3343 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3344
3345 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3346 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3347 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3348
3349 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3350 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3351 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3352 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3353 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3354 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3355 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3356 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3357 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3358
3359 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3360 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3361 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3362 watched expression from every thread.
3363
3364 @quotation
3365 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3366 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3367 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3368 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3369 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3370 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3371 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3372 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3373 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3374 @end quotation
3375
3376 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3377
3378 @node Set Catchpoints
3379 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3380 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3381 @cindex exception handlers
3382 @cindex event handling
3383
3384 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3385 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3386 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3387
3388 @table @code
3389 @kindex catch
3390 @item catch @var{event}
3391 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3392 @table @code
3393 @item throw
3394 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3395 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3396
3397 @item catch
3398 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3399
3400 @item exception
3401 @cindex Ada exception catching
3402 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3403 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3404 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3405 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3406 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3407
3408 @item exception unhandled
3409 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3410
3411 @item assert
3412 A failed Ada assertion.
3413
3414 @item exec
3415 @cindex break on fork/exec
3416 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3417
3418 @item fork
3419 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3420
3421 @item vfork
3422 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3423
3424 @item load
3425 @itemx load @var{libname}
3426 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3427 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3428 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3429
3430 @item unload
3431 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3432 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3433 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3434 @end table
3435
3436 @item tcatch @var{event}
3437 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3438 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3439
3440 @end table
3441
3442 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3443
3444 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3445 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3446
3447 @itemize @bullet
3448 @item
3449 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3450 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3451 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3452 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3453 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3454 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3455 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3456 disabled within interactive calls.
3457
3458 @item
3459 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3460
3461 @item
3462 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3463 @end itemize
3464
3465 @cindex raise exceptions
3466 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3467 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3468 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3469 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3470 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3471 out where the exception was raised.
3472
3473 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3474 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3475 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3476 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3477
3478 @smallexample
3479 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3480 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3481 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3482 @end smallexample
3483
3484 @noindent
3485 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3486 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3487 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3488
3489 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3490 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3491 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3492 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3493 raised.
3494
3495
3496 @node Delete Breaks
3497 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3498
3499 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3500 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3501 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3502 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3503 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3504 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3505
3506 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3507 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3508 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3509 their breakpoint numbers.
3510
3511 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3512 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3513 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3514
3515 @table @code
3516 @kindex clear
3517 @item clear
3518 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3519 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3520 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3521 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3522
3523 @item clear @var{function}
3524 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3525 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3526
3527 @item clear @var{linenum}
3528 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3529 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3530 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3531
3532 @cindex delete breakpoints
3533 @kindex delete
3534 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3535 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3536 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3537 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3538 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3539 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3540 @end table
3541
3542 @node Disabling
3543 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3544
3545 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3546 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3547 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3548 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3549 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3550
3551 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3552 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3553 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3554 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3555 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3556
3557 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3558 affects all of its locations.
3559
3560 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3561 states of enablement:
3562
3563 @itemize @bullet
3564 @item
3565 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3566 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3567 @item
3568 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3569 @item
3570 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3571 disabled.
3572 @item
3573 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3574 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3575 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3576 @end itemize
3577
3578 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3579 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3580
3581 @table @code
3582 @kindex disable
3583 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3584 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3585 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3586 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3587 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3588 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3589 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3590
3591 @kindex enable
3592 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3593 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3594 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3595
3596 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3597 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3598 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3599
3600 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3601 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3602 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3603 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3604 @end table
3605
3606 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3607 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3608 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3609 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3610 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3611 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3612 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3613 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3614 Stepping}.)
3615
3616 @node Conditions
3617 @subsection Break Conditions
3618 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3619 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3620
3621 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3622 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3623 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3624 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3625 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3626 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3627 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3628 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3629
3630 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3631 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3632 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3633 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3634 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3635
3636 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3637 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3638 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3639 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3640 one.
3641
3642 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3643 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3644 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3645 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3646 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3647 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3648 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3649 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3650 conditions for the
3651 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3652 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3653
3654 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3655 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3656 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3657 with the @code{condition} command.
3658
3659 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3660 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3661 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3662 catchpoint.
3663
3664 @table @code
3665 @kindex condition
3666 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3667 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3668 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3669 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3670 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3671 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3672 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3673 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3674 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3675 prints an error message:
3676
3677 @smallexample
3678 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3679 @end smallexample
3680
3681 @noindent
3682 @value{GDBN} does
3683 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3684 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3685 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3686
3687 @item condition @var{bnum}
3688 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3689 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3690 @end table
3691
3692 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3693 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3694 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3695 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3696 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3697 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3698 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3699 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3700 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3701 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3702 your program reaches it.
3703
3704 @table @code
3705 @kindex ignore
3706 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3707 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3708 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3709 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3710 takes no action.
3711
3712 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3713 a count of zero.
3714
3715 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3716 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3717 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3718 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3719
3720 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3721 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3722 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3723
3724 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3725 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3726 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3727 Variables}.
3728 @end table
3729
3730 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3731
3732
3733 @node Break Commands
3734 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3735
3736 @cindex breakpoint commands
3737 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3738 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3739 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3740 enable other breakpoints.
3741
3742 @table @code
3743 @kindex commands
3744 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3745 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3746 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3747 @itemx end
3748 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3749 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3750 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3751
3752 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3753 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3754
3755 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3756 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3757 recently encountered).
3758 @end table
3759
3760 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3761 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3762
3763 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3764 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3765 that resumes execution.
3766
3767 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3768 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3769 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3770 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3771 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3772
3773 @kindex silent
3774 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3775 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3776 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3777 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3778 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3779 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3780
3781 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3782 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3783 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3784
3785 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3786 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3787
3788 @smallexample
3789 break foo if x>0
3790 commands
3791 silent
3792 printf "x is %d\n",x
3793 cont
3794 end
3795 @end smallexample
3796
3797 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3798 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3799 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3800 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3801 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3802 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3803 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3804
3805 @smallexample
3806 break 403
3807 commands
3808 silent
3809 set x = y + 4
3810 cont
3811 end
3812 @end smallexample
3813
3814 @node Breakpoint Menus
3815 @subsection Breakpoint Menus
3816 @cindex overloading
3817 @cindex symbol overloading
3818
3819 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3820 single function name
3821 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3822 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3823 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3824 a breakpoint. You can use explicit signature of the function, as in
3825 @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})}, to specify which
3826 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3827 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3828 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3829 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3830 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3831 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3832 breakpoints.
3833
3834 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3835 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3836 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3837
3838 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3839 @smallexample
3840 @group
3841 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3842 [0] cancel
3843 [1] all
3844 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3845 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3846 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3847 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3848 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3849 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3850 > 2 4 6
3851 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3852 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3853 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3854 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3855 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3856 breakpoints.
3857 (@value{GDBP})
3858 @end group
3859 @end smallexample
3860
3861 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3862 @node Error in Breakpoints
3863 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3864 @c
3865 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3866 @c
3867 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3868 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3869 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3870 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3871
3872 @smallexample
3873 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3874 The same program may be running in another process.
3875 @end smallexample
3876
3877 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3878
3879 @enumerate
3880 @item
3881 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3882
3883 @item
3884 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3885 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3886 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3887 Then start your program again.
3888
3889 @item
3890 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3891 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3892 to nonsharable executables.
3893 @end enumerate
3894 @c @end ifclear
3895
3896 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3897 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3898
3899 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3900 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3901 @smallexample
3902 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3903 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3904 @end smallexample
3905
3906 @noindent
3907 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3908 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3909 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3910
3911 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3912 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3913
3914 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3915 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3916 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3917
3918 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3919 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3920 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3921 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3922
3923 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3924 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3925 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3926 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3927 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3928 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3929 first in the bundle.
3930
3931 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3932 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3933 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3934 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3935 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3936 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3937 is hit.
3938
3939 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3940 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3941
3942 @smallexample
3943 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3944 @end smallexample
3945
3946 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3947 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3948 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3949 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3950 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3951 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3952 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3953 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3954
3955 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3956 adjusted breakpoints:
3957
3958 @smallexample
3959 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3960 to 0x00010410.
3961 @end smallexample
3962
3963 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3964 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3965 frequently than expected.
3966
3967 @node Continuing and Stepping
3968 @section Continuing and Stepping
3969
3970 @cindex stepping
3971 @cindex continuing
3972 @cindex resuming execution
3973 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3974 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3975 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3976 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3977 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3978 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3979 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3980 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3981
3982 @table @code
3983 @kindex continue
3984 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3985 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3986 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3987 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3988 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3989 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3990 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3991 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3992 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3993 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3994
3995 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3996 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3997 @code{continue} is ignored.
3998
3999 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4000 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4001 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4002 @code{continue}.
4003 @end table
4004
4005 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4006 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4007 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4008 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4009
4010 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4011 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4012 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4013 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4014 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4015 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4016
4017 @table @code
4018 @kindex step
4019 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4020 @item step
4021 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4022 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4023 abbreviated @code{s}.
4024
4025 @quotation
4026 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4027 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4028 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4029 @c distinction here.
4030 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4031 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4032 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4033 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4034 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4035 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4036 below.
4037 @end quotation
4038
4039 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4040 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4041 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4042 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4043 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4044 called within the line.
4045
4046 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4047 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4048 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4049 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4050 was any debugging information about the routine.
4051
4052 @item step @var{count}
4053 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4054 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4055 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4056
4057 @kindex next
4058 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4059 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4060 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4061 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4062 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4063 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4064 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4065 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4066
4067 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4068
4069
4070 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4071 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4072 @c
4073 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4074 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4075 @c function are executed without stopping.
4076
4077 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4078 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4079 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4080
4081 @kindex set step-mode
4082 @item set step-mode
4083 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4084 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4085 @itemx set step-mode on
4086 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4087 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4088 information rather than stepping over it.
4089
4090 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4091 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4092 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4093
4094 @item set step-mode off
4095 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4096 debug information. This is the default.
4097
4098 @item show step-mode
4099 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4100 source line debug information.
4101
4102 @kindex finish
4103 @item finish
4104 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4105 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4106
4107 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4108 ,Returning from a Function}).
4109
4110 @kindex until
4111 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4112 @cindex run until specified location
4113 @item until
4114 @itemx u
4115 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4116 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4117 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4118 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4119 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4120 than the address of the jump.
4121
4122 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4123 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4124 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4125 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4126 through the next iteration.
4127
4128 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4129 stack frame.
4130
4131 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4132 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4133 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4134 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4135 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4136
4137 @smallexample
4138 (@value{GDBP}) f
4139 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4140 206 expand_input();
4141 (@value{GDBP}) until
4142 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4143 @end smallexample
4144
4145 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4146 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4147 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4148 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4149 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4150 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4151 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4152
4153 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4154 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4155 argument.
4156
4157 @item until @var{location}
4158 @itemx u @var{location}
4159 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4160 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4161 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4162 ,Setting Breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4163 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4164 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4165 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4166 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4167 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4168 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4169 invocations have returned.
4170
4171 @smallexample
4172 94 int factorial (int value)
4173 95 @{
4174 96 if (value > 1) @{
4175 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4176 98 @}
4177 99 return (value);
4178 100 @}
4179 @end smallexample
4180
4181
4182 @kindex advance @var{location}
4183 @itemx advance @var{location}
4184 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4185 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4186 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4187 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4188 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4189 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4190
4191
4192 @kindex stepi
4193 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4194 @item stepi
4195 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4196 @itemx si
4197 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4198
4199 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4200 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4201 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4202 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4203
4204 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4205
4206 @need 750
4207 @kindex nexti
4208 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4209 @item nexti
4210 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4211 @itemx ni
4212 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4213 proceed until the function returns.
4214
4215 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4216 @end table
4217
4218 @node Signals
4219 @section Signals
4220 @cindex signals
4221
4222 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4223 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4224 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4225 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4226 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4227 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4228 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4229 requested an alarm).
4230
4231 @cindex fatal signals
4232 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4233 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4234 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4235 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4236 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4237 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4238
4239 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4240 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4241 signal.
4242
4243 @cindex handling signals
4244 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4245 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4246 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4247 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4248 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4249
4250 @table @code
4251 @kindex info signals
4252 @kindex info handle
4253 @item info signals
4254 @itemx info handle
4255 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4256 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4257 the defined types of signals.
4258
4259 @item info signals @var{sig}
4260 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4261
4262 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4263
4264 @kindex handle
4265 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4266 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4267 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4268 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4269 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4270 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4271 say what change to make.
4272 @end table
4273
4274 @c @group
4275 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4276 Their full names are:
4277
4278 @table @code
4279 @item nostop
4280 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4281 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4282
4283 @item stop
4284 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4285 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4286
4287 @item print
4288 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4289
4290 @item noprint
4291 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4292 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4293
4294 @item pass
4295 @itemx noignore
4296 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4297 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4298 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4299
4300 @item nopass
4301 @itemx ignore
4302 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4303 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4304 @end table
4305 @c @end group
4306
4307 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4308 program until you
4309 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4310 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4311 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4312 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4313 program sees that signal when you continue.
4314
4315 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4316 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4317 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4318 erroneous signals.
4319
4320 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4321 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4322 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4323 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4324 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4325 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4326 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4327 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4328 Program a Signal}.
4329
4330 @node Thread Stops
4331 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4332
4333 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4334 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4335 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4336
4337 @table @code
4338 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4339 @cindex thread breakpoints
4340 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4341 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4342 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4343 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4344 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4345
4346 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4347 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4348 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4349 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4350 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4351
4352 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4353 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4354 program.
4355
4356 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4357 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4358 breakpoint condition, like this:
4359
4360 @smallexample
4361 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4362 @end smallexample
4363
4364 @end table
4365
4366 @cindex stopped threads
4367 @cindex threads, stopped
4368 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4369 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4370 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4371 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4372 underfoot.
4373
4374 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4375 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4376 @cindex premature return from system calls
4377 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4378 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4379 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4380 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4381 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4382 stop execution.
4383
4384 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4385 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4386 style anyways.
4387
4388 For example, do not write code like this:
4389
4390 @smallexample
4391 sleep (10);
4392 @end smallexample
4393
4394 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4395 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4396
4397 Instead, write this:
4398
4399 @smallexample
4400 int unslept = 10;
4401 while (unslept > 0)
4402 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4403 @end smallexample
4404
4405 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4406 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4407 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4408 @value{GDBN}.
4409
4410 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4411 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4412 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4413 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4414
4415 @cindex continuing threads
4416 @cindex threads, continuing
4417 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4418 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4419 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4420
4421 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4422 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4423 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4424 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4425 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4426 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4427 stops.
4428
4429 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4430 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4431 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4432 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4433
4434 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4435 thread to run.
4436
4437 @table @code
4438 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4439 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4440 @cindex lock scheduler
4441 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4442 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4443 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4444 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4445 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4446 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4447 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4448 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4449 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4450 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4451 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4452
4453 @item show scheduler-locking
4454 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4455 @end table
4456
4457
4458 @node Stack
4459 @chapter Examining the Stack
4460
4461 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4462 stopped and how it got there.
4463
4464 @cindex call stack
4465 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4466 is generated.
4467 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4468 the arguments of the call,
4469 and the local variables of the function being called.
4470 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4471 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4472 stack}.
4473
4474 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4475 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4476
4477 @cindex selected frame
4478 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4479 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4480 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4481 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4482 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4483 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4484
4485 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4486 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4487 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4488
4489 @menu
4490 * Frames:: Stack frames
4491 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4492 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4493 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4494
4495 @end menu
4496
4497 @node Frames
4498 @section Stack Frames
4499
4500 @cindex frame, definition
4501 @cindex stack frame
4502 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4503 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4504 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4505 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4506 which the function is executing.
4507
4508 @cindex initial frame
4509 @cindex outermost frame
4510 @cindex innermost frame
4511 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4512 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4513 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4514 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4515 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4516 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4517 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4518 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4519
4520 @cindex frame pointer
4521 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4522 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4523 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4524 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4525 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4526 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4527
4528 @cindex frame number
4529 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4530 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4531 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4532 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4533 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4534
4535 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4536 @c underflow problems.
4537 @cindex frameless execution
4538 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4539 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4540 @smallexample
4541 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4542 @end smallexample
4543 generates functions without a frame.)
4544 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4545 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4546 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4547 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4548 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4549 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4550 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4551
4552 @table @code
4553 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4554 @cindex current stack frame
4555 @item frame @var{args}
4556 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4557 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4558 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4559 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4560
4561 @kindex select-frame
4562 @cindex selecting frame silently
4563 @item select-frame
4564 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4565 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4566 @code{frame}.
4567 @end table
4568
4569 @node Backtrace
4570 @section Backtraces
4571
4572 @cindex traceback
4573 @cindex call stack traces
4574 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4575 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4576 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4577 stack.
4578
4579 @table @code
4580 @kindex backtrace
4581 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4582 @item backtrace
4583 @itemx bt
4584 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4585 frames in the stack.
4586
4587 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4588 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4589
4590 @item backtrace @var{n}
4591 @itemx bt @var{n}
4592 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4593
4594 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4595 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4596 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4597
4598 @item backtrace full
4599 @itemx bt full
4600 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4601 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4602 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4603 number of frames to print, as described above.
4604 @end table
4605
4606 @kindex where
4607 @kindex info stack
4608 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4609 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4610
4611 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4612 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4613 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4614 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4615 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4616 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4617 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4618 multi-threaded program.
4619
4620 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4621 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4622 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4623 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4624 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4625 line number.
4626
4627 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4628 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4629
4630 @smallexample
4631 @group
4632 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4633 at builtin.c:993
4634 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4635 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4636 at macro.c:71
4637 (More stack frames follow...)
4638 @end group
4639 @end smallexample
4640
4641 @noindent
4642 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4643 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4644 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4645
4646 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4647 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4648 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4649 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4650 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4651 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4652 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4653 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4654 such a backtrace might look like:
4655
4656 @smallexample
4657 @group
4658 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4659 at builtin.c:993
4660 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4661 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4662 at macro.c:71
4663 (More stack frames follow...)
4664 @end group
4665 @end smallexample
4666
4667 @noindent
4668 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4669 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4670
4671 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4672 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4673 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4674
4675 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4676 @cindex program entry point
4677 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4678 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4679 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4680 @code{main}@footnote{
4681 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4682 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4683 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4684 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4685 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4686 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4687
4688 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4689 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4690
4691 @table @code
4692 @item set backtrace past-main
4693 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4694 @kindex set backtrace
4695 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4696
4697 @item set backtrace past-main off
4698 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4699 default.
4700
4701 @item show backtrace past-main
4702 @kindex show backtrace
4703 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4704
4705 @item set backtrace past-entry
4706 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4707 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4708 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4709 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4710
4711 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4712 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4713 application. This is the default.
4714
4715 @item show backtrace past-entry
4716 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4717
4718 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4719 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4720 @cindex backtrace limit
4721 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4722 unlimited.
4723
4724 @item show backtrace limit
4725 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4726 @end table
4727
4728 @node Selection
4729 @section Selecting a Frame
4730
4731 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4732 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4733 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4734 of the stack frame just selected.
4735
4736 @table @code
4737 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4738 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4739 @item frame @var{n}
4740 @itemx f @var{n}
4741 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4742 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4743 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4744 @code{main}.
4745
4746 @item frame @var{addr}
4747 @itemx f @var{addr}
4748 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4749 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4750 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4751 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4752 switches between them.
4753
4754 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4755 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4756
4757 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4758 pointer and a program counter.
4759
4760 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4761 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4762
4763 @kindex up
4764 @item up @var{n}
4765 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4766 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4767 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4768
4769 @kindex down
4770 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4771 @item down @var{n}
4772 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4773 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4774 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4775 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4776 @end table
4777
4778 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4779 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4780 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4781 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4782
4783 @need 1000
4784 For example:
4785
4786 @smallexample
4787 @group
4788 (@value{GDBP}) up
4789 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4790 at env.c:10
4791 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4792 @end group
4793 @end smallexample
4794
4795 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4796 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4797 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4798 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4799 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4800 for details.
4801
4802 @table @code
4803 @kindex down-silently
4804 @kindex up-silently
4805 @item up-silently @var{n}
4806 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4807 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4808 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4809 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4810 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4811 distracting.
4812 @end table
4813
4814 @node Frame Info
4815 @section Information About a Frame
4816
4817 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4818 stack frame.
4819
4820 @table @code
4821 @item frame
4822 @itemx f
4823 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4824 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4825 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4826 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4827 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4828
4829 @kindex info frame
4830 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4831 @item info frame
4832 @itemx info f
4833 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4834 including:
4835
4836 @itemize @bullet
4837 @item
4838 the address of the frame
4839 @item
4840 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4841 @item
4842 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4843 @item
4844 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4845 @item
4846 the address of the frame's arguments
4847 @item
4848 the address of the frame's local variables
4849 @item
4850 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4851 @item
4852 which registers were saved in the frame
4853 @end itemize
4854
4855 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4856 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4857 the usual conventions.
4858
4859 @item info frame @var{addr}
4860 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4861 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4862 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4863 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4864 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4865 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4866
4867 @kindex info args
4868 @item info args
4869 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4870
4871 @item info locals
4872 @kindex info locals
4873 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4874 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4875 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4876
4877 @kindex info catch
4878 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4879 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4880 @item info catch
4881 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4882 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4883 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4884 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4885 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4886
4887 @end table
4888
4889
4890 @node Source
4891 @chapter Examining Source Files
4892
4893 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4894 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4895 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4896 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4897 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4898 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4899 source files by explicit command.
4900
4901 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4902 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4903 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4904
4905 @menu
4906 * List:: Printing source lines
4907 * Edit:: Editing source files
4908 * Search:: Searching source files
4909 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4910 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4911 @end menu
4912
4913 @node List
4914 @section Printing Source Lines
4915
4916 @kindex list
4917 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4918 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4919 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4920 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4921
4922 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4923
4924 @table @code
4925 @item list @var{linenum}
4926 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4927 current source file.
4928
4929 @item list @var{function}
4930 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4931 @var{function}.
4932
4933 @item list
4934 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4935 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4936 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4937 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4938 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4939
4940 @item list -
4941 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4942 @end table
4943
4944 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4945 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4946 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4947
4948 @table @code
4949 @kindex set listsize
4950 @item set listsize @var{count}
4951 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4952 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4953
4954 @kindex show listsize
4955 @item show listsize
4956 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4957 @end table
4958
4959 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4960 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4961 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4962 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4963 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4964
4965 @cindex linespec
4966 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4967 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4968 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4969 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4970
4971 @table @code
4972 @item list @var{linespec}
4973 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4974
4975 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4976 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4977 linespecs.
4978
4979 @item list ,@var{last}
4980 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4981
4982 @item list @var{first},
4983 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4984
4985 @item list +
4986 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4987
4988 @item list -
4989 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4990
4991 @item list
4992 As described in the preceding table.
4993 @end table
4994
4995 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4996 kinds of linespec.
4997
4998 @table @code
4999 @item @var{number}
5000 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
5001 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
5002 the same source file as the first linespec.
5003
5004 @item +@var{offset}
5005 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
5006 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
5007 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
5008 first linespec.
5009
5010 @item -@var{offset}
5011 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
5012
5013 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
5014 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
5015
5016 @item @var{function}
5017 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5018 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5019
5020 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5021 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
5022 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
5023 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
5024 identically named functions in different source files.
5025
5026 @item *@var{address}
5027 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
5028 @var{address} may be any expression.
5029 @end table
5030
5031 @node Edit
5032 @section Editing Source Files
5033 @cindex editing source files
5034
5035 @kindex edit
5036 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5037 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5038 The editing program of your choice
5039 is invoked with the current line set to
5040 the active line in the program.
5041 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5042 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
5043
5044 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
5045
5046 @table @code
5047 @item edit
5048 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
5049
5050 @item edit @var{number}
5051 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5052
5053 @item edit @var{function}
5054 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5055
5056 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
5057 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
5058
5059 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
5060 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
5061 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
5062 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
5063 identically named functions in different source files.
5064
5065 @item edit *@var{address}
5066 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
5067 @var{address} may be any expression.
5068 @end table
5069
5070 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5071 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5072 @footnote{
5073 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5074 following command-line syntax:
5075 @smallexample
5076 ex +@var{number} file
5077 @end smallexample
5078 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5079 the file where to start editing.}.
5080 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5081 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5082 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5083 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5084 @smallexample
5085 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5086 export EDITOR
5087 gdb @dots{}
5088 @end smallexample
5089 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5090 @smallexample
5091 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5092 gdb @dots{}
5093 @end smallexample
5094
5095 @node Search
5096 @section Searching Source Files
5097 @cindex searching source files
5098
5099 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5100 regular expression.
5101
5102 @table @code
5103 @kindex search
5104 @kindex forward-search
5105 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5106 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5107 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5108 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5109 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5110 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5111 @code{fo}.
5112
5113 @kindex reverse-search
5114 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5115 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5116 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5117 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5118 this command as @code{rev}.
5119 @end table
5120
5121 @node Source Path
5122 @section Specifying Source Directories
5123
5124 @cindex source path
5125 @cindex directories for source files
5126 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5127 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5128 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5129 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5130 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5131 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5132 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5133
5134 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5135 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5136 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5137 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5138 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5139 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5140 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5141 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5142 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5143 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5144 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5145
5146 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5147 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5148 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5149 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5150 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5151 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5152
5153 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5154 source files.
5155
5156 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5157 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5158 each line is in the file.
5159
5160 @kindex directory
5161 @kindex dir
5162 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5163 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5164 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5165
5166 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5167 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5168
5169 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5170 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5171 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5172 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5173 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5174 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5175 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5176 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5177 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5178 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5179 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5180 name to look up the sources.
5181
5182 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5183 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5184 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5185 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5186 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5187 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5188 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5189 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5190
5191 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5192 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5193 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5194 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5195 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5196 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5197 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5198
5199 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5200 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5201 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5202 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5203 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5204 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5205 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5206 command.
5207
5208 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5209 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5210 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5211 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5212 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5213 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5214 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5215
5216 @table @code
5217 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5218 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5219 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5220 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5221 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5222 part of absolute file names) or
5223 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5224 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5225
5226 @kindex cdir
5227 @kindex cwd
5228 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5229 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5230 @cindex compilation directory
5231 @cindex current directory
5232 @cindex working directory
5233 @cindex directory, current
5234 @cindex directory, compilation
5235 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5236 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5237 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5238 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5239 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5240 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5241
5242 @item directory
5243 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5244
5245 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5246 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5247
5248 @item show directories
5249 @kindex show directories
5250 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5251
5252 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5253 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5254 @kindex set substitute-path
5255 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5256 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5257 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5258
5259 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5260 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5261
5262 @smallexample
5263 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5264 @end smallexample
5265
5266 @noindent
5267 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5268 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5269 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5270
5271 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5272 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5273 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5274 the substitution.
5275
5276 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5277
5278 @smallexample
5279 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5280 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5281 @end smallexample
5282
5283 @noindent
5284 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5285 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5286 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5287 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5288
5289
5290 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5291 @kindex unset substitute-path
5292 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5293 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5294 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5295
5296 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5297
5298 @item show substitute-path [path]
5299 @kindex show substitute-path
5300 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5301 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5302
5303 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5304 rules.
5305
5306 @end table
5307
5308 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5309 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5310 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5311
5312 @enumerate
5313 @item
5314 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5315
5316 @item
5317 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5318 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5319 directories in one command.
5320 @end enumerate
5321
5322 @node Machine Code
5323 @section Source and Machine Code
5324 @cindex source line and its code address
5325
5326 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5327 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5328 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5329 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5330 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5331 well as hex.
5332
5333 @table @code
5334 @kindex info line
5335 @item info line @var{linespec}
5336 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5337 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5338 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5339 Source Lines}).
5340 @end table
5341
5342 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5343 the object code for the first line of function
5344 @code{m4_changequote}:
5345
5346 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5347 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5348 @smallexample
5349 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5350 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5351 @end smallexample
5352
5353 @noindent
5354 @cindex code address and its source line
5355 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5356 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5357 @smallexample
5358 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5359 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5360 @end smallexample
5361
5362 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5363 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5364 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5365 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5366 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5367 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5368 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5369 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5370 Variables}).
5371
5372 @table @code
5373 @kindex disassemble
5374 @cindex assembly instructions
5375 @cindex instructions, assembly
5376 @cindex machine instructions
5377 @cindex listing machine instructions
5378 @item disassemble
5379 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5380 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5381 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5382 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5383 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5384 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5385 @end table
5386
5387 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5388 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5389
5390 @smallexample
5391 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5392 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5393 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5394 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5395 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5396 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5397 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5398 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5399 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5400 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5401 End of assembler dump.
5402 @end smallexample
5403
5404 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5405 mnemonics or other syntax.
5406
5407 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5408 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5409 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5410 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5411 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5412
5413 @table @code
5414 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5415 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5416 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5417 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5418 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5419 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5420
5421 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5422 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5423 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5424 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5425
5426 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5427 @item show disassembly-flavor
5428 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5429 @end table
5430
5431
5432 @node Data
5433 @chapter Examining Data
5434
5435 @cindex printing data
5436 @cindex examining data
5437 @kindex print
5438 @kindex inspect
5439 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5440 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5441 @c different window or something like that.
5442 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5443 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5444 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5445 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5446 Different Languages}).
5447
5448 @table @code
5449 @item print @var{expr}
5450 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5451 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5452 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5453 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5454 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5455 Formats}.
5456
5457 @item print
5458 @itemx print /@var{f}
5459 @cindex reprint the last value
5460 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5461 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5462 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5463 @end table
5464
5465 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5466 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5467 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5468
5469 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5470 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5471 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5472 Table}.
5473
5474 @menu
5475 * Expressions:: Expressions
5476 * Variables:: Program variables
5477 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5478 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5479 * Memory:: Examining memory
5480 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5481 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5482 * Value History:: Value history
5483 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5484 * Registers:: Registers
5485 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5486 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5487 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5488 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5489 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5490 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5491 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5492 character set than GDB does
5493 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5494 @end menu
5495
5496 @node Expressions
5497 @section Expressions
5498
5499 @cindex expressions
5500 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5501 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5502 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5503 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5504 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5505 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5506 @ref{Compilation}.
5507
5508 @cindex arrays in expressions
5509 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5510 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5511 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5512 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5513
5514 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5515 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5516 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5517 languages.
5518
5519 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5520 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5521
5522 @cindex casts, in expressions
5523 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5524 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5525 at that address in memory.
5526 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5527
5528 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5529 to programming languages:
5530
5531 @table @code
5532 @item @@
5533 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5534 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5535
5536 @item ::
5537 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5538 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5539
5540 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5541 @cindex type casting memory
5542 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5543 @cindex casts, to view memory
5544 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5545 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5546 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5547 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5548 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5549 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5550 @end table
5551
5552 @node Variables
5553 @section Program Variables
5554
5555 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5556 in your program.
5557
5558 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5559 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5560
5561 @itemize @bullet
5562 @item
5563 global (or file-static)
5564 @end itemize
5565
5566 @noindent or
5567
5568 @itemize @bullet
5569 @item
5570 visible according to the scope rules of the
5571 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5572 @end itemize
5573
5574 @noindent This means that in the function
5575
5576 @smallexample
5577 foo (a)
5578 int a;
5579 @{
5580 bar (a);
5581 @{
5582 int b = test ();
5583 bar (b);
5584 @}
5585 @}
5586 @end smallexample
5587
5588 @noindent
5589 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5590 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5591 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5592 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5593
5594 @cindex variable name conflict
5595 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5596 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5597 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5598 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5599 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5600 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5601 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5602
5603 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5604 @ifnotinfo
5605 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5606 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5607 @end ifnotinfo
5608 @smallexample
5609 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5610 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5611 @end smallexample
5612
5613 @noindent
5614 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5615 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5616 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5617 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5618
5619 @smallexample
5620 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5621 @end smallexample
5622
5623 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5624 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5625 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5626 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5627 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5628 @c conflict?? --mew
5629
5630 @cindex wrong values
5631 @cindex variable values, wrong
5632 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5633 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5634 @quotation
5635 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5636 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5637 scope, and just before exit.
5638 @end quotation
5639 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5640 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5641 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5642 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5643 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5644 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5645 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5646 variable definitions may be gone.
5647
5648 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5649 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5650 when compiling.
5651
5652 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5653 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5654 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5655 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5656 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5657 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5658 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5659
5660 @smallexample
5661 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5662 @end smallexample
5663
5664 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5665 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5666 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5667 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5668 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5669 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5670 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5671 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5672 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5673 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5674 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5675
5676 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5677 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5678 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5679 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5680
5681 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5682 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5683 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5684 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5685 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5686 For program code
5687
5688 @smallexample
5689 char var0[] = "A";
5690 signed char var1[] = "A";
5691 @end smallexample
5692
5693 You get during debugging
5694 @smallexample
5695 (gdb) print var0
5696 $1 = "A"
5697 (gdb) print var1
5698 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5699 @end smallexample
5700
5701 @node Arrays
5702 @section Artificial Arrays
5703
5704 @cindex artificial array
5705 @cindex arrays
5706 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5707 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5708 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5709 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5710 program.
5711
5712 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5713 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5714 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5715 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5716 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5717 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5718 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5719 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5720 example. If a program says
5721
5722 @smallexample
5723 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5724 @end smallexample
5725
5726 @noindent
5727 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5728
5729 @smallexample
5730 p *array@@len
5731 @end smallexample
5732
5733 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5734 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5735 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5736 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5737 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5738
5739 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5740 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5741 The value need not be in memory:
5742 @smallexample
5743 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5744 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5745 @end smallexample
5746
5747 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5748 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5749 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5750 @smallexample
5751 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5752 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5753 @end smallexample
5754
5755 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5756 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5757 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5758 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5759 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5760 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5761 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5762 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5763 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5764 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5765
5766 @smallexample
5767 set $i = 0
5768 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5769 @key{RET}
5770 @key{RET}
5771 @dots{}
5772 @end smallexample
5773
5774 @node Output Formats
5775 @section Output Formats
5776
5777 @cindex formatted output
5778 @cindex output formats
5779 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5780 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5781 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5782 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5783 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5784
5785 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5786 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5787 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5788 letters supported are:
5789
5790 @table @code
5791 @item x
5792 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5793 hexadecimal.
5794
5795 @item d
5796 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5797
5798 @item u
5799 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5800
5801 @item o
5802 Print as integer in octal.
5803
5804 @item t
5805 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5806 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5807 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5808 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5809
5810 @item a
5811 @cindex unknown address, locating
5812 @cindex locate address
5813 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5814 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5815 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5816
5817 @smallexample
5818 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5819 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5820 @end smallexample
5821
5822 @noindent
5823 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5824 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5825
5826 @item c
5827 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5828 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5829 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5830 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5831
5832 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
5833 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
5834 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
5835 data.
5836
5837 @item f
5838 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5839 using typical floating point syntax.
5840
5841 @item s
5842 @cindex printing strings
5843 @cindex printing byte arrays
5844 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
5845 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
5846 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
5847 natural types.
5848
5849 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
5850 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
5851 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
5852 array.
5853 @end table
5854
5855 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5856
5857 @smallexample
5858 p/x $pc
5859 @end smallexample
5860
5861 @noindent
5862 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5863 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5864
5865 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5866 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5867 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5868
5869 @node Memory
5870 @section Examining Memory
5871
5872 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5873 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5874
5875 @cindex examining memory
5876 @table @code
5877 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5878 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5879 @itemx x @var{addr}
5880 @itemx x
5881 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5882 @end table
5883
5884 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5885 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5886 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5887 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5888 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5889
5890 @table @r
5891 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5892 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5893 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5894 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5895 @c 4.1.2.
5896
5897 @item @var{f}, the display format
5898 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5899 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5900 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
5901 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
5902 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
5903
5904 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5905 The unit size is any of
5906
5907 @table @code
5908 @item b
5909 Bytes.
5910 @item h
5911 Halfwords (two bytes).
5912 @item w
5913 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5914 @item g
5915 Giant words (eight bytes).
5916 @end table
5917
5918 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5919 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5920 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5921
5922 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5923 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5924 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5925 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5926 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5927 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5928 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5929 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5930 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5931 a value from memory).
5932 @end table
5933
5934 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5935 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5936 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5937 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5938 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5939
5940 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5941 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5942 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5943 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5944 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5945
5946 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5947 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5948 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5949 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
5950 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
5951 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
5952 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
5953 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
5954 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
5955
5956 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5957 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5958 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5959 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5960 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5961 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5962 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5963
5964 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5965 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5966 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5967 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5968 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5969 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5970 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5971 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5972 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5973
5974 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5975 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5976 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5977
5978 @cindex remote memory comparison
5979 @cindex verify remote memory image
5980 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5981 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5982 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5983 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5984 situations.
5985
5986 @table @code
5987 @kindex compare-sections
5988 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5989 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5990 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5991 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5992 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5993 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5994 remote request.
5995 @end table
5996
5997 @node Auto Display
5998 @section Automatic Display
5999 @cindex automatic display
6000 @cindex display of expressions
6001
6002 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6003 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6004 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6005 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6006 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6007 The automatic display looks like this:
6008
6009 @smallexample
6010 2: foo = 38
6011 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6012 @end smallexample
6013
6014 @noindent
6015 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6016 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6017 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6018 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6019 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6020 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6021
6022 @table @code
6023 @kindex display
6024 @item display @var{expr}
6025 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6026 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6027
6028 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6029
6030 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6031 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6032 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6033 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6034 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6035
6036 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6037 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6038 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6039 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6040 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6041 @end table
6042
6043 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6044 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6045 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6046
6047 @table @code
6048 @kindex delete display
6049 @kindex undisplay
6050 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6051 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6052 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6053
6054 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6055 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6056
6057 @kindex disable display
6058 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6059 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6060 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6061 enabled again later.
6062
6063 @kindex enable display
6064 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6065 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6066 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6067
6068 @item display
6069 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6070 done when your program stops.
6071
6072 @kindex info display
6073 @item info display
6074 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6075 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6076 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6077 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6078 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6079 @end table
6080
6081 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6082 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6083 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6084 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6085 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6086 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6087 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6088 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6089 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6090 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6091 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6092
6093 @node Print Settings
6094 @section Print Settings
6095
6096 @cindex format options
6097 @cindex print settings
6098 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6099 and symbols are printed.
6100
6101 @noindent
6102 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6103
6104 @table @code
6105 @kindex set print
6106 @item set print address
6107 @itemx set print address on
6108 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6109 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6110 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6111 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6112 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6113 @code{set print address on}:
6114
6115 @smallexample
6116 @group
6117 (@value{GDBP}) f
6118 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6119 at input.c:530
6120 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6121 @end group
6122 @end smallexample
6123
6124 @item set print address off
6125 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6126 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6127
6128 @smallexample
6129 @group
6130 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6131 (@value{GDBP}) f
6132 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6133 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6134 @end group
6135 @end smallexample
6136
6137 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6138 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6139 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6140 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6141
6142 @kindex show print
6143 @item show print address
6144 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6145 @end table
6146
6147 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6148 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6149 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6150 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6151 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6152 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6153 it prints a symbolic address:
6154
6155 @table @code
6156 @item set print symbol-filename on
6157 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6158 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6159 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6160 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6161
6162 @item set print symbol-filename off
6163 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6164 default.
6165
6166 @item show print symbol-filename
6167 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6168 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6169 @end table
6170
6171 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6172 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6173 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6174
6175 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6176 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6177
6178 @table @code
6179 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6180 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6181 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6182 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6183 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6184 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6185
6186 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6187 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6188 symbolic address.
6189 @end table
6190
6191 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6192 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6193 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6194 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6195 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6196 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6197 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6198 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6199
6200 @smallexample
6201 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6202 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6203 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6204 @end smallexample
6205
6206 @quotation
6207 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6208 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6209 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6210 @end quotation
6211
6212 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6213
6214 @table @code
6215 @item set print array
6216 @itemx set print array on
6217 @cindex pretty print arrays
6218 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6219 but uses more space. The default is off.
6220
6221 @item set print array off
6222 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6223
6224 @item show print array
6225 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6226 arrays.
6227
6228 @cindex print array indexes
6229 @item set print array-indexes
6230 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6231 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6232 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6233 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6234
6235 @item set print array-indexes off
6236 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6237
6238 @item show print array-indexes
6239 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6240 arrays.
6241
6242 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6243 @cindex number of array elements to print
6244 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6245 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6246 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6247 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6248 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6249 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6250 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6251
6252 @item show print elements
6253 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6254 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6255
6256 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6257 @cindex printing frame argument values
6258 @cindex print all frame argument values
6259 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6260 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6261 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6262 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6263 values are:
6264
6265 @table @code
6266 @item all
6267 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6268
6269 @item scalars
6270 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6271 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6272 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6273
6274 @smallexample
6275 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6276 at frame-args.c:23
6277 @end smallexample
6278
6279 @item none
6280 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6281 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6282
6283 @smallexample
6284 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6285 at frame-args.c:23
6286 @end smallexample
6287 @end table
6288
6289 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6290 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6291 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6292 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6293 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6294 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6295 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6296 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6297
6298 @item show print frame-arguments
6299 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6300
6301 @item set print repeats
6302 @cindex repeated array elements
6303 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6304 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6305 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6306 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6307 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6308 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6309 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6310
6311 @item show print repeats
6312 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6313 elements.
6314
6315 @item set print null-stop
6316 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6317 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6318 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6319 contain only short strings.
6320 The default is off.
6321
6322 @item show print null-stop
6323 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6324 @sc{null} character.
6325
6326 @item set print pretty on
6327 @cindex print structures in indented form
6328 @cindex indentation in structure display
6329 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6330 per line, like this:
6331
6332 @smallexample
6333 @group
6334 $1 = @{
6335 next = 0x0,
6336 flags = @{
6337 sweet = 1,
6338 sour = 1
6339 @},
6340 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6341 @}
6342 @end group
6343 @end smallexample
6344
6345 @item set print pretty off
6346 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6347
6348 @smallexample
6349 @group
6350 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6351 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6352 @end group
6353 @end smallexample
6354
6355 @noindent
6356 This is the default format.
6357
6358 @item show print pretty
6359 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6360
6361 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6362 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6363 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6364 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6365 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6366 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6367 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6368 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6369
6370 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6371 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6372 international character sets, and is the default.
6373
6374 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6375 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6376
6377 @item set print union on
6378 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6379 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6380 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6381
6382 @item set print union off
6383 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6384 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6385 instead.
6386
6387 @item show print union
6388 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6389 structures and other unions.
6390
6391 For example, given the declarations
6392
6393 @smallexample
6394 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6395 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6396 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6397 Bug_forms;
6398
6399 struct thing @{
6400 Species it;
6401 union @{
6402 Tree_forms tree;
6403 Bug_forms bug;
6404 @} form;
6405 @};
6406
6407 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6408 @end smallexample
6409
6410 @noindent
6411 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6412
6413 @smallexample
6414 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6415 @end smallexample
6416
6417 @noindent
6418 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6419
6420 @smallexample
6421 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6422 @end smallexample
6423
6424 @noindent
6425 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6426 and in Pascal.
6427 @end table
6428
6429 @need 1000
6430 @noindent
6431 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6432
6433 @table @code
6434 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6435 @item set print demangle
6436 @itemx set print demangle on
6437 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6438 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6439 linkage. The default is on.
6440
6441 @item show print demangle
6442 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6443
6444 @item set print asm-demangle
6445 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6446 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6447 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6448 The default is off.
6449
6450 @item show print asm-demangle
6451 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6452 or demangled form.
6453
6454 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6455 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6456 @kindex set demangle-style
6457 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6458 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6459 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6460
6461 @table @code
6462 @item auto
6463 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6464
6465 @item gnu
6466 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6467 This is the default.
6468
6469 @item hp
6470 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6471
6472 @item lucid
6473 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6474
6475 @item arm
6476 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6477 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6478 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6479 require further enhancement to permit that.
6480
6481 @end table
6482 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6483
6484 @item show demangle-style
6485 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6486
6487 @item set print object
6488 @itemx set print object on
6489 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6490 @cindex display derived types
6491 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6492 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6493 the virtual function table.
6494
6495 @item set print object off
6496 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6497 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6498
6499 @item show print object
6500 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6501
6502 @item set print static-members
6503 @itemx set print static-members on
6504 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6505 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6506
6507 @item set print static-members off
6508 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6509
6510 @item show print static-members
6511 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6512
6513 @item set print pascal_static-members
6514 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6515 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6516 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6517 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6518
6519 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6520 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6521
6522 @item show print pascal_static-members
6523 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6524
6525 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6526 @item set print vtbl
6527 @itemx set print vtbl on
6528 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6529 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6530 @cindex VTBL display
6531 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6532 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6533 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6534
6535 @item set print vtbl off
6536 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6537
6538 @item show print vtbl
6539 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6540 @end table
6541
6542 @node Value History
6543 @section Value History
6544
6545 @cindex value history
6546 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6547 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6548 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6549 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6550 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6551 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6552 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6553 symbol table.
6554
6555 @cindex @code{$}
6556 @cindex @code{$$}
6557 @cindex history number
6558 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6559 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6560 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6561 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6562 history number.
6563
6564 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6565 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6566 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6567 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6568 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6569 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6570 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6571
6572 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6573 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6574
6575 @smallexample
6576 p *$
6577 @end smallexample
6578
6579 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6580 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6581
6582 @smallexample
6583 p *$.next
6584 @end smallexample
6585
6586 @noindent
6587 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6588 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6589
6590 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6591 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6592
6593 @smallexample
6594 print x
6595 set x=5
6596 @end smallexample
6597
6598 @noindent
6599 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6600 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6601
6602 @table @code
6603 @kindex show values
6604 @item show values
6605 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6606 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6607 values} does not change the history.
6608
6609 @item show values @var{n}
6610 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6611
6612 @item show values +
6613 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6614 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6615 @end table
6616
6617 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6618 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6619
6620 @node Convenience Vars
6621 @section Convenience Variables
6622
6623 @cindex convenience variables
6624 @cindex user-defined variables
6625 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6626 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6627 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6628 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6629 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6630
6631 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6632 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6633 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6634 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6635 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6636
6637 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6638 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6639 For example:
6640
6641 @smallexample
6642 set $foo = *object_ptr
6643 @end smallexample
6644
6645 @noindent
6646 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6647 @code{object_ptr}.
6648
6649 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6650 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6651 value with another assignment at any time.
6652
6653 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6654 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6655 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6656 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6657
6658 @table @code
6659 @kindex show convenience
6660 @cindex show all user variables
6661 @item show convenience
6662 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6663 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6664
6665 @kindex init-if-undefined
6666 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6667 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6668 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6669 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6670 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6671 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6672 override default values used in a command script.
6673
6674 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6675 any side-effects do not occur.
6676 @end table
6677
6678 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6679 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6680 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6681
6682 @smallexample
6683 set $i = 0
6684 print bar[$i++]->contents
6685 @end smallexample
6686
6687 @noindent
6688 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6689
6690 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6691 values likely to be useful.
6692
6693 @table @code
6694 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6695 @item $_
6696 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6697 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6698 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6699 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6700 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6701 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6702 to the type of @code{$__}.
6703
6704 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6705 @item $__
6706 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6707 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6708 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6709
6710 @item $_exitcode
6711 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6712 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6713 the program being debugged terminates.
6714 @end table
6715
6716 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6717 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6718 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6719
6720 @node Registers
6721 @section Registers
6722
6723 @cindex registers
6724 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6725 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6726 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6727 your machine.
6728
6729 @table @code
6730 @kindex info registers
6731 @item info registers
6732 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6733 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6734
6735 @kindex info all-registers
6736 @cindex floating point registers
6737 @item info all-registers
6738 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6739 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6740
6741 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6742 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6743 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6744 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6745 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6746 @end table
6747
6748 @cindex stack pointer register
6749 @cindex program counter register
6750 @cindex process status register
6751 @cindex frame pointer register
6752 @cindex standard registers
6753 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6754 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6755 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6756 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6757 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6758 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6759 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6760 you could print the program counter in hex with
6761
6762 @smallexample
6763 p/x $pc
6764 @end smallexample
6765
6766 @noindent
6767 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6768
6769 @smallexample
6770 x/i $pc
6771 @end smallexample
6772
6773 @noindent
6774 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6775 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6776 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6777 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6778 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6779 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6780 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6781
6782 @smallexample
6783 set $sp += 4
6784 @end smallexample
6785
6786 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6787 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6788 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6789 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6790 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6791 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6792 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6793
6794 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6795 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6796 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6797 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6798 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6799 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6800 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6801
6802 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6803 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6804 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6805 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6806 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6807 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6808 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6809 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6810 prints the data in both formats.
6811
6812 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6813 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6814 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6815 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6816 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6817 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6818 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6819
6820 @smallexample
6821 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6822 $1 = @{
6823 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6824 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6825 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6826 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6827 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6828 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6829 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6830 @}
6831 @end smallexample
6832
6833 @noindent
6834 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6835 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6836 value to a @code{struct} member:
6837
6838 @smallexample
6839 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6840 @end smallexample
6841
6842 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6843 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
6844 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6845 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6846 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6847 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6848
6849 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6850 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6851 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6852 frame makes no difference.
6853
6854 @node Floating Point Hardware
6855 @section Floating Point Hardware
6856 @cindex floating point
6857
6858 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6859 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6860
6861 @table @code
6862 @kindex info float
6863 @item info float
6864 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6865 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6866 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6867 the ARM and x86 machines.
6868 @end table
6869
6870 @node Vector Unit
6871 @section Vector Unit
6872 @cindex vector unit
6873
6874 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6875 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6876
6877 @table @code
6878 @kindex info vector
6879 @item info vector
6880 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6881 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6882 @end table
6883
6884 @node OS Information
6885 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
6886 @cindex OS information
6887
6888 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6889 you debug your program.
6890
6891 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6892 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6893 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6894 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6895 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6896 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6897 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6898 structure.
6899
6900 @table @code
6901 @item info udot
6902 @kindex info udot
6903 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6904 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6905 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6906 the @code{examine} command.
6907 @end table
6908
6909 @cindex auxiliary vector
6910 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6911 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6912 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6913 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6914 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6915 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6916 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6917 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6918 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6919 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6920 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6921 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6922
6923 @table @code
6924 @kindex info auxv
6925 @item info auxv
6926 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6927 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6928 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6929 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6930 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6931 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6932 an unrecognized tag.
6933 @end table
6934
6935
6936 @node Memory Region Attributes
6937 @section Memory Region Attributes
6938 @cindex memory region attributes
6939
6940 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6941 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6942 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6943 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6944 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6945 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6946 user can override the fetched regions.
6947
6948 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6949 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6950 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6951 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6952 all memory.
6953
6954 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6955 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6956
6957 @table @code
6958 @kindex mem
6959 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6960 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6961 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6962 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6963 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
6964 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6965
6966 @item mem auto
6967 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6968 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6969
6970 @kindex delete mem
6971 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6972 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6973 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6974
6975 @kindex disable mem
6976 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6977 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6978 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6979 It may be enabled again later.
6980
6981 @kindex enable mem
6982 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6983 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6984
6985 @kindex info mem
6986 @item info mem
6987 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6988 for each region:
6989
6990 @table @emph
6991 @item Memory Region Number
6992 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6993 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6994 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6995
6996 @item Lo Address
6997 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6998
6999 @item Hi Address
7000 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7001
7002 @item Attributes
7003 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7004 @end table
7005 @end table
7006
7007
7008 @subsection Attributes
7009
7010 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7011 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7012 write accesses to a memory region.
7013
7014 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7015 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7016 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7017
7018 @table @code
7019 @item ro
7020 Memory is read only.
7021 @item wo
7022 Memory is write only.
7023 @item rw
7024 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7025 @end table
7026
7027 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7028 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7029 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7030 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7031 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7032
7033 @table @code
7034 @item 8
7035 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7036 @item 16
7037 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7038 @item 32
7039 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7040 @item 64
7041 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7042 @end table
7043
7044 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7045 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7046 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7047 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7048 @c
7049 @c @table @code
7050 @c @item hwbreak
7051 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7052 @c @item swbreak (default)
7053 @c @end table
7054
7055 @subsubsection Data Cache
7056 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7057 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7058 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7059 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7060 registers.
7061
7062 @table @code
7063 @item cache
7064 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7065 @item nocache
7066 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7067 @end table
7068
7069 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7070 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7071 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7072 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7073 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7074
7075 @table @code
7076 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7077 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7078 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7079 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7080 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7081 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7082 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7083 The default value is @code{on}.
7084 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7085 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7086 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7087 @end table
7088
7089
7090 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7091 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7092 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7093 @c
7094 @c @table @code
7095 @c @item verify
7096 @c @item noverify (default)
7097 @c @end table
7098
7099 @node Dump/Restore Files
7100 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7101 @cindex dump/restore files
7102 @cindex append data to a file
7103 @cindex dump data to a file
7104 @cindex restore data from a file
7105
7106 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7107 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7108 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7109 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7110 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7111 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7112 files.
7113
7114 @table @code
7115
7116 @kindex dump
7117 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7118 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7119 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7120 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7121
7122 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7123 @table @code
7124 @item binary
7125 Raw binary form.
7126 @item ihex
7127 Intel hex format.
7128 @item srec
7129 Motorola S-record format.
7130 @item tekhex
7131 Tektronix Hex format.
7132 @end table
7133
7134 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7135 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7136 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7137 form.
7138
7139 @kindex append
7140 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7141 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7142 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7143 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7144 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7145
7146 @kindex restore
7147 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7148 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7149 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7150 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7151 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7152
7153 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7154 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7155 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7156 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7157 from that location.
7158
7159 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7160 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7161 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7162 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7163
7164 @end table
7165
7166 @node Core File Generation
7167 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7168 @cindex dump core from inferior
7169
7170 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7171 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7172 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7173 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7174 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7175 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7176 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7177
7178 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7179 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7180 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7181
7182 @table @code
7183 @kindex gcore
7184 @kindex generate-core-file
7185 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7186 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7187 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7188 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7189 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7190 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7191
7192 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7193 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7194 @end table
7195
7196 @node Character Sets
7197 @section Character Sets
7198 @cindex character sets
7199 @cindex charset
7200 @cindex translating between character sets
7201 @cindex host character set
7202 @cindex target character set
7203
7204 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7205 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7206 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7207 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7208 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7209 @dfn{target character set}.
7210
7211 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7212 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7213 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7214 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7215 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7216 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7217 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7218 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7219 character and string literals in expressions.
7220
7221 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7222 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7223 target-charset} command, described below.
7224
7225 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7226 support:
7227
7228 @table @code
7229 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7230 @kindex set target-charset
7231 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7232 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7233 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7234 list the target character sets it supports.
7235 @end table
7236
7237 @table @code
7238 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7239 @kindex set host-charset
7240 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7241
7242 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7243 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7244 @code{set host-charset} command.
7245
7246 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7247 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7248 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7249 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7250 list the host character sets it supports.
7251
7252 @item set charset @var{charset}
7253 @kindex set charset
7254 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7255 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7256 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7257 for both host and target.
7258
7259
7260 @item show charset
7261 @kindex show charset
7262 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7263
7264 @itemx show host-charset
7265 @kindex show host-charset
7266 Show the name of the current host charset.
7267
7268 @itemx show target-charset
7269 @kindex show target-charset
7270 Show the name of the current target charset.
7271
7272 @end table
7273
7274 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7275 sets:
7276
7277 @table @code
7278
7279 @item ASCII
7280 @cindex ASCII character set
7281 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7282 character set.
7283
7284 @item ISO-8859-1
7285 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7286 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7287 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7288 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7289 this as its host character set.
7290
7291 @item EBCDIC-US
7292 @itemx IBM1047
7293 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7294 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7295 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7296 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7297 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7298
7299 @end table
7300
7301 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7302 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7303 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7304
7305 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7306 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7307 @file{charset-test.c}:
7308
7309 @smallexample
7310 #include <stdio.h>
7311
7312 char ascii_hello[]
7313 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7314 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7315 char ibm1047_hello[]
7316 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7317 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7318
7319 main ()
7320 @{
7321 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7322 @}
7323 @end smallexample
7324
7325 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7326 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7327 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7328
7329 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7330
7331 @smallexample
7332 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7333 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7334 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7335 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7336 @dots{}
7337 (@value{GDBP})
7338 @end smallexample
7339
7340 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7341 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7342 strings:
7343
7344 @smallexample
7345 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7346 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7347 (@value{GDBP})
7348 @end smallexample
7349
7350 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7351 initial character set:
7352 @smallexample
7353 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7354 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7355 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7356 (@value{GDBP})
7357 @end smallexample
7358
7359 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7360 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7361 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7362 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7363 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7364
7365 @smallexample
7366 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7367 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7368 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7369 $2 = 72 'H'
7370 (@value{GDBP})
7371 @end smallexample
7372
7373 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7374 literals you use in expressions:
7375
7376 @smallexample
7377 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7378 $3 = 43 '+'
7379 (@value{GDBP})
7380 @end smallexample
7381
7382 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7383 character.
7384
7385 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7386 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7387 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7388
7389 @smallexample
7390 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7391 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7392 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7393 $5 = 200 '\310'
7394 (@value{GDBP})
7395 @end smallexample
7396
7397 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7398 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7399
7400 @smallexample
7401 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7402 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7403 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7404 @end smallexample
7405
7406 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7407 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7408 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7409 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7410 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7411
7412 @smallexample
7413 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7414 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7415 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7416 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7417 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7418 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7419 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7420 $7 = 72 '\110'
7421 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7422 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7423 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7424 $9 = 200 'H'
7425 (@value{GDBP})
7426 @end smallexample
7427
7428 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7429 string literals you use in expressions:
7430
7431 @smallexample
7432 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7433 $10 = 78 '+'
7434 (@value{GDBP})
7435 @end smallexample
7436
7437 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7438 character.
7439
7440 @node Caching Remote Data
7441 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7442 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7443
7444 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7445 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7446 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7447 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7448 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7449 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7450 volatile registers are in use.
7451
7452 @table @code
7453 @kindex set remotecache
7454 @item set remotecache on
7455 @itemx set remotecache off
7456 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7457 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7458
7459 @kindex show remotecache
7460 @item show remotecache
7461 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7462
7463 @kindex info dcache
7464 @item info dcache
7465 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7466 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7467 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7468 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7469 the data cache operation.
7470 @end table
7471
7472
7473 @node Macros
7474 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7475
7476 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7477 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7478 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7479 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7480 where it was defined.
7481
7482 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7483 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7484 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7485 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7486
7487 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7488 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7489 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7490 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7491 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7492 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7493 see @ref{List}.
7494
7495 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7496 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7497 variable-arity macros.
7498
7499 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7500 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7501 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7502
7503 @table @code
7504
7505 @kindex macro expand
7506 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7507 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7508 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7509 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7510 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7511 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7512 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7513 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7514 it can be any string of tokens.
7515
7516 @kindex macro exp1
7517 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7518 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7519 @cindex expand macro once
7520 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7521 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7522 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7523 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7524 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7525 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7526 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7527 can be any string of tokens.
7528
7529 @kindex info macro
7530 @cindex macro definition, showing
7531 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7532 @item info macro @var{macro}
7533 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7534 source location where that definition was established.
7535
7536 @kindex macro define
7537 @cindex user-defined macros
7538 @cindex defining macros interactively
7539 @cindex macros, user-defined
7540 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7541 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7542 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7543 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7544 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7545 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7546 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7547 given in @var{arglist}.
7548
7549 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7550 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7551 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7552 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7553 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7554
7555 @kindex macro undef
7556 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7557 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7558 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7559 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7560 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7561 debugged.
7562
7563 @kindex macro list
7564 @item macro list
7565 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7566 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7567 @end table
7568
7569 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7570 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7571 show our source files:
7572
7573 @smallexample
7574 $ cat sample.c
7575 #include <stdio.h>
7576 #include "sample.h"
7577
7578 #define M 42
7579 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7580
7581 main ()
7582 @{
7583 #define N 28
7584 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7585 #undef N
7586 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7587 #define N 1729
7588 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7589 @}
7590 $ cat sample.h
7591 #define Q <
7592 $
7593 @end smallexample
7594
7595 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7596 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7597 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7598 information.
7599
7600 @smallexample
7601 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7602 $
7603 @end smallexample
7604
7605 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7606
7607 @smallexample
7608 $ gdb -nw sample
7609 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7610 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7611 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7612 (@value{GDBP})
7613 @end smallexample
7614
7615 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7616 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7617 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7618
7619 @smallexample
7620 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7621 3
7622 4 #define M 42
7623 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7624 6
7625 7 main ()
7626 8 @{
7627 9 #define N 28
7628 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7629 11 #undef N
7630 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7631 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7632 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7633 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7634 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7635 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7636 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7637 #define Q <
7638 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7639 expands to: (42 + 1)
7640 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7641 expands to: once (M + 1)
7642 (@value{GDBP})
7643 @end smallexample
7644
7645 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7646 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7647 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7648 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7649
7650 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7651 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7652
7653 @smallexample
7654 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7655 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7656 (@value{GDBP}) run
7657 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7658
7659 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7660 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7661 (@value{GDBP})
7662 @end smallexample
7663
7664 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7665
7666 @smallexample
7667 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7668 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7669 #define N 28
7670 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7671 expands to: 28 < 42
7672 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7673 $1 = 1
7674 (@value{GDBP})
7675 @end smallexample
7676
7677 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7678 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7679 thereof) in force at each point:
7680
7681 @smallexample
7682 (@value{GDBP}) next
7683 Hello, world!
7684 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7685 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7686 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7687 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7688 (@value{GDBP}) next
7689 We're so creative.
7690 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7691 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7692 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7693 #define N 1729
7694 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7695 expands to: 1729 < 42
7696 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7697 $2 = 0
7698 (@value{GDBP})
7699 @end smallexample
7700
7701
7702 @node Tracepoints
7703 @chapter Tracepoints
7704 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7705 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7706
7707 @cindex tracepoints
7708 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7709 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7710 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7711 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7712 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7713 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7714 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7715
7716 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7717 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7718 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7719 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7720 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7721 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7722 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7723 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7724 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7725 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7726 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7727
7728 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7729 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7730 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7731 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7732 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7733 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7734 Packets}.
7735
7736 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7737
7738 @menu
7739 * Set Tracepoints::
7740 * Analyze Collected Data::
7741 * Tracepoint Variables::
7742 @end menu
7743
7744 @node Set Tracepoints
7745 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7746
7747 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7748 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7749 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7750 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7751 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7752 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7753 work on.
7754
7755 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7756 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7757 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7758 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7759 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7760 tracepoint was hit.
7761
7762 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7763 conditions and actions.
7764
7765 @menu
7766 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7767 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7768 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7769 * Tracepoint Actions::
7770 * Listing Tracepoints::
7771 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7772 @end menu
7773
7774 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7775 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7776
7777 @table @code
7778 @cindex set tracepoint
7779 @kindex trace
7780 @item trace
7781 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7782 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7783 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7784 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7785 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7786 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7787 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7788 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7789 running.
7790
7791 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7792
7793 @smallexample
7794 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7795
7796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7797
7798 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7799
7800 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7801
7802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7803 @end smallexample
7804
7805 @noindent
7806 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7807
7808 @vindex $tpnum
7809 @cindex last tracepoint number
7810 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7811 @cindex tracepoint number
7812 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7813 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7814
7815 @kindex delete tracepoint
7816 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7817 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7818 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7819 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7820
7821 Examples:
7822
7823 @smallexample
7824 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7825
7826 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7827 @end smallexample
7828
7829 @noindent
7830 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7831 @end table
7832
7833 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7834 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7835
7836 @table @code
7837 @kindex disable tracepoint
7838 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7839 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7840 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7841 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7842 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7843
7844 @kindex enable tracepoint
7845 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7846 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7847 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7848 run.
7849 @end table
7850
7851 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7852 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7853
7854 @table @code
7855 @kindex passcount
7856 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7857 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7858 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7859 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7860 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7861 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7862 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7863 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7864 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7865 user.
7866
7867 Examples:
7868
7869 @smallexample
7870 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7871 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7872
7873 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7874 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7875 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7876 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7877 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7878 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7879 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7880 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7881 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7882 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7883 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7884 @end smallexample
7885 @end table
7886
7887 @node Tracepoint Actions
7888 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7889
7890 @table @code
7891 @kindex actions
7892 @cindex tracepoint actions
7893 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7894 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7895 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7896 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7897 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7898 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7899 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7900 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7901 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7902 @code{while-stepping}.
7903
7904 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7905 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7906 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7907
7908 @smallexample
7909 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7910
7911 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7912
7913 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7914 @end smallexample
7915
7916 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7917 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7918 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7919 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7920 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7921 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7922 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7923 @code{end} command.
7924
7925 @smallexample
7926 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7927 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7928 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7929 > collect bar,baz
7930 > collect $regs
7931 > while-stepping 12
7932 > collect $fp, $sp
7933 > end
7934 end
7935 @end smallexample
7936
7937 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7938 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7939 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7940 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7941 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7942 special arguments are supported:
7943
7944 @table @code
7945 @item $regs
7946 collect all registers
7947
7948 @item $args
7949 collect all function arguments
7950
7951 @item $locals
7952 collect all local variables.
7953 @end table
7954
7955 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7956 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7957 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7958
7959 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7960 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7961
7962 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7963 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7964 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7965 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7966 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7967 its own @code{end} command):
7968
7969 @smallexample
7970 > while-stepping 12
7971 > collect $regs, myglobal
7972 > end
7973 >
7974 @end smallexample
7975
7976 @noindent
7977 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7978 @code{stepping}.
7979 @end table
7980
7981 @node Listing Tracepoints
7982 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7983
7984 @table @code
7985 @kindex info tracepoints
7986 @kindex info tp
7987 @cindex information about tracepoints
7988 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7989 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7990 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7991 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7992 shown:
7993
7994 @itemize @bullet
7995 @item
7996 its number
7997 @item
7998 whether it is enabled or disabled
7999 @item
8000 its address
8001 @item
8002 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8003 @item
8004 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8005 @item
8006 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8007 @item
8008 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8009 @end itemize
8010
8011 @smallexample
8012 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8013 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8014 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8015 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8016 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8017 (@value{GDBP})
8018 @end smallexample
8019
8020 @noindent
8021 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8022 @end table
8023
8024 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8025 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8026
8027 @table @code
8028 @kindex tstart
8029 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8030 @cindex collected data discarded
8031 @item tstart
8032 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8033 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8034 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8035 experiment.
8036
8037 @kindex tstop
8038 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8039 @item tstop
8040 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8041 stops collecting data.
8042
8043 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8044 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8045 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8046
8047 @kindex tstatus
8048 @cindex status of trace data collection
8049 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8050 @item tstatus
8051 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8052 collection.
8053 @end table
8054
8055 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8056
8057 @smallexample
8058 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8059 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8060 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8061 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8062 > while-stepping 11
8063 > collect $regs
8064 > end
8065 > end
8066 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8067 [time passes @dots{}]
8068 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8069 @end smallexample
8070
8071
8072 @node Analyze Collected Data
8073 @section Using the Collected Data
8074
8075 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8076 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8077 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8078 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8079 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8080 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8081 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8082 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8083 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8084 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8085 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8086 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8087 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8088 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8089 the buffer will fail.
8090
8091 @menu
8092 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8093 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8094 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8095 @end menu
8096
8097 @node tfind
8098 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8099
8100 @kindex tfind
8101 @cindex select trace snapshot
8102 @cindex find trace snapshot
8103 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8104 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8105 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8106 snapshot is selected.
8107
8108 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8109
8110 @table @code
8111 @item tfind start
8112 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8113 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8114
8115 @item tfind none
8116 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8117
8118 @item tfind end
8119 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8120
8121 @item tfind
8122 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8123
8124 @item tfind -
8125 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8126 retracing earlier steps.
8127
8128 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8129 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8130 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8131 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8132 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8133
8134 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8135 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8136 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8137 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8138 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8139
8140 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8141 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8142 addresses.
8143
8144 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8145 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8146 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8147
8148 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8149 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8150 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8151 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8152 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8153 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8154 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8155 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8156 @end table
8157
8158 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8159 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8160 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8161 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8162 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8163 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8164 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8165 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8166 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8167 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8168 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8169 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8170 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8171 tracepoint as the current one.
8172
8173 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8174 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8175 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8176 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8177 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8178
8179 @smallexample
8180 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8181 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8182 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8183 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8184 > tfind
8185 > end
8186
8187 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8188 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8189 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8190 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8191 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8192 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8193 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8194 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8195 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8196 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8197 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8198 @end smallexample
8199
8200 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8201 the buffer:
8202
8203 @smallexample
8204 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8205 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8206 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8207 > tfind line
8208 > end
8209
8210 Frame 0, X = 1
8211 Frame 7, X = 2
8212 Frame 13, X = 255
8213 @end smallexample
8214
8215 @node tdump
8216 @subsection @code{tdump}
8217 @kindex tdump
8218 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8219 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8220
8221 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8222 the current trace snapshot.
8223
8224 @smallexample
8225 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8226 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8227 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8228 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8229 > end
8230
8231 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8232
8233 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8234 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8235 at gdb_test.c:444
8236 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8237
8238 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8239 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8240 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8241 d1 0x18 24
8242 d2 0x80 128
8243 d3 0x33 51
8244 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8245 d5 0x22 34
8246 d6 0xe0 224
8247 d7 0x380035 3670069
8248 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8249 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8250 a2 0x100 256
8251 a3 0x322000 3284992
8252 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8253 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8254 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8255 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8256 ps 0x0 0
8257 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8258 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8259 fpstatus 0x0 0
8260 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8261 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8262 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8263 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8264 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8265 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8266 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8267 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8268 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8269
8270 (@value{GDBP})
8271 @end smallexample
8272
8273 @node save-tracepoints
8274 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8275 @kindex save-tracepoints
8276 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8277
8278 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8279 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8280 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8281 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8282 Files}).
8283
8284 @node Tracepoint Variables
8285 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8286 @cindex tracepoint variables
8287 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8288
8289 @table @code
8290 @vindex $trace_frame
8291 @item (int) $trace_frame
8292 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8293 snapshot is selected.
8294
8295 @vindex $tracepoint
8296 @item (int) $tracepoint
8297 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8298
8299 @vindex $trace_line
8300 @item (int) $trace_line
8301 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8302
8303 @vindex $trace_file
8304 @item (char []) $trace_file
8305 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8306
8307 @vindex $trace_func
8308 @item (char []) $trace_func
8309 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8310 @end table
8311
8312 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8313 use @code{output} instead.
8314
8315 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8316 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8317 data.
8318
8319 @smallexample
8320 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8321
8322 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8323 > output $trace_file
8324 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8325 > tfind
8326 > end
8327 @end smallexample
8328
8329 @node Overlays
8330 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8331 @cindex overlays
8332
8333 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8334 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8335 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8336 use overlays.
8337
8338 @menu
8339 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8340 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8341 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8342 mapped by asking the inferior.
8343 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8344 @end menu
8345
8346 @node How Overlays Work
8347 @section How Overlays Work
8348 @cindex mapped overlays
8349 @cindex unmapped overlays
8350 @cindex load address, overlay's
8351 @cindex mapped address
8352 @cindex overlay area
8353
8354 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8355 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8356 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8357 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8358 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8359
8360 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8361 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8362 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8363 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8364 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8365 largest overlay as well.
8366
8367 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8368 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8369 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8370 there.
8371
8372 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8373 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8374 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8375
8376 @smallexample
8377 @group
8378 Data Instruction Larger
8379 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8380 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8381 | | | | | |
8382 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8383 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8384 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8385 | and heap | | | | | |
8386 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8387 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8388 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8389 | | | | | |
8390 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8391 address | | | | | |
8392 | overlay | <-' | | |
8393 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8394 | | <---. | | load address
8395 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8396 | | | |
8397 +-----------+ | |
8398 +-----------+
8399 | |
8400 +-----------+
8401
8402 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8403 @end group
8404 @end smallexample
8405
8406 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8407 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8408 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8409 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8410 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8411 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8412 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8413 program and the overlay area.
8414
8415 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8416 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8417 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8418 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8419 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8420 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8421 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8422
8423 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8424 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8425 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8426
8427 @itemize @bullet
8428
8429 @item
8430 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8431 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8432 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8433 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8434
8435 @item
8436 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8437 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8438 your program's performance.
8439
8440 @item
8441 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8442 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8443 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8444 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8445 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8446 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8447 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8448
8449 @item
8450 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8451 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8452 instruction and data spaces.
8453
8454 @end itemize
8455
8456 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8457 improved in many ways:
8458
8459 @itemize @bullet
8460
8461 @item
8462 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8463 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8464 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8465 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8466 area in the usual way.
8467
8468 @item
8469 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8470 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8471
8472 @item
8473 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8474 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8475 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8476 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8477 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8478 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8479 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8480
8481 @end itemize
8482
8483
8484 @node Overlay Commands
8485 @section Overlay Commands
8486
8487 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8488 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8489 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8490 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8491 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8492 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8493
8494 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8495 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8496
8497 @table @code
8498 @item overlay off
8499 @kindex overlay
8500 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8501 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8502 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8503 overlay support is disabled.
8504
8505 @item overlay manual
8506 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8507 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8508 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8509 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8510 commands described below.
8511
8512 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8513 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8514 @cindex map an overlay
8515 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8516 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8517 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8518 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8519 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8520 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8521
8522 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8523 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8524 @cindex unmap an overlay
8525 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8526 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8527 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8528 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8529
8530 @item overlay auto
8531 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8532 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8533 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8534 Overlay Debugging}.
8535
8536 @item overlay load-target
8537 @itemx overlay load
8538 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8539 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8540 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8541 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8542 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8543 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8544
8545 @item overlay list-overlays
8546 @itemx overlay list
8547 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8548 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8549 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8550
8551 @end table
8552
8553 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8554 of the function the address falls in:
8555
8556 @smallexample
8557 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8558 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8559 @end smallexample
8560 @noindent
8561 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8562 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8563 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8564 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8565
8566 @smallexample
8567 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8568 No sections are mapped.
8569 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8570 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8571 @end smallexample
8572 @noindent
8573 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8574 name normally:
8575
8576 @smallexample
8577 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8578 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8579 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8580 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8581 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8582 @end smallexample
8583
8584 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8585 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8586 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8587 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8588 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8589
8590 @itemize @bullet
8591 @item
8592 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8593 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8594 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8595 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8596 @item
8597 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8598 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8599 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8600 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8601 breakpoints properly.
8602 @end itemize
8603
8604
8605 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8606 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8607 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8608
8609 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8610 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8611 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8612 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8613 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8614 current state of the overlays.
8615
8616 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8617 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8618
8619 @table @asis
8620
8621 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8622 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8623
8624 @smallexample
8625 struct
8626 @{
8627 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8628 unsigned long vma;
8629
8630 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8631 unsigned long size;
8632
8633 /* The overlay's load address. */
8634 unsigned long lma;
8635
8636 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8637 zero otherwise. */
8638 unsigned long mapped;
8639 @}
8640 @end smallexample
8641
8642 @item @code{_novlys}:
8643 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8644 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8645
8646 @end table
8647
8648 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8649 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8650 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8651 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8652 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8653 currently mapped.
8654
8655 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8656 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8657 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8658 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8659 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8660 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8661 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8662 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8663 are not being executed.
8664
8665 @node Overlay Sample Program
8666 @section Overlay Sample Program
8667 @cindex overlay example program
8668
8669 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8670 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8671 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8672 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8673 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8674 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8675 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8676
8677 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8678 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8679 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8680 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8681
8682 @table @file
8683 @item overlays.c
8684 The main program file.
8685 @item ovlymgr.c
8686 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8687 @item foo.c
8688 @itemx bar.c
8689 @itemx baz.c
8690 @itemx grbx.c
8691 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8692 @item d10v.ld
8693 @itemx m32r.ld
8694 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8695 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8696 @end table
8697
8698 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8699 cross-compiler like this:
8700
8701 @smallexample
8702 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8703 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8704 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8705 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8706 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8707 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8708 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8709 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8710 @end smallexample
8711
8712 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8713 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8714 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8715
8716
8717 @node Languages
8718 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8719 @cindex languages
8720
8721 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8722 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8723 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8724 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8725 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8726 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8727
8728 @cindex working language
8729 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8730 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8731 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8732 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8733 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8734 language}.
8735
8736 @menu
8737 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8738 * Show:: Displaying the language
8739 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8740 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8741 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8742 @end menu
8743
8744 @node Setting
8745 @section Switching Between Source Languages
8746
8747 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8748 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8749 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8750 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8751 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8752 are printed, etc.
8753
8754 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8755 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8756 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8757 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8758 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8759 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8760 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8761 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8762 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8763 Displaying the Language}.
8764
8765 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8766 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8767 another language. In that case, make the
8768 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8769 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8770 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8771
8772 @menu
8773 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8774 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8775 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8776 @end menu
8777
8778 @node Filenames
8779 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8780
8781 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8782 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8783
8784 @table @file
8785 @item .ada
8786 @itemx .ads
8787 @itemx .adb
8788 @itemx .a
8789 Ada source file.
8790
8791 @item .c
8792 C source file
8793
8794 @item .C
8795 @itemx .cc
8796 @itemx .cp
8797 @itemx .cpp
8798 @itemx .cxx
8799 @itemx .c++
8800 C@t{++} source file
8801
8802 @item .m
8803 Objective-C source file
8804
8805 @item .f
8806 @itemx .F
8807 Fortran source file
8808
8809 @item .mod
8810 Modula-2 source file
8811
8812 @item .s
8813 @itemx .S
8814 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8815 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8816 @end table
8817
8818 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8819 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8820
8821 @node Manually
8822 @subsection Setting the Working Language
8823
8824 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8825 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8826 your program.
8827
8828 @kindex set language
8829 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8830 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8831 a language, such as
8832 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8833 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8834
8835 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8836 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8837 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8838 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8839 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8840 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8841 command such as:
8842
8843 @smallexample
8844 print a = b + c
8845 @end smallexample
8846
8847 @noindent
8848 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8849 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8850 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8851 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8852
8853 @node Automatically
8854 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
8855
8856 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8857 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8858 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8859 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8860 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8861 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8862 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8863 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8864 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8865
8866 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8867 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8868 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8869 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8870 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8871
8872 @node Show
8873 @section Displaying the Language
8874
8875 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8876 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8877
8878 @table @code
8879 @item show language
8880 @kindex show language
8881 Display the current working language. This is the
8882 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8883 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8884
8885 @item info frame
8886 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8887 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8888 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8889 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
8890 information listed here.
8891
8892 @item info source
8893 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8894 Display the source language of this source file.
8895 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8896 information listed here.
8897 @end table
8898
8899 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8900 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8901 with a language explicitly:
8902
8903 @table @code
8904 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8905 @kindex set extension-language
8906 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8907 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8908
8909 @item info extensions
8910 @kindex info extensions
8911 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8912 @end table
8913
8914 @node Checks
8915 @section Type and Range Checking
8916
8917 @quotation
8918 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8919 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8920 section documents the intended facilities.
8921 @end quotation
8922 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8923
8924 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8925 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8926 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8927 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8928 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8929 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8930 errors when your program is running.
8931
8932 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8933 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8934 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8935 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8936 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8937 automatically based on your program's source language.
8938 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
8939 settings of supported languages.
8940
8941 @menu
8942 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8943 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8944 @end menu
8945
8946 @cindex type checking
8947 @cindex checks, type
8948 @node Type Checking
8949 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
8950
8951 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8952 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8953 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8954 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8955
8956 @smallexample
8957 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8958 @exdent but
8959 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8960 @end smallexample
8961
8962 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8963 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8964
8965 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8966 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8967 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8968 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8969 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8970 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8971 also issues a warning.
8972
8973 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8974 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8975 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8976 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8977 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8978 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8979
8980 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8981 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8982 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8983 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8984 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
8985 details on specific languages.
8986
8987 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8988
8989 @kindex set check type
8990 @kindex show check type
8991 @table @code
8992 @item set check type auto
8993 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8994 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
8995 each language.
8996
8997 @item set check type on
8998 @itemx set check type off
8999 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9000 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9001 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9002 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9003 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9004
9005 @item set check type warn
9006 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9007 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9008 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9009 numbers and structures.
9010
9011 @item show type
9012 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9013 is setting it automatically.
9014 @end table
9015
9016 @cindex range checking
9017 @cindex checks, range
9018 @node Range Checking
9019 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9020
9021 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9022 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9023 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9024 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9025 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9026
9027 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9028 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9029 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9030 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9031
9032 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9033 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9034 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9035 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9036 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9037 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9038
9039 @smallexample
9040 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9041 @end smallexample
9042
9043 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9044 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9045 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9046
9047 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9048
9049 @kindex set check range
9050 @kindex show check range
9051 @table @code
9052 @item set check range auto
9053 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9054 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9055 each language.
9056
9057 @item set check range on
9058 @itemx set check range off
9059 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9060 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9061 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9062 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9063
9064 @item set check range warn
9065 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9066 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9067 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9068 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9069 systems).
9070
9071 @item show range
9072 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9073 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9074 @end table
9075
9076 @node Supported Languages
9077 @section Supported Languages
9078
9079 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9080 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9081 @c This is false ...
9082 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9083 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9084 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9085 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9086 language.
9087
9088 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9089 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9090 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9091 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9092 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9093 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9094 language reference or tutorial.
9095
9096 @menu
9097 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9098 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9099 * Fortran:: Fortran
9100 * Pascal:: Pascal
9101 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9102 * Ada:: Ada
9103 @end menu
9104
9105 @node C
9106 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9107
9108 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9109 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9110
9111 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9112 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9113 together.
9114
9115 @cindex C@t{++}
9116 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9117 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9118 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9119 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9120 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9121 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9122 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9123
9124 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9125 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9126 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9127 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9128 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9129 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9130
9131 @menu
9132 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9133 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9134 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9135 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9136 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9137 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9138 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9139 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9140 @end menu
9141
9142 @node C Operators
9143 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9144
9145 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9146
9147 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9148 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9149 often defined on groups of types.
9150
9151 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9152
9153 @itemize @bullet
9154
9155 @item
9156 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9157 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9158
9159 @item
9160 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9161 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9162
9163 @item
9164 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9165
9166 @item
9167 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9168
9169 @end itemize
9170
9171 @noindent
9172 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9173 in order of increasing precedence:
9174
9175 @table @code
9176 @item ,
9177 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9178 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9179 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9180
9181 @item =
9182 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9183 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9184
9185 @item @var{op}=
9186 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9187 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9188 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9189 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9190 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9191
9192 @item ?:
9193 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9194 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9195 integral type.
9196
9197 @item ||
9198 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9199
9200 @item &&
9201 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9202
9203 @item |
9204 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9205
9206 @item ^
9207 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9208
9209 @item &
9210 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9211
9212 @item ==@r{, }!=
9213 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9214 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9215
9216 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9217 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9218 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9219 and non-zero for true.
9220
9221 @item <<@r{, }>>
9222 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9223
9224 @item @@
9225 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9226
9227 @item +@r{, }-
9228 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9229 pointer types.
9230
9231 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9232 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9233 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9234 integral types.
9235
9236 @item ++@r{, }--
9237 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9238 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9239 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9240 operation takes place.
9241
9242 @item *
9243 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9244 @code{++}.
9245
9246 @item &
9247 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9248
9249 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9250 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9251 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9252 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9253 stored.
9254
9255 @item -
9256 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9257 precedence as @code{++}.
9258
9259 @item !
9260 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9261 @code{++}.
9262
9263 @item ~
9264 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9265 @code{++}.
9266
9267
9268 @item .@r{, }->
9269 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9270 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9271 pointer based on the stored type information.
9272 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9273
9274 @item .*@r{, }->*
9275 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9276
9277 @item []
9278 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9279 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9280
9281 @item ()
9282 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9283
9284 @item ::
9285 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9286 and @code{class} types.
9287
9288 @item ::
9289 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9290 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9291 above.
9292 @end table
9293
9294 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9295 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9296 predefined meaning.
9297
9298 @node C Constants
9299 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9300
9301 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9302
9303 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9304 following ways:
9305
9306 @itemize @bullet
9307 @item
9308 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9309 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9310 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9311 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9312 @code{long} value.
9313
9314 @item
9315 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9316 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9317 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9318 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9319 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9320 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9321 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9322 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9323 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9324 constant.
9325
9326 @item
9327 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9328 integral equivalents.
9329
9330 @item
9331 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9332 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9333 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9334 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9335 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9336 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9337 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9338 @samp{\n} for newline.
9339
9340 @item
9341 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9342 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9343 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9344 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9345 characters.
9346
9347 @item
9348 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9349 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9350
9351 @item
9352 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9353 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9354 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9355 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9356 @end itemize
9357
9358 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9359 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9360
9361 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9362 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9363
9364 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9365 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9366 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9367 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9368 @quotation
9369 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9370 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9371 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9372 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9373 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9374 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9375 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9376 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9377 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9378 C@t{++} code.
9379 @end quotation
9380
9381 @enumerate
9382
9383 @cindex member functions
9384 @item
9385 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9386
9387 @smallexample
9388 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9389 @end smallexample
9390
9391 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9392 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9393 @item
9394 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9395 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9396 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9397 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9398
9399 @cindex call overloaded functions
9400 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9401 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9402 @item
9403 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9404 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9405 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9406 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9407 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9408 default arguments.
9409
9410 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9411 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9412 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9413 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9414 number of function arguments.
9415
9416 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9417 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9418 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9419
9420 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9421 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9422 @smallexample
9423 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9424 @end smallexample
9425
9426 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9427 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9428
9429 @cindex reference declarations
9430 @item
9431 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9432 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9433 dereferenced.
9434
9435 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9436 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9437 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9438 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9439 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9440
9441 @item
9442 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9443 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9444 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9445 necessary, for example in an expression like
9446 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9447 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9448 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9449 @end enumerate
9450
9451 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9452 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9453 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9454 invoking user-defined operators.
9455
9456 @node C Defaults
9457 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9458
9459 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9460
9461 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9462 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9463 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9464 selects the working language.
9465
9466 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9467 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9468 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9469 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9470 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9471 for further details.
9472
9473 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9474 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9475 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9476
9477 @node C Checks
9478 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9479
9480 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9481
9482 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9483 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9484 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9485
9486 @itemize @bullet
9487 @item
9488 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9489 enumerated tag.
9490
9491 @item
9492 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9493 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9494
9495 @ignore
9496 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9497 @c FIXME--beers?
9498 @item
9499 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9500 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9501 compilers.)
9502 @end ignore
9503 @end itemize
9504
9505 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9506 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9507 that is not itself an array.
9508
9509 @node Debugging C
9510 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9511
9512 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9513 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9514 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9515 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9516
9517 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9518 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9519 ,Expressions}.
9520
9521 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9522 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9523
9524 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9525
9526 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9527 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9528
9529 @table @code
9530 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9531 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9532 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9533 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9534 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}.
9535
9536 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9537 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9538 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9539 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9540 classes.
9541 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9542
9543 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9544 @item catch throw
9545 @itemx catch catch
9546 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9547 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9548
9549 @cindex inheritance
9550 @item ptype @var{typename}
9551 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9552 @var{typename}.
9553 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9554
9555 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9556 @item set print demangle
9557 @itemx show print demangle
9558 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9559 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9560 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9561 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9562 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9563
9564 @item set print object
9565 @itemx show print object
9566 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9567 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9568
9569 @item set print vtbl
9570 @itemx show print vtbl
9571 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9572 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9573 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9574 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9575
9576 @kindex set overload-resolution
9577 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9578 @item set overload-resolution on
9579 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9580 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9581 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9582 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9583 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9584 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9585
9586 @item set overload-resolution off
9587 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9588 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9589 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9590 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9591 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9592 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9593 argument types.
9594
9595 @kindex show overload-resolution
9596 @item show overload-resolution
9597 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9598
9599 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9600 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9601 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9602 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9603 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9604 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9605 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9606 @end table
9607
9608 @node Decimal Floating Point
9609 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
9610 @cindex decimal floating point format
9611
9612 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
9613 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
9614 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
9615 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
9616
9617 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
9618 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
9619 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
9620 target.
9621
9622 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
9623 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
9624 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
9625
9626 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
9627 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
9628 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
9629
9630 @node Objective-C
9631 @subsection Objective-C
9632
9633 @cindex Objective-C
9634 This section provides information about some commands and command
9635 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9636 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9637 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9638
9639 @menu
9640 * Method Names in Commands::
9641 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9642 @end menu
9643
9644 @node Method Names in Commands
9645 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9646
9647 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9648 names as line specifications:
9649
9650 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9651 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9652 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9653 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9654 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9655 @itemize
9656 @item @code{clear}
9657 @item @code{break}
9658 @item @code{info line}
9659 @item @code{jump}
9660 @item @code{list}
9661 @end itemize
9662
9663 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9664
9665 @smallexample
9666 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9667 @end smallexample
9668
9669 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9670 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9671 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9672 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9673 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9674 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9675 debugged, enter:
9676
9677 @smallexample
9678 break -[Fruit create]
9679 @end smallexample
9680
9681 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9682 enter:
9683
9684 @smallexample
9685 list +[NSText initialize]
9686 @end smallexample
9687
9688 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9689 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9690 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9691 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9692
9693 @smallexample
9694 break create
9695 @end smallexample
9696
9697 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9698 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9699 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9700 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9701 none apply.
9702
9703 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9704 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9705
9706 @smallexample
9707 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9708 @end smallexample
9709
9710 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9711 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9712 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9713 @kindex print-object
9714 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9715
9716 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9717
9718 @smallexample
9719 print -[@var{object} hash]
9720 @end smallexample
9721
9722 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9723 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9724 @noindent
9725 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9726 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9727 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9728 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9729 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9730 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9731
9732 @node Fortran
9733 @subsection Fortran
9734 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9735
9736 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9737 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9738
9739 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9740 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9741 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9742 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9743 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9744 underscore.
9745
9746 @menu
9747 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9748 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9749 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9750 @end menu
9751
9752 @node Fortran Operators
9753 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9754
9755 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9756
9757 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9758 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9759 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9760
9761 @table @code
9762 @item **
9763 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9764 of the second one.
9765
9766 @item :
9767 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9768 represent a section of array.
9769 @end table
9770
9771 @node Fortran Defaults
9772 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9773
9774 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9775
9776 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9777 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9778 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9779 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9780
9781 @node Special Fortran Commands
9782 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9783
9784 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9785
9786 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9787 such as displaying common blocks.
9788
9789 @table @code
9790 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9791 @kindex info common
9792 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9793 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9794 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9795 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9796 printed.
9797 @end table
9798
9799 @node Pascal
9800 @subsection Pascal
9801
9802 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9803 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9804 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9805 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9806 syntax.
9807
9808 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9809 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9810 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9811
9812 @node Modula-2
9813 @subsection Modula-2
9814
9815 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9816
9817 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9818 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9819 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9820 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9821 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9822 table.
9823
9824 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9825 @menu
9826 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9827 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9828 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9829 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9830 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9831 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9832 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9833 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9834 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9835 @end menu
9836
9837 @node M2 Operators
9838 @subsubsection Operators
9839 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9840
9841 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9842 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9843 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9844 following definitions hold:
9845
9846 @itemize @bullet
9847
9848 @item
9849 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9850 their subranges.
9851
9852 @item
9853 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9854
9855 @item
9856 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9857
9858 @item
9859 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9860 @var{type}}.
9861
9862 @item
9863 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9864
9865 @item
9866 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9867
9868 @item
9869 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9870 @end itemize
9871
9872 @noindent
9873 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9874 increasing precedence:
9875
9876 @table @code
9877 @item ,
9878 Function argument or array index separator.
9879
9880 @item :=
9881 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9882 @var{value}.
9883
9884 @item <@r{, }>
9885 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9886 types.
9887
9888 @item <=@r{, }>=
9889 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9890 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9891 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9892
9893 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9894 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9895 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9896 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9897 comment character.
9898
9899 @item IN
9900 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9901 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9902
9903 @item OR
9904 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9905
9906 @item AND@r{, }&
9907 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9908
9909 @item @@
9910 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9911
9912 @item +@r{, }-
9913 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9914 and difference on set types.
9915
9916 @item *
9917 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9918 on set types.
9919
9920 @item /
9921 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9922 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9923
9924 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9925 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9926 precedence as @code{*}.
9927
9928 @item -
9929 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9930
9931 @item ^
9932 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9933
9934 @item NOT
9935 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9936 @code{^}.
9937
9938 @item .
9939 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9940 precedence as @code{^}.
9941
9942 @item []
9943 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9944
9945 @item ()
9946 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9947 as @code{^}.
9948
9949 @item ::@r{, }.
9950 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9951 @end table
9952
9953 @quotation
9954 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9955 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9956 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9957 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9958 @end quotation
9959
9960
9961 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9962 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
9963 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9964
9965 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9966 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9967
9968 @table @var
9969
9970 @item a
9971 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9972
9973 @item c
9974 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9975
9976 @item i
9977 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9978
9979 @item m
9980 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9981 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9982 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9983
9984 @item n
9985 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9986
9987 @item r
9988 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9989
9990 @item t
9991 represents a type.
9992
9993 @item v
9994 represents a variable.
9995
9996 @item x
9997 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9998 explanation of the function for details.
9999 @end table
10000
10001 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10002
10003 @table @code
10004 @item ABS(@var{n})
10005 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10006
10007 @item CAP(@var{c})
10008 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10009 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10010
10011 @item CHR(@var{i})
10012 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10013
10014 @item DEC(@var{v})
10015 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10016
10017 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10018 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10019 new value.
10020
10021 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10022 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10023 set.
10024
10025 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10026 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10027
10028 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10029 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10030
10031 @item INC(@var{v})
10032 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10033
10034 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10035 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10036 new value.
10037
10038 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10039 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10040 there. Returns the new set.
10041
10042 @item MAX(@var{t})
10043 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10044
10045 @item MIN(@var{t})
10046 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10047
10048 @item ODD(@var{i})
10049 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10050
10051 @item ORD(@var{x})
10052 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10053 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10054 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10055 integral, character and enumerated types.
10056
10057 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10058 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10059
10060 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10061 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10062
10063 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10064 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10065
10066 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10067 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10068 @end table
10069
10070 @quotation
10071 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10072 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10073 an error.
10074 @end quotation
10075
10076 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10077 @node M2 Constants
10078 @subsubsection Constants
10079
10080 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10081 ways:
10082
10083 @itemize @bullet
10084
10085 @item
10086 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10087 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10088 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10089 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10090
10091 @item
10092 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10093 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10094 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10095 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10096 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10097 digits.
10098
10099 @item
10100 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10101 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10102 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10103 followed by a @samp{C}.
10104
10105 @item
10106 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10107 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10108 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10109 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10110 sequences.
10111
10112 @item
10113 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10114
10115 @item
10116 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10117 @code{FALSE}.
10118
10119 @item
10120 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10121
10122 @item
10123 Set constants are not yet supported.
10124 @end itemize
10125
10126 @node M2 Types
10127 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10128 @cindex Modula-2 types
10129
10130 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10131 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10132 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10133 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10134 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10135 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10136
10137 The first example contains the following section of code:
10138
10139 @smallexample
10140 VAR
10141 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10142 r: [20..40] ;
10143 @end smallexample
10144
10145 @noindent
10146 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10147 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10148
10149 @smallexample
10150 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10151 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10152 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10153 SET OF CHAR
10154 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10155 21
10156 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10157 [20..40]
10158 @end smallexample
10159
10160 @noindent
10161 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10162
10163 @smallexample
10164 VAR
10165 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10166 @end smallexample
10167
10168 @noindent
10169 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10170
10171 @smallexample
10172 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10173 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10174 @end smallexample
10175
10176 @noindent
10177 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10178 expressions using the debugger.
10179
10180 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10181 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10182
10183 @smallexample
10184 VAR
10185 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10186 @end smallexample
10187
10188 @smallexample
10189 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10190 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10191 @end smallexample
10192
10193 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10194 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10195 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10196 above.
10197
10198 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10199
10200 @smallexample
10201 TYPE
10202 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10203 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10204 VAR
10205 s: t ;
10206 BEGIN
10207 s := blue ;
10208 @end smallexample
10209
10210 @noindent
10211 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10212 and value of a variable.
10213
10214 @smallexample
10215 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10216 $1 = blue
10217 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10218 type = [blue..yellow]
10219 @end smallexample
10220
10221 @noindent
10222 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10223 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10224 their @code{C} counterparts.
10225
10226 @smallexample
10227 VAR
10228 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10229 BEGIN
10230 s[1] := 1 ;
10231 @end smallexample
10232
10233 @smallexample
10234 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10235 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10236 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10237 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10238 @end smallexample
10239
10240 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10241 pointer types as shown in this example:
10242
10243 @smallexample
10244 VAR
10245 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10246 BEGIN
10247 NEW(s) ;
10248 s^[1] := 1 ;
10249 @end smallexample
10250
10251 @noindent
10252 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10253
10254 @smallexample
10255 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10256 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10257 @end smallexample
10258
10259 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10260 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10261 types:
10262
10263 @smallexample
10264 TYPE
10265 foo = RECORD
10266 f1: CARDINAL ;
10267 f2: CHAR ;
10268 f3: myarray ;
10269 END ;
10270
10271 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10272 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10273 VAR
10274 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10275 @end smallexample
10276
10277 @noindent
10278 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10279 below.
10280
10281 @smallexample
10282 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10283 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10284 f1 : CARDINAL;
10285 f2 : CHAR;
10286 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10287 END
10288 @end smallexample
10289
10290 @node M2 Defaults
10291 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10292 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10293
10294 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10295 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10296 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10297 selected the working language.
10298
10299 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10300 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10301 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10302 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10303
10304 @node Deviations
10305 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10306 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10307
10308 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10309 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10310
10311 @itemize @bullet
10312 @item
10313 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10314 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10315 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10316 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10317 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10318 returned a pointer.)
10319
10320 @item
10321 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10322 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10323 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10324 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10325
10326 @item
10327 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10328 argument.
10329
10330 @item
10331 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10332 @end itemize
10333
10334 @node M2 Checks
10335 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10336 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10337
10338 @quotation
10339 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10340 range checking.
10341 @end quotation
10342 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10343
10344 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10345
10346 @itemize @bullet
10347 @item
10348 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10349 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10350
10351 @item
10352 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10353 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10354 @end itemize
10355
10356 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10357 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10358
10359 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10360 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10361
10362 @node M2 Scope
10363 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10364 @cindex scope
10365 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10366 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10367 @ifinfo
10368 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10369 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10370 @end ifinfo
10371 @iftex
10372 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10373 @end iftex
10374
10375 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10376 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10377 similar syntax:
10378
10379 @smallexample
10380
10381 @var{module} . @var{id}
10382 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10383 @end smallexample
10384
10385 @noindent
10386 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10387 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10388 identifier within your program, except another module.
10389
10390 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10391 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10392 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10393 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10394
10395 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10396 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10397 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10398 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10399 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10400 @var{module}.
10401
10402 @node GDB/M2
10403 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10404
10405 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10406 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10407 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10408 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10409 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10410 analogue in Modula-2.
10411
10412 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10413 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10414 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10415 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10416 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10417 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10418
10419 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10420 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10421 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10422
10423 @node Ada
10424 @subsection Ada
10425 @cindex Ada
10426
10427 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10428 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10429 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10430 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10431 to be difficult.
10432
10433
10434 @cindex expressions in Ada
10435 @menu
10436 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10437 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10438 in @value{GDBN}.
10439 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10440 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10441 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10442 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10443 @end menu
10444
10445 @node Ada Mode Intro
10446 @subsubsection Introduction
10447 @cindex Ada mode, general
10448
10449 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10450 syntax, with some extensions.
10451 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10452
10453 @itemize @bullet
10454 @item
10455 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10456 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10457 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10458 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10459
10460 @item
10461 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10462 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10463
10464 @item
10465 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10466 @end itemize
10467
10468 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10469 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10470 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10471 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10472 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10473
10474 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10475 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10476 was translated from an Ada source file.
10477
10478 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10479 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10480 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10481 middle (to allow based literals).
10482
10483 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10484 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10485 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10486 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10487 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10488 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10489
10490 @node Omissions from Ada
10491 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10492 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10493
10494 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10495
10496 @itemize @bullet
10497 @item
10498 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10499
10500 @itemize @minus
10501 @item
10502 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10503 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10504
10505 @item
10506 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10507
10508 @item
10509 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10510
10511 @item
10512 @t{'Tag}.
10513
10514 @item
10515 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10516 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10517
10518 @item
10519 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10520 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10521
10522 @item
10523 @t{'Address}.
10524 @end itemize
10525
10526 @item
10527 The names in
10528 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10529 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10530 not currently available.
10531
10532 @item
10533 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10534 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10535 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10536 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10537 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10538 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10539 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10540 indeterminate values.
10541
10542 @item
10543 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10544 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10545 are not implemented.
10546
10547 @item
10548 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10549 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10550 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10551 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10552 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10553
10554 @smallexample
10555 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10556 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10557 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10558 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10559 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10560 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10561 @end smallexample
10562
10563 Changing a
10564 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10565 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10566 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10567 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10568 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10569 declared to have a type such as:
10570
10571 @smallexample
10572 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10573 Id : Integer;
10574 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10575 end record;
10576 @end smallexample
10577
10578 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10579 assignments:
10580
10581 @smallexample
10582 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10583 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10584 @end smallexample
10585
10586 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10587 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10588 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10589 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10590 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10591 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10592 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10593 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10594
10595 @item
10596 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10597
10598 @item
10599 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10600 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10601 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10602 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10603 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10604 the proper resolution.
10605
10606 @item
10607 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10608
10609 @item
10610 Entry calls are not implemented.
10611
10612 @item
10613 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10614 formats are not supported.
10615
10616 @item
10617 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10618 @end itemize
10619
10620 @node Additions to Ada
10621 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10622 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10623
10624 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10625 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10626
10627 @itemize @bullet
10628 @item
10629 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10630 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10631 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10632 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10633 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10634 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10635 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10636 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10637
10638 @item
10639 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10640 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10641 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10642
10643 @item
10644 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10645 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10646
10647 @item
10648 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10649 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10650 @end itemize
10651
10652 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10653 additions specific to Ada:
10654
10655 @itemize @bullet
10656 @item
10657 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10658 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10659
10660 @smallexample
10661 set x := y + 3
10662 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10663 @end smallexample
10664
10665 @item
10666 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10667 the value of its right-hand operand.
10668 This allows, for example,
10669 complex conditional breaks:
10670
10671 @smallexample
10672 break f
10673 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10674 @end smallexample
10675
10676 @item
10677 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10678 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10679 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10680 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10681 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10682 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10683 in strings. For example,
10684 @smallexample
10685 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10686 @end smallexample
10687 @noindent
10688 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10689 after each period.
10690
10691 @item
10692 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10693 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10694 to write
10695
10696 @smallexample
10697 print 'max(x, y)
10698 @end smallexample
10699
10700 @item
10701 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10702 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10703 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10704 of 3 might print as
10705
10706 @smallexample
10707 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10708 @end smallexample
10709
10710 @noindent
10711 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10712 clause.
10713
10714 @item
10715 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10716 multi-character subsequence of
10717 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10718 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10719 in place of @t{a'length}.
10720
10721 @item
10722 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10723 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10724 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10725 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10726 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10727 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10728 For example,
10729 @smallexample
10730 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10731 @end smallexample
10732
10733 @item
10734 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10735 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10736 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10737 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10738 object.
10739
10740 @end itemize
10741
10742 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10743 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10744
10745 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10746 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10747 before reaching the main procedure.
10748 As defined in the Ada Reference
10749 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10750 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10751 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10752 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10753
10754 @node Ada Glitches
10755 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10756 @cindex Ada, problems
10757
10758 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10759 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10760 @value{GDBN},
10761 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10762 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10763
10764 @itemize @bullet
10765 @item
10766 Currently, the debugger
10767 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10768 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10769 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10770 to get it printed properly.
10771
10772 @item
10773 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10774 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10775
10776 @item
10777 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10778 argument lists are treated as positional).
10779
10780 @item
10781 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10782
10783 @item
10784 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10785 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10786 the host machine.
10787
10788 @item
10789 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10790
10791 @item
10792 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10793 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10794 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10795 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10796 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10797 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10798 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10799 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10800 you can usually resolve the confusion
10801 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10802 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10803 @end itemize
10804
10805 @node Unsupported Languages
10806 @section Unsupported Languages
10807
10808 @cindex unsupported languages
10809 @cindex minimal language
10810 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10811 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10812 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10813 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10814 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10815 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10816
10817 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10818 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10819 language.
10820
10821 @node Symbols
10822 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10823
10824 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10825 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10826 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10827 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10828 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10829 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10830 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10831
10832 @cindex symbol names
10833 @cindex names of symbols
10834 @cindex quoting names
10835 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10836 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10837 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10838 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
10839 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10840 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10841 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10842 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10843
10844 @smallexample
10845 p 'foo.c'::x
10846 @end smallexample
10847
10848 @noindent
10849 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10850
10851 @table @code
10852 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10853 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10854 @kindex set case-sensitive
10855 @item set case-sensitive on
10856 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10857 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10858 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10859 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10860 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10861 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10862 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10863 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10864 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10865 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10866 case-insensitive matches.
10867
10868 @kindex show case-sensitive
10869 @item show case-sensitive
10870 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10871 lookups.
10872
10873 @kindex info address
10874 @cindex address of a symbol
10875 @item info address @var{symbol}
10876 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10877 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10878 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10879 is always stored.
10880
10881 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10882 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10883 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10884
10885 @kindex info symbol
10886 @cindex symbol from address
10887 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10888 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10889 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10890 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10891 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10892
10893 @smallexample
10894 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10895 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10896 @end smallexample
10897
10898 @noindent
10899 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10900 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10901
10902 @kindex whatis
10903 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10904 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10905 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10906 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10907 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10908 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10909 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10910 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10911 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10912 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10913 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10914
10915 @kindex ptype
10916 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10917 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10918 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10919 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10920
10921 For example, for this variable declaration:
10922
10923 @smallexample
10924 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10925 @end smallexample
10926
10927 @noindent
10928 the two commands give this output:
10929
10930 @smallexample
10931 @group
10932 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10933 type = struct complex
10934 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10935 type = struct complex @{
10936 double real;
10937 double imag;
10938 @}
10939 @end group
10940 @end smallexample
10941
10942 @noindent
10943 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10944 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10945
10946 @cindex incomplete type
10947 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10948 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10949 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10950 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10951 given these declarations:
10952
10953 @smallexample
10954 struct foo;
10955 struct foo *fooptr;
10956 @end smallexample
10957
10958 @noindent
10959 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10960
10961 @smallexample
10962 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10963 $1 = <incomplete type>
10964 @end smallexample
10965
10966 @noindent
10967 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10968 completely specified.
10969
10970 @kindex info types
10971 @item info types @var{regexp}
10972 @itemx info types
10973 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10974 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10975 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10976 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10977 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10978 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10979 name is @code{value}.
10980
10981 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10982 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10983 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10984
10985 @kindex info scope
10986 @cindex local variables
10987 @item info scope @var{location}
10988 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10989 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10990 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10991 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10992
10993 @smallexample
10994 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10995 Scope for command_line_handler:
10996 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10997 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10998 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10999 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11000 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11001 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11002 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11003 @end smallexample
11004
11005 @noindent
11006 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11007 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11008 collect}.
11009
11010 @kindex info source
11011 @item info source
11012 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11013 the function containing the current point of execution:
11014 @itemize @bullet
11015 @item
11016 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11017 @item
11018 the directory it was compiled in,
11019 @item
11020 its length, in lines,
11021 @item
11022 which programming language it is written in,
11023 @item
11024 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11025 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11026 @item
11027 whether the debugging information includes information about
11028 preprocessor macros.
11029 @end itemize
11030
11031
11032 @kindex info sources
11033 @item info sources
11034 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11035 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11036 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11037
11038 @kindex info functions
11039 @item info functions
11040 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11041
11042 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11043 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11044 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11045 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11046 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11047 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11048 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11049 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11050
11051 @kindex info variables
11052 @item info variables
11053 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11054 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11055
11056 @item info variables @var{regexp}
11057 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11058 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11059 @var{regexp}.
11060
11061 @kindex info classes
11062 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11063 @item info classes
11064 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11065 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11066 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11067 expression.
11068
11069 @kindex info selectors
11070 @item info selectors
11071 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11072 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11073 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11074 expression.
11075
11076 @ignore
11077 This was never implemented.
11078 @kindex info methods
11079 @item info methods
11080 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11081 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11082 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11083 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11084 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11085 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11086 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11087 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11088 @end ignore
11089
11090 @cindex reloading symbols
11091 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11092 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11093 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11094 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11095 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11096
11097 @table @code
11098 @kindex set symbol-reloading
11099 @item set symbol-reloading on
11100 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11101 object file with a particular name is seen again.
11102
11103 @item set symbol-reloading off
11104 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11105 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11106 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11107 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11108 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11109 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11110 name.
11111
11112 @kindex show symbol-reloading
11113 @item show symbol-reloading
11114 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11115 @end table
11116
11117 @cindex opaque data types
11118 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11119 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
11120 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11121 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11122 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11123 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11124 another source file. The default is on.
11125
11126 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11127 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11128
11129 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
11130 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11131 is printed as follows:
11132 @smallexample
11133 @{<no data fields>@}
11134 @end smallexample
11135
11136 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11137 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11138 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11139
11140 @kindex maint print symbols
11141 @cindex symbol dump
11142 @kindex maint print psymbols
11143 @cindex partial symbol dump
11144 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11145 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11146 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11147 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11148 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11149 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11150 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11151 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11152 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11153 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11154 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11155 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11156 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11157 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11158 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11159 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11160 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11161
11162 @kindex maint info symtabs
11163 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11164 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11165 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11166 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11167 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11168 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11169 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11170
11171 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11172 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11173 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11174 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11175 structure in more detail. For example:
11176
11177 @smallexample
11178 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11179 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11180 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11181 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11182 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11183 readin no
11184 fullname (null)
11185 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11186 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11187 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11188 dependencies (none)
11189 @}
11190 @}
11191 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11192 (@value{GDBP})
11193 @end smallexample
11194 @noindent
11195 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11196 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11197 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11198 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11199 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11200
11201 @smallexample
11202 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11203 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11204 line 1574.
11205 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11206 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11207 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11208 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11209 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11210 dirname (null)
11211 fullname (null)
11212 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11213 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11214 debugformat DWARF 2
11215 @}
11216 @}
11217 (@value{GDBP})
11218 @end smallexample
11219 @end table
11220
11221
11222 @node Altering
11223 @chapter Altering Execution
11224
11225 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11226 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11227 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11228 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11229 program.
11230
11231 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11232 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11233 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11234
11235 @menu
11236 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11237 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11238 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11239 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11240 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11241 * Patching:: Patching your program
11242 @end menu
11243
11244 @node Assignment
11245 @section Assignment to Variables
11246
11247 @cindex assignment
11248 @cindex setting variables
11249 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11250 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11251
11252 @smallexample
11253 print x=4
11254 @end smallexample
11255
11256 @noindent
11257 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11258 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11259 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11260 information on operators in supported languages.
11261
11262 @kindex set variable
11263 @cindex variables, setting
11264 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11265 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11266 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11267 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11268 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11269
11270 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11271 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11272 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11273 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11274 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11275 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11276 command @code{set width}:
11277
11278 @smallexample
11279 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11280 type = double
11281 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11282 $4 = 13
11283 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11284 Invalid syntax in expression.
11285 @end smallexample
11286
11287 @noindent
11288 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11289 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11290
11291 @smallexample
11292 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11293 @end smallexample
11294
11295 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11296 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11297 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11298 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11299 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11300 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11301
11302 @smallexample
11303 @group
11304 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11305 type = double
11306 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11307 $1 = 1
11308 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11309 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11310 $2 = 1
11311 (@value{GDBP}) r
11312 The program being debugged has been started already.
11313 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11314 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11315 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11316 Invalid bfd target.
11317 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11318 The current BFD target is "=4".
11319 @end group
11320 @end smallexample
11321
11322 @noindent
11323 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11324 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11325 @code{g}, use
11326
11327 @smallexample
11328 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11329 @end smallexample
11330
11331 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11332 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11333 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11334 same length or shorter.
11335 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11336 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11337
11338 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11339 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11340 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11341 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11342 and representation in memory), and
11343
11344 @smallexample
11345 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11346 @end smallexample
11347
11348 @noindent
11349 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11350
11351 @node Jumping
11352 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11353
11354 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11355 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11356 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11357
11358 @table @code
11359 @kindex jump
11360 @item jump @var{linespec}
11361 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11362 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11363 Source Lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11364 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11365 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11366 Breakpoints}.
11367
11368 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11369 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11370 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11371 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11372 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11373 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11374 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11375 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11376 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11377
11378 @item jump *@var{address}
11379 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11380 @end table
11381
11382 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11383 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11384 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11385 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11386 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11387 example,
11388
11389 @smallexample
11390 set $pc = 0x485
11391 @end smallexample
11392
11393 @noindent
11394 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11395 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11396 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11397
11398 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11399 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11400 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11401 detail.
11402
11403 @c @group
11404 @node Signaling
11405 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11406 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11407
11408 @table @code
11409 @kindex signal
11410 @item signal @var{signal}
11411 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11412 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11413 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11414 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11415
11416 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11417 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11418 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11419 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11420 signal.
11421
11422 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11423 after executing the command.
11424 @end table
11425 @c @end group
11426
11427 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11428 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11429 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11430 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11431 passes the signal directly to your program.
11432
11433
11434 @node Returning
11435 @section Returning from a Function
11436
11437 @table @code
11438 @cindex returning from a function
11439 @kindex return
11440 @item return
11441 @itemx return @var{expression}
11442 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11443 command. If you give an
11444 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11445 value.
11446 @end table
11447
11448 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11449 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11450 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11451 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11452
11453 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11454 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11455 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11456 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11457 of functions.
11458
11459 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11460 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11461 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11462 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11463 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11464
11465 @node Calling
11466 @section Calling Program Functions
11467
11468 @table @code
11469 @cindex calling functions
11470 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11471 @item print @var{expr}
11472 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11473 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11474 debugged.
11475
11476 @kindex call
11477 @item call @var{expr}
11478 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11479 returned values.
11480
11481 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11482 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11483 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11484 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11485 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11486 value history.
11487 @end table
11488
11489 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11490 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11491 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11492 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11493
11494 @table @code
11495 @item set unwindonsignal
11496 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11497 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11498 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11499 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11500 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11501 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11502 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11503 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11504 received.
11505
11506 @item show unwindonsignal
11507 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11508 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11509 @value{GDBN}.
11510 @end table
11511
11512 @cindex weak alias functions
11513 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11514 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11515 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11516 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11517 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11518 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11519 function instead.
11520
11521 @node Patching
11522 @section Patching Programs
11523
11524 @cindex patching binaries
11525 @cindex writing into executables
11526 @cindex writing into corefiles
11527
11528 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11529 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11530 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11531 patching your program's binary.
11532
11533 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11534 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11535 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11536 repairs.
11537
11538 @table @code
11539 @kindex set write
11540 @item set write on
11541 @itemx set write off
11542 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11543 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11544 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11545
11546 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11547 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11548 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11549
11550 @item show write
11551 @kindex show write
11552 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11553 as well as reading.
11554 @end table
11555
11556 @node GDB Files
11557 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11558
11559 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11560 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11561 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11562 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11563
11564 @menu
11565 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11566 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11567 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11568 @end menu
11569
11570 @node Files
11571 @section Commands to Specify Files
11572
11573 @cindex symbol table
11574 @cindex core dump file
11575
11576 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11577 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11578 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11579 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11580
11581 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11582 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11583 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11584 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11585 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11586 new files are useful.
11587
11588 @table @code
11589 @cindex executable file
11590 @kindex file
11591 @item file @var{filename}
11592 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11593 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11594 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11595 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11596 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11597 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11598 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11599 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11600
11601 @cindex unlinked object files
11602 @cindex patching object files
11603 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11604 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11605 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11606 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11607 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11608 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11609 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11610 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11611
11612 @item file
11613 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11614 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11615
11616 @kindex exec-file
11617 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11618 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11619 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11620 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11621 discard information on the executable file.
11622
11623 @kindex symbol-file
11624 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11625 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11626 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11627 table and program to run from the same file.
11628
11629 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11630 program's symbol table.
11631
11632 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11633 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11634 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11635 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11636 @value{GDBN}.
11637
11638 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11639 executing it once.
11640
11641 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11642 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11643 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11644 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11645 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11646 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11647 optimized code.
11648
11649 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11650 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11651 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11652 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11653 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11654
11655 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11656 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11657 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11658 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11659 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11660 Warnings and Messages}.)
11661
11662 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11663 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11664 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11665 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11666 in stabs format.
11667
11668 @kindex readnow
11669 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11670 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11671 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11672 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11673 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11674 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11675 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11676 entire symbol table available.
11677
11678 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11679 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11680 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11681 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11682 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11683 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11684 @c files.
11685
11686 @kindex core-file
11687 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11688 @itemx core
11689 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11690 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11691 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11692 executable file itself for other parts.
11693
11694 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11695 to be used.
11696
11697 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11698 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11699 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11700 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11701 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11702
11703 @kindex add-symbol-file
11704 @cindex dynamic linking
11705 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11706 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11707 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11708 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11709 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11710 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11711 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11712 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11713 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11714 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11715 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11716 @var{address} as an expression.
11717
11718 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11719 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11720 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11721 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11722 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11723
11724 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11725 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11726 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11727 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11728 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11729 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11730 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11731 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11732 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11733
11734 @itemize @bullet
11735 @item
11736 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11737 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11738 @item
11739 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11740 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11741 @item
11742 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11743 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11744 @end itemize
11745
11746 @noindent
11747 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11748 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11749 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11750 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11751 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11752 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11753 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11754 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11755 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11756 way.
11757
11758 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11759
11760 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11761 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11762 @cindex load symbols from memory
11763 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11764 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11765 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11766 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11767 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11768 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11769 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11770 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11771 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11772
11773 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11774 @kindex assf
11775 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11776 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11777 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11778 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11779 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11780 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11781 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11782 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11783 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11784 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11785
11786 @kindex section
11787 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11788 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11789 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11790 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11791 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11792 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11793 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11794 their addresses.
11795
11796 @kindex info files
11797 @kindex info target
11798 @item info files
11799 @itemx info target
11800 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11801 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11802 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11803 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11804 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11805 current ones.
11806
11807 @kindex maint info sections
11808 @item maint info sections
11809 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11810 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11811 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11812 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11813 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11814 may be arbitrarily combined):
11815
11816 @table @code
11817 @item ALLOBJ
11818 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11819 @item @var{sections}
11820 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11821 @item @var{section-flags}
11822 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11823 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11824 @table @code
11825 @item ALLOC
11826 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11827 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11828 @item LOAD
11829 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11830 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11831 @item RELOC
11832 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11833 @item READONLY
11834 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11835 @item CODE
11836 Section contains executable code only.
11837 @item DATA
11838 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11839 @item ROM
11840 Section will reside in ROM.
11841 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11842 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11843 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11844 Section is not empty.
11845 @item NEVER_LOAD
11846 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11847 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11848 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11849 COFF shared library information.
11850 @item IS_COMMON
11851 Section contains common symbols.
11852 @end table
11853 @end table
11854 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11855 @cindex read-only sections
11856 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11857 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11858 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11859 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11860 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11861 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11862 enhancement to debugging performance.
11863
11864 The default is off.
11865
11866 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11867 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11868 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11869 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11870
11871 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11872 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11873 @end table
11874
11875 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11876 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11877 name and remembers it that way.
11878
11879 @cindex shared libraries
11880 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
11881 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11882 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11883
11884 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
11885 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
11886
11887 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11888 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11889 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11890 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11891 debugging a core file).
11892
11893 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11894 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11895
11896 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11897 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11898 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11899
11900 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11901 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11902 particularly large or there are many of them.
11903
11904 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11905 commands:
11906
11907 @table @code
11908 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11909 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11910 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11911 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11912 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11913 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11914 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11915 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11916
11917 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11918 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11919 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11920 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11921 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11922 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11923 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11924 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
11925 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11926
11927 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11928 @item show auto-solib-add
11929 Display the current autoloading mode.
11930 @end table
11931
11932 @cindex load shared library
11933 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11934 command:
11935
11936 @table @code
11937 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11938 @kindex info share
11939 @item info share
11940 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11941 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11942
11943 @kindex sharedlibrary
11944 @kindex share
11945 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11946 @itemx share @var{regex}
11947 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11948 Unix regular expression.
11949 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11950 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11951 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11952 loaded.
11953
11954 @item nosharedlibrary
11955 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11956 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11957 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11958 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11959 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11960 discarded.
11961 @end table
11962
11963 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11964 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11965 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11966
11967 @table @code
11968 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11969 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11970 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11971 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11972 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11973 shared library.
11974
11975 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11976 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11977 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11978 library events happen.
11979 @end table
11980
11981 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11982 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11983 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11984 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11985 not.
11986
11987 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11988 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11989 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11990 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11991 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11992
11993 @table @code
11994 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11995 @cindex system root, alternate
11996 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11997 @kindex set sysroot
11998 @item set sysroot @var{path}
11999 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12000 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12001 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12002 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12003 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12004 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12005 under @var{path}.
12006
12007 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12008 sysroot}.
12009
12010 @cindex default system root
12011 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12012 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12013 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12014 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12015 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12016 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12017 location.
12018
12019 @kindex show sysroot
12020 @item show sysroot
12021 Display the current shared library prefix.
12022
12023 @kindex set solib-search-path
12024 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12025 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12026 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12027 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12028 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12029 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12030 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12031 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12032 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12033 of shared library symbols.
12034
12035 @kindex show solib-search-path
12036 @item show solib-search-path
12037 Display the current shared library search path.
12038 @end table
12039
12040
12041 @node Separate Debug Files
12042 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12043 @cindex separate debugging information files
12044 @cindex debugging information in separate files
12045 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12046 @cindex debugging information directory, global
12047 @cindex global debugging information directory
12048 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12049 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12050
12051 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12052 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12053 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12054 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12055 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12056 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12057 install only when they need to debug a problem.
12058
12059 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12060 file:
12061
12062 @itemize @bullet
12063 @item
12064 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12065 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12066 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12067 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12068 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12069 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12070 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12071 came from the same build.
12072
12073 @item
12074 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12075 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12076 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12077 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12078 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12079 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12080 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12081 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12082 below.
12083 @end itemize
12084
12085 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12086 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12087
12088 @itemize @bullet
12089 @item
12090 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12091 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12092 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12093 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12094 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12095
12096 @item
12097 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12098 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12099 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12100 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12101 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12102 hex characters, not 10.)
12103 @end itemize
12104
12105 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12106 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12107 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12108 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12109 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12110 debug information files, in the indicated order:
12111
12112 @itemize @minus
12113 @item
12114 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12115 @item
12116 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12117 @item
12118 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12119 @item
12120 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12121 @end itemize
12122
12123 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12124 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12125
12126 @table @code
12127
12128 @kindex set debug-file-directory
12129 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12130 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12131 information files to @var{directory}.
12132
12133 @kindex show debug-file-directory
12134 @item show debug-file-directory
12135 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12136 information files.
12137
12138 @end table
12139
12140 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12141 @cindex debug link sections
12142 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12143 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12144
12145 @itemize
12146 @item
12147 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12148 a zero byte,
12149 @item
12150 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12151 boundary within the section, and
12152 @item
12153 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12154 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12155 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12156 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12157 @end itemize
12158
12159 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12160 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12161 described above.
12162
12163 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12164 @cindex build ID sections
12165 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12166 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12167 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12168 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12169 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12170 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12171 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12172 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12173 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12174
12175 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12176 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12177 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12178 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12179 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12180 in an ordinary executable.
12181
12182 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12183 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12184 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12185 following commands:
12186
12187 @smallexample
12188 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12189 @kbd{strip -g foo}
12190 @end smallexample
12191
12192 @noindent
12193 These commands remove the debugging
12194 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12195 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12196 two files:
12197
12198 @itemize @bullet
12199 @item
12200 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12201 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12202
12203 @smallexample
12204 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12205 @end smallexample
12206
12207 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12208 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12209 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12210 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12211
12212 @item
12213 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12214 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12215 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12216 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12217 @end itemize
12218
12219 @noindent
12220
12221 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12222 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12223 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12224 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12225
12226 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12227 @smallexample
12228 unsigned long
12229 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12230 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12231 @{
12232 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12233 @{
12234 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12235 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12236 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12237 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12238 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12239 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12240 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12241 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12242 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12243 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12244 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12245 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12246 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12247 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12248 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12249 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12250 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12251 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12252 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12253 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12254 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12255 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12256 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12257 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12258 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12259 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12260 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12261 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12262 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12263 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12264 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12265 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12266 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12267 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12268 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12269 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12270 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12271 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12272 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12273 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12274 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12275 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12276 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12277 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12278 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12279 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12280 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12281 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12282 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12283 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12284 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12285 0x2d02ef8d
12286 @};
12287 unsigned char *end;
12288
12289 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12290 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12291 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12292 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12293 @}
12294 @end smallexample
12295
12296 @noindent
12297 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12298
12299
12300 @node Symbol Errors
12301 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12302
12303 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12304 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12305 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12306 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12307 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12308 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12309 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12310 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12311 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12312 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12313 Messages}).
12314
12315 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12316
12317 @table @code
12318 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12319
12320 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12321 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12322 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12323 in its outer scope blocks.
12324
12325 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12326 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12327 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12328 function.
12329
12330 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12331
12332 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12333 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12334 do so.
12335
12336 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12337 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12338 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12339 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12340 Messages}.)
12341
12342 @item bad block start address patched
12343
12344 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12345 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12346 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12347
12348 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12349 starting on the previous source line.
12350
12351 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12352
12353 @cindex foo
12354 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12355 larger than the size of the string table.
12356
12357 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12358 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12359 with this name.
12360
12361 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12362
12363 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12364 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12365 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12366
12367 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12368 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12369 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12370 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12371 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12372 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12373
12374 @item stub type has NULL name
12375
12376 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12377
12378 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12379 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12380 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12381 it.
12382
12383 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12384
12385 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12386
12387 @end table
12388
12389 @node Targets
12390 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12391
12392 @cindex debugging target
12393 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12394
12395 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12396 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12397 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12398 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12399 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12400 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12401 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12402 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12403
12404 @cindex target architecture
12405 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12406 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12407 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12408 command.
12409
12410 @table @code
12411 @kindex set architecture
12412 @kindex show architecture
12413 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12414 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12415 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12416 supported architectures.
12417
12418 @item show architecture
12419 Show the current target architecture.
12420
12421 @item set processor
12422 @itemx processor
12423 @kindex set processor
12424 @kindex show processor
12425 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12426 and @code{show architecture}.
12427 @end table
12428
12429 @menu
12430 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12431 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12432 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12433 @end menu
12434
12435 @node Active Targets
12436 @section Active Targets
12437
12438 @cindex stacking targets
12439 @cindex active targets
12440 @cindex multiple targets
12441
12442 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12443 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12444 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12445 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12446 a core file.
12447
12448 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12449 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12450 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12451 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12452 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12453 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12454 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12455 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12456 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12457
12458 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12459 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12460 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12461 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12462 process target is active.
12463
12464 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12465 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12466 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12467 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12468 Process}).
12469
12470 @node Target Commands
12471 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12472
12473 @table @code
12474 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12475 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12476 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12477 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12478 protocol of the target machine.
12479
12480 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12481 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12482 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12483
12484 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12485 after executing the command.
12486
12487 @kindex help target
12488 @item help target
12489 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12490 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12491 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12492
12493 @item help target @var{name}
12494 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12495 select it.
12496
12497 @kindex set gnutarget
12498 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12499 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12500 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12501 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12502 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12503 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12504
12505 @quotation
12506 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12507 you must know the actual BFD name.
12508 @end quotation
12509
12510 @noindent
12511 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12512
12513 @kindex show gnutarget
12514 @item show gnutarget
12515 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12516 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12517 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12518 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12519 @end table
12520
12521 @cindex common targets
12522 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12523 configuration):
12524
12525 @table @code
12526 @kindex target
12527 @item target exec @var{program}
12528 @cindex executable file target
12529 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12530 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12531
12532 @item target core @var{filename}
12533 @cindex core dump file target
12534 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12535 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12536
12537 @item target remote @var{medium}
12538 @cindex remote target
12539 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12540 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12541 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12542
12543 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12544 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12545
12546 @smallexample
12547 target remote /dev/ttya
12548 @end smallexample
12549
12550 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12551 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12552 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12553 clobbered by the download.
12554
12555 @item target sim
12556 @cindex built-in simulator target
12557 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12558 In general,
12559 @smallexample
12560 target sim
12561 load
12562 run
12563 @end smallexample
12564 @noindent
12565 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12566 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12567 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12568 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12569 Processors}.
12570
12571 @end table
12572
12573 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12574
12575 @table @code
12576
12577 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12578 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12579 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12580
12581 @end table
12582
12583 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12584 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12585
12586 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12587 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12588 various aspects of this process.
12589
12590 @table @code
12591
12592 @item set hash
12593 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12594 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12595 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12596 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12597 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12598 monitor.
12599
12600 @item show hash
12601 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12602 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12603
12604 @item set debug monitor
12605 @kindex set debug monitor
12606 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12607 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12608 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12609
12610 @item show debug monitor
12611 @kindex show debug monitor
12612 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12613 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12614 @end table
12615
12616 @table @code
12617
12618 @kindex load @var{filename}
12619 @item load @var{filename}
12620 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12621 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12622 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12623 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12624 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12625 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12626
12627 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12628 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12629 target is @dots{}}''
12630
12631 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12632 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12633 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12634 specifies a fixed address.
12635 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12636
12637 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12638 load programs into flash memory.
12639
12640 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12641 @end table
12642
12643 @node Byte Order
12644 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
12645
12646 @cindex choosing target byte order
12647 @cindex target byte order
12648
12649 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12650 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12651 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12652 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12653 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12654 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12655
12656 @table @code
12657 @kindex set endian
12658 @item set endian big
12659 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12660
12661 @item set endian little
12662 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12663
12664 @item set endian auto
12665 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12666 executable.
12667
12668 @item show endian
12669 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12670
12671 @end table
12672
12673 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12674 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12675 target system.
12676
12677
12678 @node Remote Debugging
12679 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12680 @cindex remote debugging
12681
12682 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12683 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12684 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12685 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12686 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12687
12688 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12689 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12690 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12691 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12692 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12693 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12694
12695 Other remote targets may be available in your
12696 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12697
12698 @menu
12699 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12700 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
12701 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12702 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12703 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12704 @end menu
12705
12706 @node Connecting
12707 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
12708
12709 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12710 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12711 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12712 program as the first argument.
12713
12714 @cindex @code{target remote}
12715 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12716 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12717 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12718 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12719 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12720 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12721
12722 @table @code
12723
12724 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12725 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12726 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12727 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12728
12729 @smallexample
12730 target remote /dev/ttyb
12731 @end smallexample
12732
12733 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12734 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12735 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12736 @code{target} command.
12737
12738 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12739 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12740 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12741 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12742 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12743 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12744 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12745 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12746 target.
12747
12748 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12749 @code{manyfarms}:
12750
12751 @smallexample
12752 target remote manyfarms:2828
12753 @end smallexample
12754
12755 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12756 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12757 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12758 port 1234 on your local machine:
12759
12760 @smallexample
12761 target remote :1234
12762 @end smallexample
12763 @noindent
12764
12765 Note that the colon is still required here.
12766
12767 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12768 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12769 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12770 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12771
12772 @smallexample
12773 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12774 @end smallexample
12775
12776 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12777 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12778 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12779 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12780
12781 @item target remote | @var{command}
12782 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12783 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12784 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12785 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12786 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12787 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12788 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12789 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12790
12791 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12792 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12793 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12794
12795 @end table
12796
12797 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12798 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12799 remote program.
12800
12801 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12802 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12803 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12804 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12805 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12806 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12807 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12808
12809 @smallexample
12810 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12811 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12812 @end smallexample
12813
12814 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12815 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12816 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12817 goes back to waiting.
12818
12819 @table @code
12820 @kindex detach (remote)
12821 @item detach
12822 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12823 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12824 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12825 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12826 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12827
12828 @kindex disconnect
12829 @item disconnect
12830 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12831 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12832 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12833 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12834 another target.
12835
12836 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12837 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12838 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12839 @kindex monitor
12840 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12841 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12842 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12843 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12844 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12845 and implement.
12846 @end table
12847
12848 @node File Transfer
12849 @section Sending files to a remote system
12850 @cindex remote target, file transfer
12851 @cindex file transfer
12852 @cindex sending files to remote systems
12853
12854 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
12855 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
12856 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
12857 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
12858 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
12859 the only way to upload or download files.
12860
12861 Not all remote targets support these commands.
12862
12863 @table @code
12864 @kindex remote put
12865 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
12866 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
12867 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
12868
12869 @kindex remote get
12870 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
12871 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
12872 on the host system.
12873
12874 @kindex remote delete
12875 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
12876 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
12877
12878 @end table
12879
12880 @node Server
12881 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
12882
12883 @kindex gdbserver
12884 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12885 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12886 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12887 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12888
12889 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12890 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12891 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12892 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12893 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12894 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12895 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12896 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12897 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12898 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12899 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12900 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12901 choice for debugging.
12902
12903 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12904 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12905 protocol.
12906
12907 @table @emph
12908 @item On the target machine,
12909 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12910 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12911 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12912 system does all the symbol handling.
12913
12914 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12915 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12916 syntax is:
12917
12918 @smallexample
12919 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12920 @end smallexample
12921
12922 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12923 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12924 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12925 @file{/dev/com1}:
12926
12927 @smallexample
12928 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12929 @end smallexample
12930
12931 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12932 with it.
12933
12934 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12935
12936 @smallexample
12937 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12938 @end smallexample
12939
12940 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12941 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12942 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12943 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12944 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12945 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12946 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12947 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12948 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12949 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12950 @code{target remote} command.
12951
12952 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12953 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12954
12955 @smallexample
12956 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12957 @end smallexample
12958
12959 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12960 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12961
12962 @pindex pidof
12963 @cindex attach to a program by name
12964 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12965 @code{pidof} utility:
12966
12967 @smallexample
12968 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{program}`
12969 @end smallexample
12970
12971 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
12972 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12973 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12974
12975 @item On the host machine,
12976 first make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
12977 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
12978 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
12979 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-system-root}).
12980
12981 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
12982 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
12983 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
12984 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
12985 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
12986 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
12987 programs.
12988
12989 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
12990 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12991 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12992 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12993 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12994 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12995 already on the target.
12996
12997 @end table
12998
12999 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13000 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13001
13002 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13003 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13004 Here are the available commands; they are only of interest when
13005 debugging @value{GDBN} or @code{gdbserver}.
13006
13007 @table @code
13008 @item monitor help
13009 List the available monitor commands.
13010
13011 @item monitor set debug 0
13012 @itemx monitor set debug 1
13013 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13014
13015 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
13016 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13017 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13018 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13019
13020 @end table
13021
13022 @node Remote Configuration
13023 @section Remote Configuration
13024
13025 @kindex set remote
13026 @kindex show remote
13027 This section documents the configuration options available when
13028 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13029 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13030 system-call-allowed}.
13031
13032 @table @code
13033 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13034 @cindex address size for remote targets
13035 @cindex bits in remote address
13036 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13037 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13038 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13039 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13040
13041 @item show remoteaddresssize
13042 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13043
13044 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
13045 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
13046 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13047 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13048 remote targets.
13049
13050 @item show remotebaud
13051 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13052
13053 @item set remotebreak
13054 @cindex interrupt remote programs
13055 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13056 @anchor{set remotebreak}
13057 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13058 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13059 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13060 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13061 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13062
13063 @item show remotebreak
13064 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13065 interrupt the remote program.
13066
13067 @item set remoteflow on
13068 @itemx set remoteflow off
13069 @kindex set remoteflow
13070 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13071 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13072
13073 @item show remoteflow
13074 @kindex show remoteflow
13075 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13076
13077 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13078 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13079 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13080 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13081 @code{ascii}.
13082
13083 @item show remotelogbase
13084 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13085 protocol.
13086
13087 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13088 @cindex record serial communications on file
13089 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13090 default is not to record at all.
13091
13092 @item show remotelogfile.
13093 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13094 serial communications.
13095
13096 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13097 @cindex timeout for serial communications
13098 @cindex remote timeout
13099 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13100 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13101
13102 @item show remotetimeout
13103 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13104 responses.
13105
13106 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13107 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13108 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13109 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13110 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13111 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13112 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13113 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13114 @end table
13115
13116 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13117 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13118 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13119 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13120 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13121 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13122 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13123 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13124 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13125
13126 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13127 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13128 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13129 @value{GDBN} developers.
13130
13131 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13132 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13133 are:
13134
13135 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13136 @item Command Name
13137 @tab Remote Packet
13138 @tab Related Features
13139
13140 @item @code{fetch-register}
13141 @tab @code{p}
13142 @tab @code{info registers}
13143
13144 @item @code{set-register}
13145 @tab @code{P}
13146 @tab @code{set}
13147
13148 @item @code{binary-download}
13149 @tab @code{X}
13150 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13151
13152 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
13153 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13154 @tab @code{info auxv}
13155
13156 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
13157 @tab @code{qSymbol}
13158 @tab Detecting multiple threads
13159
13160 @item @code{verbose-resume}
13161 @tab @code{vCont}
13162 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13163
13164 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
13165 @tab @code{Z0}
13166 @tab @code{break}
13167
13168 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13169 @tab @code{Z1}
13170 @tab @code{hbreak}
13171
13172 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
13173 @tab @code{Z2}
13174 @tab @code{watch}
13175
13176 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
13177 @tab @code{Z3}
13178 @tab @code{rwatch}
13179
13180 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
13181 @tab @code{Z4}
13182 @tab @code{awatch}
13183
13184 @item @code{target-features}
13185 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13186 @tab @code{set architecture}
13187
13188 @item @code{library-info}
13189 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13190 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13191
13192 @item @code{memory-map}
13193 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13194 @tab @code{info mem}
13195
13196 @item @code{read-spu-object}
13197 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13198 @tab @code{info spu}
13199
13200 @item @code{write-spu-object}
13201 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13202 @tab @code{info spu}
13203
13204 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13205 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13206 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13207
13208 @item @code{supported-packets}
13209 @tab @code{qSupported}
13210 @tab Remote communications parameters
13211
13212 @item @code{pass-signals}
13213 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
13214 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13215
13216 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
13217 @tab @code{vFile:close}
13218 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13219
13220 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
13221 @tab @code{vFile:open}
13222 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13223
13224 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
13225 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
13226 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13227
13228 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
13229 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
13230 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13231
13232 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
13233 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
13234 @tab @code{remote delete}
13235 @end multitable
13236
13237 @node Remote Stub
13238 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
13239
13240 @cindex debugging stub, example
13241 @cindex remote stub, example
13242 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
13243 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13244 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13245 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13246 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13247 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13248 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13249 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13250
13251 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13252 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13253 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13254 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13255 program, you need:
13256
13257 @enumerate
13258 @item
13259 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13260 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13261 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13262
13263 @item
13264 A C subroutine library to support your program's
13265 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13266
13267 @item
13268 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13269 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13270 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13271 documentation.
13272 @end enumerate
13273
13274 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13275 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13276 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13277
13278 @table @emph
13279 @item On the host,
13280 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13281 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13282 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13283
13284 @item On the target,
13285 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13286 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13287 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13288
13289 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13290 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13291 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13292 @end table
13293
13294 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13295 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13296 @sc{sparc} boards.
13297
13298 @cindex remote serial stub list
13299 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13300
13301 @table @code
13302
13303 @item i386-stub.c
13304 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13305 @cindex Intel
13306 @cindex i386
13307 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13308
13309 @item m68k-stub.c
13310 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13311 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13312 @cindex m680x0
13313 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13314
13315 @item sh-stub.c
13316 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13317 @cindex Renesas
13318 @cindex SH
13319 For Renesas SH architectures.
13320
13321 @item sparc-stub.c
13322 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13323 @cindex Sparc
13324 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13325
13326 @item sparcl-stub.c
13327 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13328 @cindex Fujitsu
13329 @cindex SparcLite
13330 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13331
13332 @end table
13333
13334 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13335 recently added stubs.
13336
13337 @menu
13338 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13339 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13340 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13341 @end menu
13342
13343 @node Stub Contents
13344 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13345
13346 @cindex remote serial stub
13347 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13348 subroutines:
13349
13350 @table @code
13351 @item set_debug_traps
13352 @findex set_debug_traps
13353 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13354 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13355 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13356 beginning of your program.
13357
13358 @item handle_exception
13359 @findex handle_exception
13360 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13361 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13362 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13363 run when a trap is triggered.
13364
13365 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13366 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13367 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13368 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13369 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13370 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13371 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13372 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13373 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13374 machine.
13375
13376 @item breakpoint
13377 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13378 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13379 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13380 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13381 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13382 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13383 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13384 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13385 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13386 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13387 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13388
13389 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13390 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13391 start of your debugging session.
13392 @end table
13393
13394 @node Bootstrapping
13395 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13396
13397 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13398 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13399 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13400 debugging target machine.
13401
13402 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13403 serial port.
13404
13405 @table @code
13406 @item int getDebugChar()
13407 @findex getDebugChar
13408 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13409 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13410 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13411
13412 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13413 @findex putDebugChar
13414 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13415 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13416 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13417 @end table
13418
13419 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13420 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13421 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13422 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13423 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13424 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13425 remote system to stop.
13426
13427 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13428 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13429 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13430 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13431
13432 Other routines you need to supply are:
13433
13434 @table @code
13435 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13436 @findex exceptionHandler
13437 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13438 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13439 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13440 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13441 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13442 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13443 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13444 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13445 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13446 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13447 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13448 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13449 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13450
13451 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13452 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13453 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13454 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13455 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13456
13457 @item void flush_i_cache()
13458 @findex flush_i_cache
13459 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13460 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13461 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13462
13463 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13464 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13465 @end table
13466
13467 @noindent
13468 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13469
13470 @table @code
13471 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13472 @findex memset
13473 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13474 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13475 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13476 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13477 @end table
13478
13479 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13480 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13481 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13482 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13483
13484
13485 @node Debug Session
13486 @subsection Putting it All Together
13487
13488 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13489 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13490 steps.
13491
13492 @enumerate
13493 @item
13494 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13495 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13496 @display
13497 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13498 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13499 @end display
13500
13501 @item
13502 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13503
13504 @smallexample
13505 set_debug_traps();
13506 breakpoint();
13507 @end smallexample
13508
13509 @item
13510 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13511 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13512
13513 @smallexample
13514 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13515 @end smallexample
13516
13517 @noindent
13518 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13519 function in your program, that function is called when
13520 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13521 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13522 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13523
13524 @item
13525 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13526 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13527
13528 @item
13529 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13530 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13531
13532 @item
13533 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13534 @c document that. FIXME.
13535 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13536 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13537
13538 @item
13539 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13540 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13541
13542 @end enumerate
13543
13544 @node Configurations
13545 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13546
13547 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13548 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13549 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13550
13551 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13552 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13553 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13554 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13555 are quite different from each other.
13556
13557 @menu
13558 * Native::
13559 * Embedded OS::
13560 * Embedded Processors::
13561 * Architectures::
13562 @end menu
13563
13564 @node Native
13565 @section Native
13566
13567 This section describes details specific to particular native
13568 configurations.
13569
13570 @menu
13571 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13572 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13573 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13574 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13575 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13576 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13577 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13578 @end menu
13579
13580 @node HP-UX
13581 @subsection HP-UX
13582
13583 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13584 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13585 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13586
13587
13588 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13589 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13590
13591 @cindex libkvm
13592 @cindex kernel memory image
13593 @cindex kernel crash dump
13594
13595 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13596 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13597 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13598 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13599 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13600 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13601 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13602 @code{kvm} target:
13603
13604 @smallexample
13605 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13606 @end smallexample
13607
13608 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13609 argument:
13610
13611 @smallexample
13612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13613 @end smallexample
13614
13615 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13616 available:
13617
13618 @table @code
13619 @kindex kvm
13620 @item kvm pcb
13621 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13622
13623 @item kvm proc
13624 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13625 modern FreeBSD systems.
13626 @end table
13627
13628 @node SVR4 Process Information
13629 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
13630 @cindex /proc
13631 @cindex examine process image
13632 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13633
13634 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13635 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13636 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13637 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13638 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13639 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13640 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13641 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13642 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13643
13644 @table @code
13645 @kindex info proc
13646 @cindex process ID
13647 @item info proc
13648 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13649 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13650 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13651 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13652 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13653 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13654 executable file's absolute file name.
13655
13656 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13657 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13658 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13659 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13660 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13661 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13662
13663 @item info proc mappings
13664 @cindex memory address space mappings
13665 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13666 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13667 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13668 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13669 memory access rights to that range.
13670
13671 @item info proc stat
13672 @itemx info proc status
13673 @cindex process detailed status information
13674 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13675 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13676 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13677 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13678 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13679 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13680 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13681
13682 @item info proc all
13683 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13684 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13685
13686 @ignore
13687 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13688 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13689 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13690 @kindex info proc times
13691 @item info proc times
13692 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13693 its children.
13694
13695 @kindex info proc id
13696 @item info proc id
13697 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13698 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13699 @end ignore
13700
13701 @item set procfs-trace
13702 @kindex set procfs-trace
13703 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13704 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13705
13706 @item show procfs-trace
13707 @kindex show procfs-trace
13708 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13709
13710 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13711 @kindex set procfs-file
13712 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13713 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13714 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13715 standard output.
13716
13717 @item show procfs-file
13718 @kindex show procfs-file
13719 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13720
13721 @item proc-trace-entry
13722 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13723 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13724 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13725 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13726 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13727 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13728 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13729 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13730 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13731
13732 @item info pidlist
13733 @kindex info pidlist
13734 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13735 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13736 processes and all the threads within each process.
13737
13738 @item info meminfo
13739 @kindex info meminfo
13740 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13741 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13742 @end table
13743
13744 @node DJGPP Native
13745 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13746 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13747 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13748 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13749
13750 @cindex DPMI
13751 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13752 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13753 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13754 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13755
13756 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13757 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13758 subsection describes those commands.
13759
13760 @table @code
13761 @kindex info dos
13762 @item info dos
13763 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13764 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13765
13766 @kindex sysinfo
13767 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13768 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13769 @item info dos sysinfo
13770 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13771 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13772 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13773
13774 @cindex GDT
13775 @cindex LDT
13776 @cindex IDT
13777 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13778 @cindex descriptor tables display
13779 @item info dos gdt
13780 @itemx info dos ldt
13781 @itemx info dos idt
13782 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13783 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13784 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13785 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13786 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13787 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13788 rights.
13789
13790 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13791 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13792 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13793 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13794 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13795
13796 @cindex garbled pointers
13797 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13798 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13799 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13800 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13801 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13802 debugged program's data segment:
13803
13804 @smallexample
13805 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13806 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13807 @end smallexample
13808
13809 @noindent
13810 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13811 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13812
13813 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13814 @item info dos pde
13815 @itemx info dos pte
13816 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13817 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13818 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13819 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13820 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13821 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13822 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13823 that is currently in use.
13824
13825 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13826 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13827 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13828 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13829 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13830 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13831 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13832
13833 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13834 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13835 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13836 controller.
13837
13838 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13839
13840 @cindex physical address from linear address
13841 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13842 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13843 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13844 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13845 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13846 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13847 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13848
13849 @smallexample
13850 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13851 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13852 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13853 @end smallexample
13854
13855 @noindent
13856 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13857 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13858 attributes of that page.
13859
13860 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13861 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13862 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13863 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13864 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13865 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13866
13867 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13868 transfer buffer:
13869
13870 @smallexample
13871 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13872 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13873 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13874 @end smallexample
13875
13876 @noindent
13877 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13878 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13879 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13880 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13881 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13882
13883 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13884 @end table
13885
13886 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13887 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13888 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13889 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13890
13891 @table @code
13892 @kindex set com1base
13893 @kindex set com1irq
13894 @kindex set com2base
13895 @kindex set com2irq
13896 @kindex set com3base
13897 @kindex set com3irq
13898 @kindex set com4base
13899 @kindex set com4irq
13900 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13901 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13902 port.
13903
13904 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13905 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13906 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13907
13908 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13909 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13910 other 3 COM ports.
13911
13912 @kindex show com1base
13913 @kindex show com1irq
13914 @kindex show com2base
13915 @kindex show com2irq
13916 @kindex show com3base
13917 @kindex show com3irq
13918 @kindex show com4base
13919 @kindex show com4irq
13920 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13921 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13922 lines used by the COM ports.
13923
13924 @item info serial
13925 @kindex info serial
13926 @cindex DOS serial port status
13927 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13928 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13929 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13930 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13931 @end table
13932
13933
13934 @node Cygwin Native
13935 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
13936 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13937 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13938 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13939
13940 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13941 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13942 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
13943 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
13944 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
13945
13946 @table @code
13947 @kindex info w32
13948 @item info w32
13949 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
13950 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13951
13952 @item info w32 selector
13953 This command displays information returned by
13954 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13955 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13956 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13957 Without argument, this command displays information
13958 about the six segment registers.
13959
13960 @kindex info dll
13961 @item info dll
13962 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
13963
13964 @kindex dll-symbols
13965 @item dll-symbols
13966 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13967 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13968
13969 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13970 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13971 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13972 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13973 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13974 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13975 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13976 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13977 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13978 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13979 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13980
13981 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13982 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13983 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13984 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13985
13986 @kindex set new-console
13987 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13988 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13989 be started in a new console on next start.
13990 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13991 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13992
13993 @kindex show new-console
13994 @item show new-console
13995 Displays whether a new console is used
13996 when the debuggee is started.
13997
13998 @kindex set new-group
13999 @item set new-group @var{mode}
14000 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14001 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14002 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14003 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
14004
14005 @kindex show new-group
14006 @item show new-group
14007 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14008
14009 @kindex set debugevents
14010 @item set debugevents
14011 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14012 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14013 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14014 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14015 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14016
14017 @kindex set debugexec
14018 @item set debugexec
14019 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14020 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14021
14022 @kindex set debugexceptions
14023 @item set debugexceptions
14024 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14025 debuggee seen by the debugger.
14026
14027 @kindex set debugmemory
14028 @item set debugmemory
14029 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14030 and writes by the debugger.
14031
14032 @kindex set shell
14033 @item set shell
14034 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14035 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14036
14037 @kindex show shell
14038 @item show shell
14039 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14040
14041 @end table
14042
14043 @menu
14044 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14045 @end menu
14046
14047 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14048 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14049 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14050 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14051
14052 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14053 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14054 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14055 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14056 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14057 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14058 ``minimal symbols''.
14059
14060 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14061 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14062 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14063 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14064 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14065 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14066 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14067 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14068 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14069 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14070
14071 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14072
14073 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14074 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14075 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14076 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14077 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14078 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14079 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14080 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14081 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14082
14083 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14084 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14085 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14086 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14087 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14088 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14089
14090 @smallexample
14091 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14092 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14093
14094 Non-debugging symbols:
14095 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
14096 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14097 @end smallexample
14098
14099 @smallexample
14100 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
14101 All functions matching regular expression "!":
14102
14103 Non-debugging symbols:
14104 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
14105 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
14106 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14107 [etc...]
14108 @end smallexample
14109
14110 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14111
14112 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14113 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14114 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14115 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14116 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14117 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14118 a function within a DLL without a running program.
14119
14120 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14121 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14122 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14123 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14124 problem:
14125
14126 @smallexample
14127 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14128 $1 = 268572168
14129 @end smallexample
14130
14131 @smallexample
14132 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
14133 0x10021610: "\230y\""
14134 @end smallexample
14135
14136 And two possible solutions:
14137
14138 @smallexample
14139 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14140 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14141 @end smallexample
14142
14143 @smallexample
14144 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
14145 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14146 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
14147 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14148 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
14149 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14150 @end smallexample
14151
14152 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14153 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14154 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14155 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14156 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14157
14158 @smallexample
14159 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14160 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14161 @end smallexample
14162
14163 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14164 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14165 safe.
14166
14167 @node Hurd Native
14168 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14169 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14170
14171 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14172 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14173
14174 @table @code
14175 @item set signals
14176 @itemx set sigs
14177 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14178 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14179 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14180 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14181 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14182 @code{signals}.
14183
14184 @item show signals
14185 @itemx show sigs
14186 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14187 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14188 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14189
14190 @item set signal-thread
14191 @itemx set sigthread
14192 @kindex set signal-thread
14193 @kindex set sigthread
14194 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14195 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14196 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14197 signal-thread}.
14198
14199 @item show signal-thread
14200 @itemx show sigthread
14201 @kindex show signal-thread
14202 @kindex show sigthread
14203 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14204 delivered a signal.
14205
14206 @item set stopped
14207 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14208 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14209 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14210 continued by delivering a signal to it.
14211
14212 @item show stopped
14213 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14214 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14215 stopped.
14216
14217 @item set exceptions
14218 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14219 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14220 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14221 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14222 trapping on.
14223
14224 @item show exceptions
14225 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14226 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14227
14228 @item set task pause
14229 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14230 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14231 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14232 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14233 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14234 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14235 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14236 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14237 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14238
14239 @item show task pause
14240 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14241 Show the current state of task suspension.
14242
14243 @item set task detach-suspend-count
14244 @cindex task suspend count
14245 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14246 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14247 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14248
14249 @item show task detach-suspend-count
14250 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14251
14252 @item set task exception-port
14253 @itemx set task excp
14254 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14255 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14256 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14257 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14258
14259 @item set noninvasive
14260 @cindex noninvasive task options
14261 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14262 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14263 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14264 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14265
14266 @item info send-rights
14267 @itemx info receive-rights
14268 @itemx info port-rights
14269 @itemx info port-sets
14270 @itemx info dead-names
14271 @itemx info ports
14272 @itemx info psets
14273 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14274 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14275 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14276 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14277 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14278 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14279 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14280 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14281 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14282
14283 @item set thread pause
14284 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14285 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14286 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14287 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14288 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14289 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14290 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14291 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14292 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14293 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14294 only the current thread.
14295
14296 @item show thread pause
14297 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14298 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14299
14300 @item set thread run
14301 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14302
14303 @item show thread run
14304 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14305
14306 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14307 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14308 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14309 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14310 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14311 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14312 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14313
14314 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14315 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14316 detaching.
14317
14318 @item set thread exception-port
14319 @itemx set thread excp
14320 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14321 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14322 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14323
14324 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14325 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14326 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14327 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14328
14329 @item set thread default
14330 @itemx show thread default
14331 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14332 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14333 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14334 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14335 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14336 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14337 the non-default commands.
14338 @end table
14339
14340
14341 @node Neutrino
14342 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14343 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14344
14345 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14346 Neutrino target:
14347
14348 @table @code
14349 @item set debug nto-debug
14350 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14351 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14352 Neutrino support.
14353
14354 @item show debug nto-debug
14355 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14356 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14357 @end table
14358
14359
14360 @node Embedded OS
14361 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14362
14363 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14364 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14365 architectures.
14366
14367 @menu
14368 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14369 @end menu
14370
14371 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14372 various real-time operating systems.
14373
14374 @node VxWorks
14375 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14376
14377 @cindex VxWorks
14378
14379 @table @code
14380
14381 @kindex target vxworks
14382 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14383 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14384 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14385
14386 @end table
14387
14388 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14389 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14390
14391 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14392 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14393 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14394 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14395 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14396 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14397 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14398
14399 @table @code
14400 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14401 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14402 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14403 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14404 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14405 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14406 of a thin network line.
14407 @end table
14408
14409 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14410 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14411 procedures.
14412
14413 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14414 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14415 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14416 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14417 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14418 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14419 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14420 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14421 manual.
14422 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14423
14424 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14425 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14426 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14427 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14428
14429 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14430
14431 @smallexample
14432 (vxgdb)
14433 @end smallexample
14434
14435 @menu
14436 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14437 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14438 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14439 @end menu
14440
14441 @node VxWorks Connection
14442 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14443
14444 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14445 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14446
14447 @smallexample
14448 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14449 @end smallexample
14450
14451 @need 750
14452 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14453
14454 @smallexample
14455 Attaching remote machine across net...
14456 Connected to tt.
14457 @end smallexample
14458
14459 @need 1000
14460 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14461 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14462 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14463 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14464 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14465
14466 @smallexample
14467 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14468 @end smallexample
14469
14470 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14471 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14472 command again.
14473
14474 @node VxWorks Download
14475 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14476
14477 @cindex download to VxWorks
14478 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14479 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14480 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14481 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14482 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14483 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14484 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14485 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14486 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14487 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14488 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14489 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14490 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14491 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14492 program, type this on VxWorks:
14493
14494 @smallexample
14495 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14496 @end smallexample
14497
14498 @noindent
14499 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14500
14501 @smallexample
14502 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14503 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14504 @end smallexample
14505
14506 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14507
14508 @smallexample
14509 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14510 @end smallexample
14511
14512 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14513 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14514 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14515 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14516 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14517 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14518 table.)
14519
14520 @node VxWorks Attach
14521 @subsubsection Running Tasks
14522
14523 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14524 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14525 follows:
14526
14527 @smallexample
14528 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14529 @end smallexample
14530
14531 @noindent
14532 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14533 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14534 the time of attachment.
14535
14536 @node Embedded Processors
14537 @section Embedded Processors
14538
14539 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14540 configurations.
14541
14542 @cindex send command to simulator
14543 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14544 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14545
14546 @table @code
14547 @item sim @var{command}
14548 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14549 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14550 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14551 acceptable commands.
14552 @end table
14553
14554
14555 @menu
14556 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14557 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14558 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14559 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14560 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14561 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14562 * PowerPC:: PowerPC
14563 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14564 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14565 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14566 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14567 * CRIS:: CRIS
14568 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14569 @end menu
14570
14571 @node ARM
14572 @subsection ARM
14573 @cindex ARM RDI
14574
14575 @table @code
14576 @kindex target rdi
14577 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14578 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14579 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14580 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14581
14582 @kindex target rdp
14583 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14584 ARM Demon monitor.
14585
14586 @end table
14587
14588 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14589
14590 @table @code
14591 @item set arm disassembler
14592 @kindex set arm
14593 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14594 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14595
14596 @item show arm disassembler
14597 @kindex show arm
14598 Show the current disassembly style.
14599
14600 @item set arm apcs32
14601 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14602 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14603
14604 @item show arm apcs32
14605 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14606
14607 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14608 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14609 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14610
14611 @table @code
14612 @item auto
14613 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14614 @item softfpa
14615 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14616 processors.
14617 @item fpa
14618 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14619 @item softvfp
14620 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14621 @item vfp
14622 VFP co-processor.
14623 @end table
14624
14625 @item show arm fpu
14626 Show the current type of the FPU.
14627
14628 @item set arm abi
14629 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14630
14631 @item show arm abi
14632 Show the currently used ABI.
14633
14634 @item set debug arm
14635 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14636 target support subsystem.
14637
14638 @item show debug arm
14639 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14640 @end table
14641
14642 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14643 using the RDI interface:
14644
14645 @table @code
14646 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14647 @kindex rdilogfile
14648 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14649 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14650 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14651 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14652 @file{rdi.log}.
14653
14654 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14655 @kindex rdilogenable
14656 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14657 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14658 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14659 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14660 are logged to a file.
14661
14662 @item set rdiromatzero
14663 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14664 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14665 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14666 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14667 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14668 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14669
14670 @item show rdiromatzero
14671 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14672 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14673
14674 @item set rdiheartbeat
14675 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14676 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14677 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14678 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14679 well as the Angel monitor.
14680
14681 @item show rdiheartbeat
14682 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14683 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14684 @end table
14685
14686
14687 @node M32R/D
14688 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14689
14690 @table @code
14691 @kindex target m32r
14692 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14693 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14694
14695 @kindex target m32rsdi
14696 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14697 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14698 @end table
14699
14700 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14701
14702 @table @code
14703 @item set download-path @var{path}
14704 @kindex set download-path
14705 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14706 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14707
14708 @item show download-path
14709 @kindex show download-path
14710 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14711
14712 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14713 @kindex set board-address
14714 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14715 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14716
14717 @item show board-address
14718 @kindex show board-address
14719 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14720
14721 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14722 @kindex set server-address
14723 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14724 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14725 host machine.
14726
14727 @item show server-address
14728 @kindex show server-address
14729 Display the IP address of the download server.
14730
14731 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14732 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14733 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14734 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14735 executable file is uploaded.
14736
14737 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14738 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14739 Test the @code{upload} command.
14740 @end table
14741
14742 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14743
14744 @table @code
14745 @item sdireset
14746 @kindex sdireset
14747 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14748 This command resets the SDI connection.
14749
14750 @item sdistatus
14751 @kindex sdistatus
14752 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14753
14754 @item debug_chaos
14755 @kindex debug_chaos
14756 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14757 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14758
14759 @item use_debug_dma
14760 @kindex use_debug_dma
14761 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14762
14763 @item use_mon_code
14764 @kindex use_mon_code
14765 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14766
14767 @item use_ib_break
14768 @kindex use_ib_break
14769 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14770
14771 @item use_dbt_break
14772 @kindex use_dbt_break
14773 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14774 @end table
14775
14776 @node M68K
14777 @subsection M68k
14778
14779 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
14780 target command for the following ROM monitor.
14781
14782 @table @code
14783
14784 @kindex target dbug
14785 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14786 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14787
14788 @end table
14789
14790 @node MIPS Embedded
14791 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14792
14793 @cindex MIPS boards
14794 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14795 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14796 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14797
14798 @need 1000
14799 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14800
14801 @table @code
14802 @item target mips @var{port}
14803 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14804 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14805 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14806 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14807 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14808 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14809 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14810
14811 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14812 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14813 debugger:
14814
14815 @smallexample
14816 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14817 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14818 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14819 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14820 (@value{GDBP}) run
14821 @end smallexample
14822
14823 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14824 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14825 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14826 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14827 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14828
14829 @item target pmon @var{port}
14830 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14831 PMON ROM monitor.
14832
14833 @item target ddb @var{port}
14834 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14835 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14836
14837 @item target lsi @var{port}
14838 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14839 LSI variant of PMON.
14840
14841 @kindex target r3900
14842 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14843 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14844
14845 @kindex target array
14846 @item target array @var{dev}
14847 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14848
14849 @end table
14850
14851
14852 @noindent
14853 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14854
14855 @table @code
14856 @item set mipsfpu double
14857 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14858 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14859 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14860 @itemx show mipsfpu
14861 @kindex set mipsfpu
14862 @kindex show mipsfpu
14863 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14864 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14865 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14866 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14867 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14868 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14869 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14870 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14871 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14872 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14873 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14874 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14875 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14876
14877 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14878 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14879 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14880
14881 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14882 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14883
14884 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14885 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14886 @itemx show timeout
14887 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14888 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14889 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14890 @kindex set timeout
14891 @kindex show timeout
14892 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14893 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14894 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14895 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14896 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14897 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14898 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14899 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14900 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14901 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14902
14903 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14904 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14905 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14906 to run before stopping.
14907
14908 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14909 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14910 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14911 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14912 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14913 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14914
14915 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14916 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14917 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14918 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14919
14920 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14921 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14922 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14923 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14924 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14925 @table @asis
14926 @item pmon target
14927 @samp{PMON}
14928 @item ddb target
14929 @samp{NEC010}
14930 @item lsi target
14931 @samp{PMON>}
14932 @end table
14933
14934 @item show monitor-prompt
14935 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14936 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14937 remote monitor.
14938
14939 @item set monitor-warnings
14940 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14941 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14942 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14943 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14944 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14945
14946 @item show monitor-warnings
14947 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14948 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14949
14950 @item pmon @var{command}
14951 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14952 @cindex send PMON command
14953 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14954 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14955 @end table
14956
14957 @node OpenRISC 1000
14958 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14959 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14960
14961 @cindex or1k boards
14962 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14963 about platform and commands.
14964
14965 @table @code
14966
14967 @kindex target jtag
14968 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14969
14970 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14971 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14972 connected via parallel port to the board.
14973
14974 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14975
14976 @kindex or1ksim
14977 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14978 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14979 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14980
14981 @kindex info or1k spr
14982 @item info or1k spr
14983 Displays spr groups.
14984
14985 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14986 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14987 Displays register names in selected group.
14988
14989 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14990 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14991 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14992 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14993 Shows information about specified spr register.
14994
14995 @kindex spr
14996 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14997 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14998 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14999 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15000 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15001 @end table
15002
15003 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15004 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15005 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15006 triggers can be set using:
15007 @table @code
15008 @item $LEA/$LDATA
15009 Load effective address/data
15010 @item $SEA/$SDATA
15011 Store effective address/data
15012 @item $AEA/$ADATA
15013 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15014 @item $FETCH
15015 Fetch data
15016 @end table
15017
15018 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15019 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15020
15021 @code{htrace} commands:
15022 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15023 @table @code
15024 @kindex hwatch
15025 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
15026 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15027 or Data. For example:
15028
15029 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15030
15031 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15032
15033 @kindex htrace
15034 @item htrace info
15035 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15036
15037 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15038 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15039
15040 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15041 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15042
15043 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15044 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15045
15046 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15047 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15048 triggered.
15049
15050 @item htrace enable
15051 @itemx htrace disable
15052 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15053
15054 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15055 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15056
15057 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15058 will be written there.
15059
15060 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15061 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15062
15063 @item htrace mode continuous
15064 Set continuous trace mode.
15065
15066 @item htrace mode suspend
15067 Set suspend trace mode.
15068
15069 @end table
15070
15071 @node PowerPC
15072 @subsection PowerPC
15073
15074 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15075
15076 @table @code
15077 @kindex set powerpc
15078 @item set powerpc soft-float
15079 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
15080 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15081 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15082 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15083
15084 @item set powerpc vector-abi
15085 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15086 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15087 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15088 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15089 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15090 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15091 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15092
15093 @kindex target dink32
15094 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15095 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15096
15097 @kindex target ppcbug
15098 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15099 @kindex target ppcbug1
15100 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15101 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15102
15103 @kindex target sds
15104 @item target sds @var{dev}
15105 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15106 @end table
15107
15108 @cindex SDS protocol
15109 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15110 by @value{GDBN}:
15111
15112 @table @code
15113 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15114 @kindex set sdstimeout
15115 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15116 default is 2 seconds.
15117
15118 @item show sdstimeout
15119 @kindex show sdstimeout
15120 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15121
15122 @item sds @var{command}
15123 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15124 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15125 @end table
15126
15127
15128 @node PA
15129 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15130
15131 @table @code
15132
15133 @kindex target op50n
15134 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15135 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15136
15137 @kindex target w89k
15138 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15139 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15140
15141 @end table
15142
15143 @node Sparclet
15144 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15145
15146 @cindex Sparclet
15147
15148 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15149 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15150 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15151 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15152 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15153
15154 @table @code
15155 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15156 @kindex remotetimeout
15157 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15158 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15159 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15160 @end table
15161
15162 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15163 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15164 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15165 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15166 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15167
15168 @smallexample
15169 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15170 @end smallexample
15171
15172 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15173
15174 @smallexample
15175 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15176 @end smallexample
15177
15178 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15179 Once you have set
15180 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15181 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15182 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15183
15184 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15185
15186 @smallexample
15187 (gdbslet)
15188 @end smallexample
15189
15190 @menu
15191 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15192 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15193 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15194 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15195 @end menu
15196
15197 @node Sparclet File
15198 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15199
15200 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15201
15202 @smallexample
15203 (gdbslet) file prog
15204 @end smallexample
15205
15206 @need 1000
15207 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15208 @value{GDBN} locates
15209 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15210 path.
15211 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15212 files will be searched as well.
15213 @value{GDBN} locates
15214 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15215 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15216 If it fails
15217 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15218
15219 @smallexample
15220 prog: No such file or directory.
15221 @end smallexample
15222
15223 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15224 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15225 @code{target} command again.
15226
15227 @node Sparclet Connection
15228 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15229
15230 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15231 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15232
15233 @smallexample
15234 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15235 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15236 main () at ../prog.c:3
15237 @end smallexample
15238
15239 @need 750
15240 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15241
15242 @smallexample
15243 Connected to ttya.
15244 @end smallexample
15245
15246 @node Sparclet Download
15247 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
15248
15249 @cindex download to Sparclet
15250 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15251 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15252 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15253 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15254 command.
15255 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15256 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15257 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15258 of each of the file's sections.
15259 For instance, if the program
15260 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15261 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15262
15263 @smallexample
15264 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15265 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15266 @end smallexample
15267
15268 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15269 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15270 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15271
15272 @node Sparclet Execution
15273 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
15274
15275 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15276 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15277 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15278 manual for the list of commands.
15279
15280 @smallexample
15281 (gdbslet) b main
15282 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15283 (gdbslet) run
15284 Starting program: prog
15285 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15286 3 char *symarg = 0;
15287 (gdbslet) step
15288 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15289 (gdbslet)
15290 @end smallexample
15291
15292 @node Sparclite
15293 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15294
15295 @table @code
15296
15297 @kindex target sparclite
15298 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15299 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15300 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15301 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15302 remote protocol.
15303
15304 @end table
15305
15306 @node Z8000
15307 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15308
15309 @cindex Z8000
15310 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15311 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15312
15313 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15314 a Z8000 simulator.
15315
15316 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15317 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15318 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15319 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15320
15321 @table @code
15322 @item target sim @var{args}
15323 @kindex sim
15324 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15325 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15326 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15327 @end table
15328
15329 @noindent
15330 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15331 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15332 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15333 to run your program, and so on.
15334
15335 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15336 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15337 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15338
15339 @table @code
15340
15341 @item cycles
15342 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15343
15344 @item insts
15345 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15346
15347 @item time
15348 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15349
15350 @end table
15351
15352 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15353 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15354 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15355 simulated clock ticks.
15356
15357 @node AVR
15358 @subsection Atmel AVR
15359 @cindex AVR
15360
15361 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15362 following AVR-specific commands:
15363
15364 @table @code
15365 @item info io_registers
15366 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15367 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15368 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15369 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15370 @end table
15371
15372 @node CRIS
15373 @subsection CRIS
15374 @cindex CRIS
15375
15376 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15377 following CRIS-specific commands:
15378
15379 @table @code
15380 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15381 @cindex CRIS version
15382 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15383 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15384 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15385
15386 @item show cris-version
15387 Show the current CRIS version.
15388
15389 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15390 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15391 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15392 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15393 @code{R59}.
15394
15395 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15396 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15397
15398 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15399 @cindex CRIS mode
15400 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15401 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15402 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15403
15404 @item show cris-mode
15405 Show the current CRIS mode.
15406 @end table
15407
15408 @node Super-H
15409 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15410 @cindex Super-H
15411
15412 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15413 commands:
15414
15415 @table @code
15416 @item regs
15417 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15418 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15419 @end table
15420
15421
15422 @node Architectures
15423 @section Architectures
15424
15425 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15426 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15427
15428 @menu
15429 * i386::
15430 * A29K::
15431 * Alpha::
15432 * MIPS::
15433 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15434 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15435 @end menu
15436
15437 @node i386
15438 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15439
15440 @table @code
15441 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15442 @kindex set struct-convention
15443 @cindex struct return convention
15444 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15445 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15446 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15447 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15448 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15449 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15450 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15451 be returned in a register.
15452
15453 @item show struct-convention
15454 @kindex show struct-convention
15455 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15456 from functions.
15457 @end table
15458
15459 @node A29K
15460 @subsection A29K
15461
15462 @table @code
15463
15464 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15465 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15466 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15467 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15468 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15469 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15470 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15471 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15472 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15473 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15474 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15475 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15476 hexadecimal.
15477
15478 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15479 @item show rstack_high_address
15480 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15481 processors.
15482
15483 @end table
15484
15485 @node Alpha
15486 @subsection Alpha
15487
15488 See the following section.
15489
15490 @node MIPS
15491 @subsection MIPS
15492
15493 @cindex stack on Alpha
15494 @cindex stack on MIPS
15495 @cindex Alpha stack
15496 @cindex MIPS stack
15497 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15498 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15499 find the beginning of a function.
15500
15501 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15502 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15503 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15504 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15505 commands:
15506
15507 @table @code
15508 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15509 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15510 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15511 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15512 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15513 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15514 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15515 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15516
15517 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15518 Display the current limit.
15519 @end table
15520
15521 @noindent
15522 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15523 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15524
15525 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15526 programs:
15527
15528 @table @code
15529 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15530 @kindex set mips abi
15531 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15532 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15533 values of @var{arg} are:
15534
15535 @table @samp
15536 @item auto
15537 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15538 default).
15539 @item o32
15540 @item o64
15541 @item n32
15542 @item n64
15543 @item eabi32
15544 @item eabi64
15545 @item auto
15546 @end table
15547
15548 @item show mips abi
15549 @kindex show mips abi
15550 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15551
15552 @item set mipsfpu
15553 @itemx show mipsfpu
15554 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15555
15556 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15557 @kindex set mips mask-address
15558 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15559 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15560 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15561 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15562 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15563
15564 @item show mips mask-address
15565 @kindex show mips mask-address
15566 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15567 not.
15568
15569 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15570 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15571 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15572 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15573 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15574 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15575
15576 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15577 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15578 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15579
15580 @item set debug mips
15581 @kindex set debug mips
15582 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15583 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15584
15585 @item show debug mips
15586 @kindex show debug mips
15587 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15588 @end table
15589
15590
15591 @node HPPA
15592 @subsection HPPA
15593 @cindex HPPA support
15594
15595 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15596 following special commands:
15597
15598 @table @code
15599 @item set debug hppa
15600 @kindex set debug hppa
15601 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15602 messages are to be displayed.
15603
15604 @item show debug hppa
15605 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15606
15607 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15608 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15609 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15610 given @var{address}.
15611
15612 @end table
15613
15614
15615 @node SPU
15616 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15617 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
15618 @cindex SPU
15619
15620 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
15621 it provides the following special commands:
15622
15623 @table @code
15624 @item info spu event
15625 @kindex info spu
15626 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
15627 and pending event status.
15628
15629 @item info spu signal
15630 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
15631 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
15632 notification channels.
15633
15634 @item info spu mailbox
15635 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
15636 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
15637 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
15638
15639 @item info spu dma
15640 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15641 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15642 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15643
15644 @item info spu proxydma
15645 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15646 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15647 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15648
15649 @end table
15650
15651
15652 @node Controlling GDB
15653 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15654
15655 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15656 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15657 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15658 described here.
15659
15660 @menu
15661 * Prompt:: Prompt
15662 * Editing:: Command editing
15663 * Command History:: Command history
15664 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15665 * Numbers:: Numbers
15666 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15667 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15668 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15669 @end menu
15670
15671 @node Prompt
15672 @section Prompt
15673
15674 @cindex prompt
15675
15676 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15677 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15678 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15679 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15680 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15681 which one you are talking to.
15682
15683 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15684 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15685 or a prompt that does not.
15686
15687 @table @code
15688 @kindex set prompt
15689 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15690 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15691
15692 @kindex show prompt
15693 @item show prompt
15694 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15695 @end table
15696
15697 @node Editing
15698 @section Command Editing
15699 @cindex readline
15700 @cindex command line editing
15701
15702 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15703 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15704 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15705 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15706 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15707 debugging sessions.
15708
15709 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15710 command @code{set}.
15711
15712 @table @code
15713 @kindex set editing
15714 @cindex editing
15715 @item set editing
15716 @itemx set editing on
15717 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15718
15719 @item set editing off
15720 Disable command line editing.
15721
15722 @kindex show editing
15723 @item show editing
15724 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15725 @end table
15726
15727 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15728 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15729 encouraged to read that chapter.
15730
15731 @node Command History
15732 @section Command History
15733 @cindex command history
15734
15735 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15736 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15737 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15738 history facility.
15739
15740 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15741 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15742 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15743
15744 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15745 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
15746 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
15747 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15748 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15749 pressed on a line by itself.
15750
15751 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15752 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15753 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15754 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15755
15756 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15757 history.
15758
15759 @table @code
15760 @cindex history substitution
15761 @cindex history file
15762 @kindex set history filename
15763 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15764 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15765 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15766 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15767 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15768 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15769 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15770 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15771 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15772 is not set.
15773
15774 @cindex save command history
15775 @kindex set history save
15776 @item set history save
15777 @itemx set history save on
15778 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15779 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15780
15781 @item set history save off
15782 Stop recording command history in a file.
15783
15784 @cindex history size
15785 @kindex set history size
15786 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15787 @item set history size @var{size}
15788 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15789 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15790 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15791 @end table
15792
15793 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15794 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15795
15796 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15797 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15798 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15799 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15800 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15801 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15802 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15803 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15804
15805 The commands to control history expansion are:
15806
15807 @table @code
15808 @item set history expansion on
15809 @itemx set history expansion
15810 @kindex set history expansion
15811 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15812
15813 @item set history expansion off
15814 Disable history expansion.
15815
15816 @c @group
15817 @kindex show history
15818 @item show history
15819 @itemx show history filename
15820 @itemx show history save
15821 @itemx show history size
15822 @itemx show history expansion
15823 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15824 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15825 @c @end group
15826 @end table
15827
15828 @table @code
15829 @kindex show commands
15830 @cindex show last commands
15831 @cindex display command history
15832 @item show commands
15833 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15834
15835 @item show commands @var{n}
15836 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15837
15838 @item show commands +
15839 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15840 @end table
15841
15842 @node Screen Size
15843 @section Screen Size
15844 @cindex size of screen
15845 @cindex pauses in output
15846
15847 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15848 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15849 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15850 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15851 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15852 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15853 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15854 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15855
15856 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15857 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15858 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15859 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15860 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15861 width} commands:
15862
15863 @table @code
15864 @kindex set height
15865 @kindex set width
15866 @kindex show width
15867 @kindex show height
15868 @item set height @var{lpp}
15869 @itemx show height
15870 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15871 @itemx show width
15872 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15873 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15874 commands display the current settings.
15875
15876 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15877 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15878 file or to an editor buffer.
15879
15880 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15881 from wrapping its output.
15882
15883 @item set pagination on
15884 @itemx set pagination off
15885 @kindex set pagination
15886 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15887 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15888
15889 @item show pagination
15890 @kindex show pagination
15891 Show the current pagination mode.
15892 @end table
15893
15894 @node Numbers
15895 @section Numbers
15896 @cindex number representation
15897 @cindex entering numbers
15898
15899 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15900 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15901 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15902 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15903 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15904 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15905 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15906 both input and output with the commands described below.
15907
15908 @table @code
15909 @kindex set input-radix
15910 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15911 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15912 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15913 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15914 example, any of
15915
15916 @smallexample
15917 set input-radix 012
15918 set input-radix 10.
15919 set input-radix 0xa
15920 @end smallexample
15921
15922 @noindent
15923 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15924 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15925 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15926 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15927 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15928 change the radix.
15929
15930 @kindex set output-radix
15931 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15932 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15933 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15934 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15935
15936 @kindex show input-radix
15937 @item show input-radix
15938 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15939
15940 @kindex show output-radix
15941 @item show output-radix
15942 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15943
15944 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15945 @itemx show radix
15946 @kindex set radix
15947 @kindex show radix
15948 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15949 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15950 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15951 default value of 10.
15952
15953 @end table
15954
15955 @node ABI
15956 @section Configuring the Current ABI
15957
15958 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15959 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15960 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15961 current ABI.
15962
15963 @cindex OS ABI
15964 @kindex set osabi
15965 @kindex show osabi
15966
15967 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15968 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15969 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15970 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15971 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15972 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15973 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15974 platform provides.
15975
15976 @table @code
15977 @item show osabi
15978 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15979
15980 @item set osabi
15981 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15982
15983 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15984 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15985 @end table
15986
15987 @cindex float promotion
15988
15989 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15990 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15991 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15992 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15993 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15994 @code{double} and then passed.
15995
15996 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15997 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15998 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15999
16000 @table @code
16001 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16002 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16003 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16004 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16005 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16006
16007 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16008 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16009 functions.
16010
16011 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16012 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16013 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16014 @end table
16015
16016 @kindex set cp-abi
16017 @kindex show cp-abi
16018 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16019 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16020 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16021 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16022 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16023 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16024 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16025 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16026 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16027 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16028 ``auto''.
16029
16030 @table @code
16031 @item show cp-abi
16032 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16033
16034 @item set cp-abi
16035 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16036
16037 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16038 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16039 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16040 @end table
16041
16042 @node Messages/Warnings
16043 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
16044
16045 @cindex verbose operation
16046 @cindex optional warnings
16047 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16048 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16049 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16050 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16051
16052 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16053 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16054 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16055
16056 @table @code
16057 @kindex set verbose
16058 @item set verbose on
16059 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16060
16061 @item set verbose off
16062 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16063
16064 @kindex show verbose
16065 @item show verbose
16066 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16067 @end table
16068
16069 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16070 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16071 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16072 Symbol Files}).
16073
16074 @table @code
16075
16076 @kindex set complaints
16077 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16078 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16079 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16080 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16081 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16082
16083 @kindex show complaints
16084 @item show complaints
16085 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16086
16087 @end table
16088
16089 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16090 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16091 you try to run a program which is already running:
16092
16093 @smallexample
16094 (@value{GDBP}) run
16095 The program being debugged has been started already.
16096 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16097 @end smallexample
16098
16099 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16100 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16101
16102 @table @code
16103
16104 @kindex set confirm
16105 @cindex flinching
16106 @cindex confirmation
16107 @cindex stupid questions
16108 @item set confirm off
16109 Disables confirmation requests.
16110
16111 @item set confirm on
16112 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16113
16114 @kindex show confirm
16115 @item show confirm
16116 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16117
16118 @end table
16119
16120 @cindex command tracing
16121 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16122 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16123 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16124 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16125
16126 @table @code
16127 @kindex set trace-commands
16128 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16129 @item set trace-commands on
16130 Enable command tracing.
16131 @item set trace-commands off
16132 Disable command tracing.
16133 @item show trace-commands
16134 Display the current state of command tracing.
16135 @end table
16136
16137 @node Debugging Output
16138 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16139 @cindex optional debugging messages
16140
16141 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16142 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16143 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16144 section documents those commands.
16145
16146 @table @code
16147 @kindex set exec-done-display
16148 @item set exec-done-display
16149 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16150 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16151 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16152 @kindex show exec-done-display
16153 @item show exec-done-display
16154 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16155 notification.
16156 @kindex set debug
16157 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16158 @cindex architecture debugging info
16159 @item set debug arch
16160 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16161 @kindex show debug
16162 @item show debug arch
16163 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16164 @item set debug aix-thread
16165 @cindex AIX threads
16166 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16167 module.
16168 @item show debug aix-thread
16169 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16170 @item set debug event
16171 @cindex event debugging info
16172 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16173 default is off.
16174 @item show debug event
16175 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16176 info.
16177 @item set debug expression
16178 @cindex expression debugging info
16179 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16180 expression parsing. The default is off.
16181 @item show debug expression
16182 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16183 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16184 @item set debug frame
16185 @cindex frame debugging info
16186 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16187 default is off.
16188 @item show debug frame
16189 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16190 info.
16191 @item set debug infrun
16192 @cindex inferior debugging info
16193 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16194 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16195 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16196 @item show debug infrun
16197 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16198 @item set debug lin-lwp
16199 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16200 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16201 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16202 @item show debug lin-lwp
16203 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16204 @item set debug observer
16205 @cindex observer debugging info
16206 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16207 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16208 @item show debug observer
16209 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16210 @item set debug overload
16211 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16212 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16213 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16214 is off.
16215 @item show debug overload
16216 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16217 debugging info.
16218 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16219 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16220 @cindex debug remote protocol
16221 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16222 @cindex display remote packets
16223 @item set debug remote
16224 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16225 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16226 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16227 @item show debug remote
16228 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16229 @item set debug serial
16230 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16231 default is off.
16232 @item show debug serial
16233 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16234 info.
16235 @item set debug solib-frv
16236 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16237 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16238 @item show debug solib-frv
16239 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16240 messages.
16241 @item set debug target
16242 @cindex target debugging info
16243 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16244 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16245 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16246 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16247 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16248 @item show debug target
16249 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16250 info.
16251 @item set debugvarobj
16252 @cindex variable object debugging info
16253 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16254 info. The default is off.
16255 @item show debugvarobj
16256 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16257 debugging info.
16258 @item set debug xml
16259 @cindex XML parser debugging
16260 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16261 @item show debug xml
16262 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16263 @end table
16264
16265 @node Sequences
16266 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16267
16268 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16269 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16270 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16271 files.
16272
16273 @menu
16274 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16275 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16276 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16277 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16278 @end menu
16279
16280 @node Define
16281 @section User-defined Commands
16282
16283 @cindex user-defined command
16284 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16285 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16286 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16287 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16288 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16289 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16290
16291 @smallexample
16292 define adder
16293 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16294 end
16295 @end smallexample
16296
16297 @noindent
16298 To execute the command use:
16299
16300 @smallexample
16301 adder 1 2 3
16302 @end smallexample
16303
16304 @noindent
16305 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16306 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16307 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16308 functions calls.
16309
16310 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16311 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16312 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16313 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16314
16315 @smallexample
16316 define adder
16317 if $argc == 2
16318 print $arg0 + $arg1
16319 end
16320 if $argc == 3
16321 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16322 end
16323 end
16324 @end smallexample
16325
16326 @table @code
16327
16328 @kindex define
16329 @item define @var{commandname}
16330 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16331 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16332
16333 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16334 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16335 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16336
16337 @kindex document
16338 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16339 @item document @var{commandname}
16340 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16341 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16342 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16343 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16344 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16345 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16346
16347 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16348 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16349 does not change the documentation.
16350
16351 @kindex dont-repeat
16352 @cindex don't repeat command
16353 @item dont-repeat
16354 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16355 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16356 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16357
16358 @kindex help user-defined
16359 @item help user-defined
16360 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16361 (if any) for each.
16362
16363 @kindex show user
16364 @item show user
16365 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16366 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16367 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16368 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16369
16370 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16371 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16372 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16373 @item show max-user-call-depth
16374 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16375 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16376 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16377 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16378 @end table
16379
16380 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16381 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16382
16383 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16384 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16385 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16386
16387 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16388 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16389 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16390 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16391
16392 @node Hooks
16393 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16394 @cindex command hooks
16395 @cindex hooks, for commands
16396 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16397
16398 @kindex hook
16399 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16400 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16401 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16402 before that command.
16403
16404 @cindex hooks, post-command
16405 @kindex hookpost
16406 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16407 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16408 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16409 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16410 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16411
16412 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16413 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16414
16415 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16416 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16417
16418 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16419 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16420 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16421 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16422 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16423
16424 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16425 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16426 you could define:
16427
16428 @smallexample
16429 define hook-stop
16430 handle SIGALRM nopass
16431 end
16432
16433 define hook-run
16434 handle SIGALRM pass
16435 end
16436
16437 define hook-continue
16438 handle SIGALRM pass
16439 end
16440 @end smallexample
16441
16442 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16443 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16444 you could define:
16445
16446 @smallexample
16447 define hook-echo
16448 echo <<<---
16449 end
16450
16451 define hookpost-echo
16452 echo --->>>\n
16453 end
16454
16455 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16456 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16457 (@value{GDBP})
16458
16459 @end smallexample
16460
16461 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16462 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16463 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16464 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16465 @c or not?
16466 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16467 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16468 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16469
16470 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16471 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16472
16473 @node Command Files
16474 @section Command Files
16475
16476 @cindex command files
16477 @cindex scripting commands
16478 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16479 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16480 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16481 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16482 terminal.
16483
16484 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16485 command:
16486
16487 @table @code
16488 @kindex source
16489 @cindex execute commands from a file
16490 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16491 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16492 @end table
16493
16494 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16495 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16496 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16497 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16498 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16499
16500 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16501 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16502
16503 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16504 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16505 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16506
16507 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16508 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16509 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16510 when called from command files.
16511
16512 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16513 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16514 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16515 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16516 the next command.
16517
16518 @smallexample
16519 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16520 @end smallexample
16521
16522 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16523 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16524 would be directed to @file{log}.
16525
16526 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16527 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16528 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16529 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16530 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16531 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16532 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16533 conditionally, etc.
16534
16535 @table @code
16536 @kindex if
16537 @kindex else
16538 @item if
16539 @itemx else
16540 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16541 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16542 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16543 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16544 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16545 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16546 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16547
16548 @kindex while
16549 @item while
16550 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16551 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16552 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16553 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16554 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16555 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16556
16557 @kindex loop_break
16558 @item loop_break
16559 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16560 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16561 line.
16562
16563 @kindex loop_continue
16564 @item loop_continue
16565 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16566 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16567 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16568 the controlling expression.
16569
16570 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16571 @item end
16572 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16573 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16574 @end table
16575
16576
16577 @node Output
16578 @section Commands for Controlled Output
16579
16580 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16581 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16582 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16583 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16584 want.
16585
16586 @table @code
16587 @kindex echo
16588 @item echo @var{text}
16589 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16590 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16591 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16592 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16593 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16594 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16595 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16596 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16597 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16598 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16599 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16600
16601 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16602 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16603
16604 @smallexample
16605 echo This is some text\n\
16606 which is continued\n\
16607 onto several lines.\n
16608 @end smallexample
16609
16610 produces the same output as
16611
16612 @smallexample
16613 echo This is some text\n
16614 echo which is continued\n
16615 echo onto several lines.\n
16616 @end smallexample
16617
16618 @kindex output
16619 @item output @var{expression}
16620 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16621 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16622 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16623 on expressions.
16624
16625 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16626 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16627 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16628 Formats}, for more information.
16629
16630 @kindex printf
16631 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16632 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
16633 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
16634 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
16635 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
16636 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
16637 executing the code below:
16638
16639 @smallexample
16640 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16641 @end smallexample
16642
16643 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
16644 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
16645 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
16646 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
16647 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
16648 printed.
16649
16650 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16651
16652 @smallexample
16653 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16654 @end smallexample
16655
16656 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
16657 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
16658 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
16659
16660 @itemize @bullet
16661 @item
16662 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
16663
16664 @item
16665 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
16666 width.
16667
16668 @item
16669 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
16670 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
16671
16672 @item
16673 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
16674 supported.
16675
16676 @item
16677 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
16678
16679 @item
16680 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
16681 @end itemize
16682
16683 @noindent
16684 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
16685 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
16686 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
16687 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
16688
16689 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
16690 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
16691 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
16692 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
16693 supported.
16694
16695 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
16696 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following conversion
16697 letters:
16698
16699 @itemize @bullet
16700 @item
16701 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
16702
16703 @item
16704 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
16705
16706 @item
16707 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
16708 @end itemize
16709
16710 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
16711 support for the three conversion letters for DFP types, other modifiers
16712 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
16713
16714 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
16715 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
16716
16717 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
16718 @smallexample
16719 printf "D32: %H - D64: %D - D128: %DD\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
16720 @end smallexample
16721
16722 @end table
16723
16724 @node Interpreters
16725 @chapter Command Interpreters
16726 @cindex command interpreters
16727
16728 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16729 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16730 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16731
16732 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16733 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16734 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16735 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16736
16737 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16738 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16739 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16740 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16741
16742 @table @code
16743 @item console
16744 @cindex console interpreter
16745 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16746 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16747 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16748
16749 @item mi
16750 @cindex mi interpreter
16751 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16752 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16753 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16754 Interface}.
16755
16756 @item mi2
16757 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16758 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16759
16760 @item mi1
16761 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16762 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16763
16764 @end table
16765
16766 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16767 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16768 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16769 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16770 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16771 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16772 the IDE inoperable!
16773
16774 @kindex interpreter-exec
16775 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16776 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16777 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16778 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16779
16780 @smallexample
16781 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16782 @end smallexample
16783
16784 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16785 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16786
16787 @node TUI
16788 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16789 @cindex TUI
16790 @cindex Text User Interface
16791
16792 @menu
16793 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16794 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16795 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16796 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
16797 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16798 @end menu
16799
16800 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
16801 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16802 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16803 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
16804 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
16805 is available.
16806
16807 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
16808 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
16809 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
16810 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
16811 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
16812 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
16813
16814 @node TUI Overview
16815 @section TUI Overview
16816
16817 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
16818
16819 @table @emph
16820 @item command
16821 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16822 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16823 managed using readline.
16824
16825 @item source
16826 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16827 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16828
16829 @item assembly
16830 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16831
16832 @item register
16833 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
16834 when their values change.
16835 @end table
16836
16837 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16838 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
16839 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
16840 indicates the breakpoint type:
16841
16842 @table @code
16843 @item B
16844 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16845
16846 @item b
16847 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16848
16849 @item H
16850 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16851
16852 @item h
16853 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16854 @end table
16855
16856 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16857
16858 @table @code
16859 @item +
16860 Breakpoint is enabled.
16861
16862 @item -
16863 Breakpoint is disabled.
16864 @end table
16865
16866 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
16867 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
16868 changes.
16869
16870 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
16871 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
16872 layouts:
16873
16874 @itemize @bullet
16875 @item
16876 source only,
16877
16878 @item
16879 assembly only,
16880
16881 @item
16882 source and assembly,
16883
16884 @item
16885 source and registers, or
16886
16887 @item
16888 assembly and registers.
16889 @end itemize
16890
16891 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
16892
16893 @table @emph
16894 @item target
16895 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
16896 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16897
16898 @item process
16899 Gives the current process or thread number.
16900 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16901
16902 @item function
16903 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16904 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16905 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
16906 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16907
16908 @item line
16909 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16910 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
16911
16912 @item pc
16913 Indicates the current program counter address.
16914 @end table
16915
16916 @node TUI Keys
16917 @section TUI Key Bindings
16918 @cindex TUI key bindings
16919
16920 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16921 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
16922 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16923
16924 @table @kbd
16925 @kindex C-x C-a
16926 @item C-x C-a
16927 @kindex C-x a
16928 @itemx C-x a
16929 @kindex C-x A
16930 @itemx C-x A
16931 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
16932 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
16933 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
16934 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
16935 The screen is then refreshed.
16936
16937 @kindex C-x 1
16938 @item C-x 1
16939 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16940 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16941 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16942
16943 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16944
16945 @kindex C-x 2
16946 @item C-x 2
16947 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16948 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
16949 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16950 previous layout and the new one.
16951
16952 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16953
16954 @kindex C-x o
16955 @item C-x o
16956 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16957 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
16958 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16959
16960 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16961
16962 @kindex C-x s
16963 @item C-x s
16964 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
16965 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16966 @end table
16967
16968 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
16969
16970 @table @asis
16971 @kindex PgUp
16972 @item @key{PgUp}
16973 Scroll the active window one page up.
16974
16975 @kindex PgDn
16976 @item @key{PgDn}
16977 Scroll the active window one page down.
16978
16979 @kindex Up
16980 @item @key{Up}
16981 Scroll the active window one line up.
16982
16983 @kindex Down
16984 @item @key{Down}
16985 Scroll the active window one line down.
16986
16987 @kindex Left
16988 @item @key{Left}
16989 Scroll the active window one column left.
16990
16991 @kindex Right
16992 @item @key{Right}
16993 Scroll the active window one column right.
16994
16995 @kindex C-L
16996 @item @kbd{C-L}
16997 Refresh the screen.
16998 @end table
16999
17000 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
17001 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
17002 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
17003 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
17004 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
17005
17006 @node TUI Single Key Mode
17007 @section TUI Single Key Mode
17008 @cindex TUI single key mode
17009
17010 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
17011 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
17012 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
17013
17014 @table @kbd
17015 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17016 @item c
17017 continue
17018
17019 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17020 @item d
17021 down
17022
17023 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17024 @item f
17025 finish
17026
17027 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17028 @item n
17029 next
17030
17031 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17032 @item q
17033 exit the SingleKey mode.
17034
17035 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17036 @item r
17037 run
17038
17039 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17040 @item s
17041 step
17042
17043 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17044 @item u
17045 up
17046
17047 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17048 @item v
17049 info locals
17050
17051 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17052 @item w
17053 where
17054 @end table
17055
17056 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17057 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17058 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17059 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17060 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17061 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17062
17063
17064 @node TUI Commands
17065 @section TUI-specific Commands
17066 @cindex TUI commands
17067
17068 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17069 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
17070 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
17071 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
17072
17073 @table @code
17074 @item info win
17075 @kindex info win
17076 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17077
17078 @item layout next
17079 @kindex layout
17080 Display the next layout.
17081
17082 @item layout prev
17083 Display the previous layout.
17084
17085 @item layout src
17086 Display the source window only.
17087
17088 @item layout asm
17089 Display the assembly window only.
17090
17091 @item layout split
17092 Display the source and assembly window.
17093
17094 @item layout regs
17095 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17096
17097 @item focus next
17098 @kindex focus
17099 Make the next window active for scrolling.
17100
17101 @item focus prev
17102 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
17103
17104 @item focus src
17105 Make the source window active for scrolling.
17106
17107 @item focus asm
17108 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
17109
17110 @item focus regs
17111 Make the register window active for scrolling.
17112
17113 @item focus cmd
17114 Make the command window active for scrolling.
17115
17116 @item refresh
17117 @kindex refresh
17118 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17119
17120 @item tui reg float
17121 @kindex tui reg
17122 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17123
17124 @item tui reg general
17125 Show the general registers in the register window.
17126
17127 @item tui reg next
17128 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17129 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17130 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17131 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17132
17133 @item tui reg system
17134 Show the system registers in the register window.
17135
17136 @item update
17137 @kindex update
17138 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17139
17140 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17141 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17142 @kindex winheight
17143 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17144 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17145 decrease it.
17146
17147 @item tabset @var{nchars}
17148 @kindex tabset
17149 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17150 @end table
17151
17152 @node TUI Configuration
17153 @section TUI Configuration Variables
17154 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17155
17156 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
17157
17158 @table @code
17159 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17160 @kindex set tui border-kind
17161 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17162 The possible values are the following:
17163 @table @code
17164 @item space
17165 Use a space character to draw the border.
17166
17167 @item ascii
17168 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
17169
17170 @item acs
17171 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17172 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17173 @end table
17174
17175 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17176 @kindex set tui border-mode
17177 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17178 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17179 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
17180 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17181 @table @code
17182 @item normal
17183 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17184
17185 @item standout
17186 Use standout mode.
17187
17188 @item reverse
17189 Use reverse video mode.
17190
17191 @item half
17192 Use half bright mode.
17193
17194 @item half-standout
17195 Use half bright and standout mode.
17196
17197 @item bold
17198 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17199
17200 @item bold-standout
17201 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17202 @end table
17203 @end table
17204
17205 @node Emacs
17206 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17207
17208 @cindex Emacs
17209 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17210 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17211 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17212 @value{GDBN}.
17213
17214 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17215 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17216 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17217 created Emacs buffer.
17218 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17219
17220 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17221 things:
17222
17223 @itemize @bullet
17224 @item
17225 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
17226 the GUD buffer.
17227
17228 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17229 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17230
17231 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17232 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17233 in this way.
17234
17235 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17236 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17237 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17238 stop.
17239
17240 @item
17241 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17242
17243 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17244 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17245 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17246 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17247 and the source.
17248
17249 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17250 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17251 @end itemize
17252
17253 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
17254 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
17255 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
17256 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
17257
17258 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17259 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17260 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17261 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17262 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17263 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17264 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17265 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17266 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17267
17268 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17269 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
17270 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
17271 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17272
17273 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17274 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17275 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17276 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17277 one you want.
17278
17279 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17280 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17281
17282 @table @kbd
17283 @item C-h m
17284 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
17285
17286 @item C-c C-s
17287 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17288 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17289
17290 @item C-c C-n
17291 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17292 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17293 to show the current file and location.
17294
17295 @item C-c C-i
17296 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17297 display window accordingly.
17298
17299 @item C-c C-f
17300 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17301 @code{finish} command.
17302
17303 @item C-c C-r
17304 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17305 command.
17306
17307 @item C-c <
17308 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17309 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17310 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17311
17312 @item C-c >
17313 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17314 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17315 @end table
17316
17317 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17318 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17319
17320 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
17321 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
17322 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
17323 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
17324 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
17325 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
17326 speedbar displays watch expressions.
17327
17328 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17329 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17330 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17331 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17332 frame.
17333
17334 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17335 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17336 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17337 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17338 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17339 to correspond properly with the code.
17340
17341 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
17342 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
17343 Emacs Manual}).
17344
17345 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17346 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17347 @ignore
17348 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17349 @kindex Epoch
17350 @kindex inspect
17351
17352 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17353 called the @code{epoch}
17354 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17355 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17356 each value is printed in its own window.
17357 @end ignore
17358
17359
17360 @node GDB/MI
17361 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17362
17363 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17364
17365 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17366 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17367 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17368 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17369 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17370 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17371
17372 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17373 in the form of a reference manual.
17374
17375 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17376 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17377 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17378
17379 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17380
17381 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17382 This chapter uses the following notation:
17383
17384 @itemize @bullet
17385 @item
17386 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17387
17388 @item
17389 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17390 it may or may not be given.
17391
17392 @item
17393 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17394 may repeat zero or more times.
17395
17396 @item
17397 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17398 may repeat one or more times.
17399
17400 @item
17401 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17402 @end itemize
17403
17404 @ignore
17405 @heading Dependencies
17406 @end ignore
17407
17408 @menu
17409 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17410 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17411 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17412 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17413 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17414 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17415 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17416 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17417 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17418 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17419 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17420 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17421 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17422 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17423 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17424 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17425 @ignore
17426 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17427 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17428 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17429 @end ignore
17430 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17431 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
17432 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17433 @end menu
17434
17435 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17436 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17437 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17438
17439 @menu
17440 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17441 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17442 @end menu
17443
17444 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17445 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17446
17447 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17448 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17449 @table @code
17450 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17451 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17452
17453 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17454 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17455 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17456
17457 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17458 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17459 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17460
17461 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17462 "any sequence of digits"
17463
17464 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17465 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17466
17467 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17468 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17469
17470 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17471 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17472
17473 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17474 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17475 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17476
17477 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17478 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17479
17480 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17481 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17482 @end table
17483
17484 @noindent
17485 Notes:
17486
17487 @itemize @bullet
17488 @item
17489 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17490 output is described below.
17491
17492 @item
17493 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17494 finishes.
17495
17496 @item
17497 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17498 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17499 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17500 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17501 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17502 @end itemize
17503
17504 Pragmatics:
17505
17506 @itemize @bullet
17507 @item
17508 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17509
17510 @item
17511 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17512 @end itemize
17513
17514 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17515 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17516
17517 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17518 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17519 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17520 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17521 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17522 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17523
17524 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17525 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17526 @var{token}.
17527
17528 @table @code
17529 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17530 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17531
17532 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17533 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17534
17535 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17536 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17537
17538 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17539 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17540
17541 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17542 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17543
17544 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17545 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17546
17547 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17548 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17549
17550 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17551 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17552
17553 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17554 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17555
17556 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17557 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17558 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17559
17560 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17561 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17562
17563 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17564 @code{ @var{string} }
17565
17566 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17567 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17568
17569 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17570 @code{@var{c-string}}
17571
17572 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17573 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17574
17575 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17576 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17577 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17578
17579 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17580 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17581
17582 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17583 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17584
17585 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17586 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17587
17588 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17589 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17590
17591 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17592 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17593
17594 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17595 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17596 @end table
17597
17598 @noindent
17599 Notes:
17600
17601 @itemize @bullet
17602 @item
17603 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17604
17605 @item
17606 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17607 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17608 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17609 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17610
17611 @item
17612 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17613 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17614 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17615 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17616
17617 @item
17618 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17619 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17620 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17621 @samp{*}.
17622
17623 @item
17624 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17625 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17626 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17627 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17628
17629 @item
17630 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17631 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17632 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17633 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17634
17635 @item
17636 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17637 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17638 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17639
17640 @item
17641 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17642 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17643 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17644 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17645
17646 @item
17647 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17648 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17649 @var{values}.
17650
17651
17652 @end itemize
17653
17654 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17655 details about the various output records.
17656
17657 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17658 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17659 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17660
17661 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17662 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17663
17664 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17665 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17666 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17667 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17668 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17669 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17670
17671 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17672 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17673 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17674
17675 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17676 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17677 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17678 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17679
17680 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17681 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17682
17683 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17684 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17685 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17686 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17687 might change.
17688
17689 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17690 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17691 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17692 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17693
17694 @itemize @bullet
17695 @item
17696 New MI commands may be added.
17697
17698 @item
17699 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17700
17701 @item
17702 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17703 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
17704
17705 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17706 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17707
17708 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17709 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17710 @end itemize
17711
17712 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17713 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17714 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17715 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17716 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17717
17718 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17719 @c version?
17720
17721 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17722 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17723 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17724 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17725 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17726 Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17727 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17728 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17729 @cindex mailing lists
17730
17731 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17732 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17733 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17734
17735 @menu
17736 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17737 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17738 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17739 @end menu
17740
17741 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17742 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17743
17744 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17745 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17746 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17747 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17748
17749 @table @code
17750 @findex ^done
17751 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17752 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17753 values.
17754
17755 @item "^running"
17756 @findex ^running
17757 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17758 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17759 running.
17760
17761 @item "^connected"
17762 @findex ^connected
17763 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
17764
17765 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17766 @findex ^error
17767 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17768 error message.
17769
17770 @item "^exit"
17771 @findex ^exit
17772 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
17773
17774 @end table
17775
17776 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17777 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17778
17779 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17780 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17781 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17782 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17783 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17784
17785 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17786 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17787 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17788 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17789 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17790
17791 @table @code
17792 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17793 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17794 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17795
17796 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17797 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17798 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17799 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17800
17801 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17802 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17803 internals.
17804 @end table
17805
17806 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17807 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17808
17809 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17810 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17811 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17812 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17813 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17814 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17815
17816 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17817 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17818
17819 @table @code
17820 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17821 @end table
17822
17823 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17824
17825 @table @code
17826 @item breakpoint-hit
17827 A breakpoint was reached.
17828 @item watchpoint-trigger
17829 A watchpoint was triggered.
17830 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17831 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17832 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17833 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17834 @item function-finished
17835 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17836 @item location-reached
17837 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17838 @item watchpoint-scope
17839 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17840 @item end-stepping-range
17841 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17842 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17843 @item exited-signalled
17844 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17845 @item exited
17846 The inferior exited.
17847 @item exited-normally
17848 The inferior exited normally.
17849 @item signal-received
17850 A signal was received by the inferior.
17851 @end table
17852
17853
17854 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17855 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17856 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17857 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17858
17859 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17860 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17861 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17862 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17863
17864 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17865 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17866
17867 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
17868
17869 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17870 information of the breakpoint.
17871
17872 @smallexample
17873 -> -break-insert main
17874 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17875 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17876 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17877 <- (gdb)
17878 @end smallexample
17879
17880 @subheading Program Execution
17881
17882 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17883 reason that execution stopped.
17884
17885 @smallexample
17886 -> -exec-run
17887 <- ^running
17888 <- (gdb)
17889 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17890 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17891 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17892 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17893 <- (gdb)
17894 -> -exec-continue
17895 <- ^running
17896 <- (gdb)
17897 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17898 <- (gdb)
17899 @end smallexample
17900
17901 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
17902
17903 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17904
17905 @smallexample
17906 -> (gdb)
17907 <- -gdb-exit
17908 <- ^exit
17909 @end smallexample
17910
17911 @subheading A Bad Command
17912
17913 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17914
17915 @smallexample
17916 -> -rubbish
17917 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17918 <- (gdb)
17919 @end smallexample
17920
17921
17922 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17923 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17924 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17925
17926 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17927 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17928
17929 @subheading Motivation
17930
17931 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17932
17933 @subheading Introduction
17934
17935 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17936
17937 @subheading Commands
17938
17939 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17940
17941 @subsubheading Synopsis
17942
17943 @smallexample
17944 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17945 @end smallexample
17946
17947 @subsubheading Result
17948
17949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17950
17951 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17952
17953 @subsubheading Example
17954
17955 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17956 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17957
17958
17959 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17960 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17961 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17962
17963 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17964 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17965 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17966 breakpoints.
17967
17968 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17969 @findex -break-after
17970
17971 @subsubheading Synopsis
17972
17973 @smallexample
17974 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17975 @end smallexample
17976
17977 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17978 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17979 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17980 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17981
17982 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17983
17984 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17985
17986 @subsubheading Example
17987
17988 @smallexample
17989 (gdb)
17990 -break-insert main
17991 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
17992 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
17993 (gdb)
17994 -break-after 1 3
17995 ~
17996 ^done
17997 (gdb)
17998 -break-list
17999 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18000 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18001 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18002 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18003 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18004 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18005 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18006 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18007 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18008 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18009 (gdb)
18010 @end smallexample
18011
18012 @ignore
18013 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18014 @findex -break-catch
18015
18016 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18017 @findex -break-commands
18018 @end ignore
18019
18020
18021 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18022 @findex -break-condition
18023
18024 @subsubheading Synopsis
18025
18026 @smallexample
18027 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18028 @end smallexample
18029
18030 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18031 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18032 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18033 command below).
18034
18035 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18036
18037 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18038
18039 @subsubheading Example
18040
18041 @smallexample
18042 (gdb)
18043 -break-condition 1 1
18044 ^done
18045 (gdb)
18046 -break-list
18047 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18048 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18049 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18050 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18051 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18052 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18053 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18054 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18055 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18056 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18057 (gdb)
18058 @end smallexample
18059
18060 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18061 @findex -break-delete
18062
18063 @subsubheading Synopsis
18064
18065 @smallexample
18066 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18067 @end smallexample
18068
18069 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18070 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18071
18072 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18073
18074 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18075
18076 @subsubheading Example
18077
18078 @smallexample
18079 (gdb)
18080 -break-delete 1
18081 ^done
18082 (gdb)
18083 -break-list
18084 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18085 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18086 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18087 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18088 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18089 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18090 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18091 body=[]@}
18092 (gdb)
18093 @end smallexample
18094
18095 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18096 @findex -break-disable
18097
18098 @subsubheading Synopsis
18099
18100 @smallexample
18101 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18102 @end smallexample
18103
18104 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18105 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18106
18107 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18108
18109 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18110
18111 @subsubheading Example
18112
18113 @smallexample
18114 (gdb)
18115 -break-disable 2
18116 ^done
18117 (gdb)
18118 -break-list
18119 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18120 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18121 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18122 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18123 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18124 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18125 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18126 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18127 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18128 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18129 (gdb)
18130 @end smallexample
18131
18132 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18133 @findex -break-enable
18134
18135 @subsubheading Synopsis
18136
18137 @smallexample
18138 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18139 @end smallexample
18140
18141 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18142
18143 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18144
18145 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18146
18147 @subsubheading Example
18148
18149 @smallexample
18150 (gdb)
18151 -break-enable 2
18152 ^done
18153 (gdb)
18154 -break-list
18155 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18156 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18157 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18158 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18159 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18160 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18161 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18162 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18163 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18164 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18165 (gdb)
18166 @end smallexample
18167
18168 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18169 @findex -break-info
18170
18171 @subsubheading Synopsis
18172
18173 @smallexample
18174 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18175 @end smallexample
18176
18177 @c REDUNDANT???
18178 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18179
18180 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18181
18182 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18183
18184 @subsubheading Example
18185 N.A.
18186
18187 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18188 @findex -break-insert
18189
18190 @subsubheading Synopsis
18191
18192 @smallexample
18193 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
18194 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18195 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
18196 @end smallexample
18197
18198 @noindent
18199 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
18200
18201 @itemize @bullet
18202 @item function
18203 @c @item +offset
18204 @c @item -offset
18205 @c @item linenum
18206 @item filename:linenum
18207 @item filename:function
18208 @item *address
18209 @end itemize
18210
18211 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18212
18213 @table @samp
18214 @item -t
18215 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18216 @item -h
18217 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18218 @item -c @var{condition}
18219 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18220 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18221 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18222 @item -f
18223 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
18224 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
18225 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
18226 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
18227 cannot be parsed.
18228 @end table
18229
18230 @subsubheading Result
18231
18232 The result is in the form:
18233
18234 @smallexample
18235 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18236 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18237 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18238 times="@var{times}"@}
18239 @end smallexample
18240
18241 @noindent
18242 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18243 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18244 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18245 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18246 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18247 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18248 which use the same output).
18249
18250 Note: this format is open to change.
18251 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18252
18253 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18254
18255 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18256 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18257
18258 @subsubheading Example
18259
18260 @smallexample
18261 (gdb)
18262 -break-insert main
18263 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18264 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18265 (gdb)
18266 -break-insert -t foo
18267 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18268 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18269 (gdb)
18270 -break-list
18271 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18272 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18273 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18274 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18275 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18276 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18277 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18278 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18279 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18280 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18281 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18282 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18283 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18284 (gdb)
18285 -break-insert -r foo.*
18286 ~int foo(int, int);
18287 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18288 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18289 (gdb)
18290 @end smallexample
18291
18292 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18293 @findex -break-list
18294
18295 @subsubheading Synopsis
18296
18297 @smallexample
18298 -break-list
18299 @end smallexample
18300
18301 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18302
18303 @table @samp
18304 @item Number
18305 number of the breakpoint
18306 @item Type
18307 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18308 @item Disposition
18309 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18310 or @samp{nokeep}
18311 @item Enabled
18312 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18313 @item Address
18314 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18315 @item What
18316 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18317 name, line number
18318 @item Times
18319 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18320 @end table
18321
18322 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18323 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18324
18325 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18326
18327 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18328
18329 @subsubheading Example
18330
18331 @smallexample
18332 (gdb)
18333 -break-list
18334 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18335 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18336 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18337 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18338 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18339 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18340 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18341 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18342 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18343 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18344 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18345 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18346 (gdb)
18347 @end smallexample
18348
18349 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18350
18351 @smallexample
18352 (gdb)
18353 -break-list
18354 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18355 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18356 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18357 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18358 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18359 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18360 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18361 body=[]@}
18362 (gdb)
18363 @end smallexample
18364
18365 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18366 @findex -break-watch
18367
18368 @subsubheading Synopsis
18369
18370 @smallexample
18371 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18372 @end smallexample
18373
18374 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18375 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18376 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18377 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18378 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18379 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18380 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18381 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18382
18383 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18384 breakpoints inserted.
18385
18386 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18387
18388 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18389 @samp{rwatch}.
18390
18391 @subsubheading Example
18392
18393 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18394
18395 @smallexample
18396 (gdb)
18397 -break-watch x
18398 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18399 (gdb)
18400 -exec-continue
18401 ^running
18402 (gdb)
18403 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18404 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18405 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18406 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18407 (gdb)
18408 @end smallexample
18409
18410 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18411 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18412 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18413
18414 @smallexample
18415 (gdb)
18416 -break-watch C
18417 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18418 (gdb)
18419 -exec-continue
18420 ^running
18421 (gdb)
18422 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18423 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18424 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18425 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18426 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18427 (gdb)
18428 -exec-continue
18429 ^running
18430 (gdb)
18431 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18432 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18433 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18434 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18435 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18436 (gdb)
18437 @end smallexample
18438
18439 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18440 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18441 deleted.
18442
18443 @smallexample
18444 (gdb)
18445 -break-watch C
18446 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18447 (gdb)
18448 -break-list
18449 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18450 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18451 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18452 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18453 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18454 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18455 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18456 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18457 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18458 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18459 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18460 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18461 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18462 (gdb)
18463 -exec-continue
18464 ^running
18465 (gdb)
18466 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18467 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18468 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18469 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18470 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18471 (gdb)
18472 -break-list
18473 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18474 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18475 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18476 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18477 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18478 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18479 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18480 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18481 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18482 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18483 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18484 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18485 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18486 (gdb)
18487 -exec-continue
18488 ^running
18489 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18490 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18491 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18492 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18493 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18494 (gdb)
18495 -break-list
18496 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18497 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18498 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18499 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18500 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18501 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18502 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18503 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18504 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18505 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18506 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18507 times="1"@}]@}
18508 (gdb)
18509 @end smallexample
18510
18511 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18512 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18513 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18514
18515 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18516 @findex -exec-arguments
18517
18518
18519 @subsubheading Synopsis
18520
18521 @smallexample
18522 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18523 @end smallexample
18524
18525 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18526 @samp{-exec-run}.
18527
18528 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18529
18530 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18531
18532 @subsubheading Example
18533
18534 @c FIXME!
18535 Don't have one around.
18536
18537
18538 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18539 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18540
18541 @subsubheading Synopsis
18542
18543 @smallexample
18544 -exec-show-arguments
18545 @end smallexample
18546
18547 Print the arguments of the program.
18548
18549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18550
18551 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18552
18553 @subsubheading Example
18554 N.A.
18555
18556
18557 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18558 @findex -environment-cd
18559
18560 @subsubheading Synopsis
18561
18562 @smallexample
18563 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18564 @end smallexample
18565
18566 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18567
18568 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18569
18570 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18571
18572 @subsubheading Example
18573
18574 @smallexample
18575 (gdb)
18576 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18577 ^done
18578 (gdb)
18579 @end smallexample
18580
18581
18582 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18583 @findex -environment-directory
18584
18585 @subsubheading Synopsis
18586
18587 @smallexample
18588 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18589 @end smallexample
18590
18591 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18592 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18593 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18594 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18595 occurs as normal.
18596 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18597 multiple directories in a single command
18598 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18599 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18600 If blanks are needed as
18601 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18602 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18603 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18604 character must not be used
18605 in any directory name.
18606 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18607
18608 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18609
18610 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18611
18612 @subsubheading Example
18613
18614 @smallexample
18615 (gdb)
18616 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18617 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18618 (gdb)
18619 -environment-directory ""
18620 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18621 (gdb)
18622 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18623 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18624 (gdb)
18625 -environment-directory -r
18626 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18627 (gdb)
18628 @end smallexample
18629
18630
18631 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18632 @findex -environment-path
18633
18634 @subsubheading Synopsis
18635
18636 @smallexample
18637 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18638 @end smallexample
18639
18640 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18641 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18642 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18643 supplied in addition to the
18644 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18645 occurs as normal.
18646 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18647 multiple directories in a single command
18648 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18649 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18650 If blanks are needed as
18651 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18652 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18653 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18654 character must not be used
18655 in any directory name.
18656 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18657
18658
18659 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18660
18661 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18662
18663 @subsubheading Example
18664
18665 @smallexample
18666 (gdb)
18667 -environment-path
18668 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18669 (gdb)
18670 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18671 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18672 (gdb)
18673 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18674 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18675 (gdb)
18676 @end smallexample
18677
18678
18679 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18680 @findex -environment-pwd
18681
18682 @subsubheading Synopsis
18683
18684 @smallexample
18685 -environment-pwd
18686 @end smallexample
18687
18688 Show the current working directory.
18689
18690 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18691
18692 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18693
18694 @subsubheading Example
18695
18696 @smallexample
18697 (gdb)
18698 -environment-pwd
18699 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18700 (gdb)
18701 @end smallexample
18702
18703 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18704 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18705 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18706
18707
18708 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18709 @findex -thread-info
18710
18711 @subsubheading Synopsis
18712
18713 @smallexample
18714 -thread-info
18715 @end smallexample
18716
18717 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18718
18719 No equivalent.
18720
18721 @subsubheading Example
18722 N.A.
18723
18724
18725 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18726 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18727
18728 @subsubheading Synopsis
18729
18730 @smallexample
18731 -thread-list-all-threads
18732 @end smallexample
18733
18734 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18735
18736 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18737
18738 @subsubheading Example
18739 N.A.
18740
18741
18742 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18743 @findex -thread-list-ids
18744
18745 @subsubheading Synopsis
18746
18747 @smallexample
18748 -thread-list-ids
18749 @end smallexample
18750
18751 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18752 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18753
18754 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18755
18756 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18757
18758 @subsubheading Example
18759
18760 No threads present, besides the main process:
18761
18762 @smallexample
18763 (gdb)
18764 -thread-list-ids
18765 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18766 (gdb)
18767 @end smallexample
18768
18769
18770 Several threads:
18771
18772 @smallexample
18773 (gdb)
18774 -thread-list-ids
18775 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18776 number-of-threads="3"
18777 (gdb)
18778 @end smallexample
18779
18780
18781 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18782 @findex -thread-select
18783
18784 @subsubheading Synopsis
18785
18786 @smallexample
18787 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18788 @end smallexample
18789
18790 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18791 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18792
18793 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18794
18795 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18796
18797 @subsubheading Example
18798
18799 @smallexample
18800 (gdb)
18801 -exec-next
18802 ^running
18803 (gdb)
18804 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18805 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18806 (gdb)
18807 -thread-list-ids
18808 ^done,
18809 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18810 number-of-threads="3"
18811 (gdb)
18812 -thread-select 3
18813 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18814 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18815 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18816 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18817 (gdb)
18818 @end smallexample
18819
18820 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18821 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18822 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18823
18824 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18825 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
18826 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18827 other cases.
18828
18829 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18830 @findex -exec-continue
18831
18832 @subsubheading Synopsis
18833
18834 @smallexample
18835 -exec-continue
18836 @end smallexample
18837
18838 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18839 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18840
18841 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18842
18843 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18844
18845 @subsubheading Example
18846
18847 @smallexample
18848 -exec-continue
18849 ^running
18850 (gdb)
18851 @@Hello world
18852 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18853 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18854 (gdb)
18855 @end smallexample
18856
18857
18858 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18859 @findex -exec-finish
18860
18861 @subsubheading Synopsis
18862
18863 @smallexample
18864 -exec-finish
18865 @end smallexample
18866
18867 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18868 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18869
18870 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18871
18872 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18873
18874 @subsubheading Example
18875
18876 Function returning @code{void}.
18877
18878 @smallexample
18879 -exec-finish
18880 ^running
18881 (gdb)
18882 @@hello from foo
18883 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18884 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18885 (gdb)
18886 @end smallexample
18887
18888 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18889 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18890 value itself.
18891
18892 @smallexample
18893 -exec-finish
18894 ^running
18895 (gdb)
18896 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18897 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18898 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18899 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18900 (gdb)
18901 @end smallexample
18902
18903
18904 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18905 @findex -exec-interrupt
18906
18907 @subsubheading Synopsis
18908
18909 @smallexample
18910 -exec-interrupt
18911 @end smallexample
18912
18913 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18914 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18915 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18916 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18917 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18918
18919 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18920
18921 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18922
18923 @subsubheading Example
18924
18925 @smallexample
18926 (gdb)
18927 111-exec-continue
18928 111^running
18929
18930 (gdb)
18931 222-exec-interrupt
18932 222^done
18933 (gdb)
18934 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18935 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18936 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18937 (gdb)
18938
18939 (gdb)
18940 -exec-interrupt
18941 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18942 (gdb)
18943 @end smallexample
18944
18945
18946 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18947 @findex -exec-next
18948
18949 @subsubheading Synopsis
18950
18951 @smallexample
18952 -exec-next
18953 @end smallexample
18954
18955 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18956 of the next source line is reached.
18957
18958 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18959
18960 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18961
18962 @subsubheading Example
18963
18964 @smallexample
18965 -exec-next
18966 ^running
18967 (gdb)
18968 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18969 (gdb)
18970 @end smallexample
18971
18972
18973 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18974 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18975
18976 @subsubheading Synopsis
18977
18978 @smallexample
18979 -exec-next-instruction
18980 @end smallexample
18981
18982 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18983 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18984 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18985 printed as well.
18986
18987 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18988
18989 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18990
18991 @subsubheading Example
18992
18993 @smallexample
18994 (gdb)
18995 -exec-next-instruction
18996 ^running
18997
18998 (gdb)
18999 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19000 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19001 (gdb)
19002 @end smallexample
19003
19004
19005 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19006 @findex -exec-return
19007
19008 @subsubheading Synopsis
19009
19010 @smallexample
19011 -exec-return
19012 @end smallexample
19013
19014 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19015 Displays the new current frame.
19016
19017 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19018
19019 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19020
19021 @subsubheading Example
19022
19023 @smallexample
19024 (gdb)
19025 200-break-insert callee4
19026 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19027 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19028 (gdb)
19029 000-exec-run
19030 000^running
19031 (gdb)
19032 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19033 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19034 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19035 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19036 (gdb)
19037 205-break-delete
19038 205^done
19039 (gdb)
19040 111-exec-return
19041 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19042 args=[@{name="strarg",
19043 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19044 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19045 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19046 (gdb)
19047 @end smallexample
19048
19049
19050 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19051 @findex -exec-run
19052
19053 @subsubheading Synopsis
19054
19055 @smallexample
19056 -exec-run
19057 @end smallexample
19058
19059 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19060 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19061 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19062 the program has exited exceptionally.
19063
19064 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19065
19066 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19067
19068 @subsubheading Examples
19069
19070 @smallexample
19071 (gdb)
19072 -break-insert main
19073 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19074 (gdb)
19075 -exec-run
19076 ^running
19077 (gdb)
19078 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19079 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19080 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19081 (gdb)
19082 @end smallexample
19083
19084 @noindent
19085 Program exited normally:
19086
19087 @smallexample
19088 (gdb)
19089 -exec-run
19090 ^running
19091 (gdb)
19092 x = 55
19093 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19094 (gdb)
19095 @end smallexample
19096
19097 @noindent
19098 Program exited exceptionally:
19099
19100 @smallexample
19101 (gdb)
19102 -exec-run
19103 ^running
19104 (gdb)
19105 x = 55
19106 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19107 (gdb)
19108 @end smallexample
19109
19110 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19111 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19112
19113 @smallexample
19114 (gdb)
19115 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19116 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19117 @end smallexample
19118
19119
19120 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19121
19122
19123 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19124 @findex -exec-step
19125
19126 @subsubheading Synopsis
19127
19128 @smallexample
19129 -exec-step
19130 @end smallexample
19131
19132 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19133 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19134 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19135 function.
19136
19137 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19138
19139 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19140
19141 @subsubheading Example
19142
19143 Stepping into a function:
19144
19145 @smallexample
19146 -exec-step
19147 ^running
19148 (gdb)
19149 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19150 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19151 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19152 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19153 (gdb)
19154 @end smallexample
19155
19156 Regular stepping:
19157
19158 @smallexample
19159 -exec-step
19160 ^running
19161 (gdb)
19162 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19163 (gdb)
19164 @end smallexample
19165
19166
19167 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19168 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19169
19170 @subsubheading Synopsis
19171
19172 @smallexample
19173 -exec-step-instruction
19174 @end smallexample
19175
19176 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19177 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19178 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19179 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19180 well.
19181
19182 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19183
19184 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19185
19186 @subsubheading Example
19187
19188 @smallexample
19189 (gdb)
19190 -exec-step-instruction
19191 ^running
19192
19193 (gdb)
19194 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19195 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19196 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19197 (gdb)
19198 -exec-step-instruction
19199 ^running
19200
19201 (gdb)
19202 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19203 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19204 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19205 (gdb)
19206 @end smallexample
19207
19208
19209 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19210 @findex -exec-until
19211
19212 @subsubheading Synopsis
19213
19214 @smallexample
19215 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19216 @end smallexample
19217
19218 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19219 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19220 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19221 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19222
19223 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19224
19225 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19226
19227 @subsubheading Example
19228
19229 @smallexample
19230 (gdb)
19231 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19232 ^running
19233 (gdb)
19234 x = 55
19235 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19236 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19237 (gdb)
19238 @end smallexample
19239
19240 @ignore
19241 @subheading -file-clear
19242 Is this going away????
19243 @end ignore
19244
19245 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19246 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19247 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19248
19249
19250 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19251 @findex -stack-info-frame
19252
19253 @subsubheading Synopsis
19254
19255 @smallexample
19256 -stack-info-frame
19257 @end smallexample
19258
19259 Get info on the selected frame.
19260
19261 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19262
19263 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19264 (without arguments).
19265
19266 @subsubheading Example
19267
19268 @smallexample
19269 (gdb)
19270 -stack-info-frame
19271 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19272 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19273 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19274 (gdb)
19275 @end smallexample
19276
19277 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19278 @findex -stack-info-depth
19279
19280 @subsubheading Synopsis
19281
19282 @smallexample
19283 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19284 @end smallexample
19285
19286 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19287 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19288
19289 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19290
19291 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19292
19293 @subsubheading Example
19294
19295 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19296
19297 @smallexample
19298 (gdb)
19299 -stack-info-depth
19300 ^done,depth="12"
19301 (gdb)
19302 -stack-info-depth 4
19303 ^done,depth="4"
19304 (gdb)
19305 -stack-info-depth 12
19306 ^done,depth="12"
19307 (gdb)
19308 -stack-info-depth 11
19309 ^done,depth="11"
19310 (gdb)
19311 -stack-info-depth 13
19312 ^done,depth="12"
19313 (gdb)
19314 @end smallexample
19315
19316 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19317 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19318
19319 @subsubheading Synopsis
19320
19321 @smallexample
19322 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19323 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19324 @end smallexample
19325
19326 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19327 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19328 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19329 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19330 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19331 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19332 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19333 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19334
19335 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19336 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19337 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19338
19339 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19340
19341 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19342 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19343 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19344
19345 @subsubheading Example
19346
19347 @smallexample
19348 (gdb)
19349 -stack-list-frames
19350 ^done,
19351 stack=[
19352 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19353 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19354 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19355 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19356 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19357 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19358 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19359 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19360 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19361 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19362 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19363 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19364 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19365 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19366 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19367 (gdb)
19368 -stack-list-arguments 0
19369 ^done,
19370 stack-args=[
19371 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19372 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19373 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19374 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19375 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19376 (gdb)
19377 -stack-list-arguments 1
19378 ^done,
19379 stack-args=[
19380 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19381 frame=@{level="1",
19382 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19383 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19384 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19385 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19386 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19387 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19388 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19389 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19390 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19391 (gdb)
19392 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19393 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19394 (gdb)
19395 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19396 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19397 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19398 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19399 (gdb)
19400 @end smallexample
19401
19402 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19403
19404
19405 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19406 @findex -stack-list-frames
19407
19408 @subsubheading Synopsis
19409
19410 @smallexample
19411 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19412 @end smallexample
19413
19414 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19415 following info:
19416
19417 @table @samp
19418 @item @var{level}
19419 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19420 @item @var{addr}
19421 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19422 @item @var{func}
19423 Function name.
19424 @item @var{file}
19425 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19426 @item @var{line}
19427 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19428 @end table
19429
19430 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19431 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19432 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19433 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19434 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19435 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19436 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19437
19438 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19439
19440 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19441
19442 @subsubheading Example
19443
19444 Full stack backtrace:
19445
19446 @smallexample
19447 (gdb)
19448 -stack-list-frames
19449 ^done,stack=
19450 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19451 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19452 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19453 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19454 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19455 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19456 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19457 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19458 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19459 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19460 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19461 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19462 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19463 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19464 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19465 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19466 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19467 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19468 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19469 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19470 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19471 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19472 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19473 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19474 (gdb)
19475 @end smallexample
19476
19477 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19478
19479 @smallexample
19480 (gdb)
19481 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19482 ^done,stack=
19483 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19484 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19485 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19486 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19487 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19488 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19489 (gdb)
19490 @end smallexample
19491
19492 Show a single frame:
19493
19494 @smallexample
19495 (gdb)
19496 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19497 ^done,stack=
19498 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19499 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19500 (gdb)
19501 @end smallexample
19502
19503
19504 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19505 @findex -stack-list-locals
19506
19507 @subsubheading Synopsis
19508
19509 @smallexample
19510 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19511 @end smallexample
19512
19513 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19514 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19515 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19516 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19517 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19518 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19519 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19520 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19521 more detail.
19522
19523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19524
19525 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19526
19527 @subsubheading Example
19528
19529 @smallexample
19530 (gdb)
19531 -stack-list-locals 0
19532 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19533 (gdb)
19534 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19535 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19536 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19537 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19538 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19539 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19540 (gdb)
19541 @end smallexample
19542
19543
19544 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19545 @findex -stack-select-frame
19546
19547 @subsubheading Synopsis
19548
19549 @smallexample
19550 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19551 @end smallexample
19552
19553 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19554 the stack.
19555
19556 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19557
19558 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19559 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19560
19561 @subsubheading Example
19562
19563 @smallexample
19564 (gdb)
19565 -stack-select-frame 2
19566 ^done
19567 (gdb)
19568 @end smallexample
19569
19570 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19571 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19572 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19573
19574 @ignore
19575
19576 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19577
19578 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19579 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19580 used by @code{Insight}.
19581
19582 The two main reasons for that are:
19583
19584 @enumerate 1
19585 @item
19586 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19587
19588 @item
19589 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19590 now).
19591 @end enumerate
19592
19593 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19594 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19595 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19596 hints about their use.
19597
19598 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19599 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19600 least, the following operations:
19601
19602 @itemize @bullet
19603 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19604 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19605 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19606 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19607 @end itemize
19608
19609 @end ignore
19610
19611 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19612
19613 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19614
19615 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19616 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19617 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19618 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19619 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19620 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19621 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19622 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19623 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19624 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19625 object, or to change display format.
19626
19627 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19628 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19629 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19630 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19631 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19632 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
19633 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
19634 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
19635 child will be created.
19636
19637 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19638 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19639 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19640 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19641 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19642
19643 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19644 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19645 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19646 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19647 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
19648 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
19649 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
19650 variables that frontend has created.
19651
19652 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
19653 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
19654 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
19655 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
19656 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
19657 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
19658 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
19659 implicitly updated.
19660
19661 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19662 access this functionality:
19663
19664 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19665 @item @strong{Operation}
19666 @tab @strong{Description}
19667
19668 @item @code{-var-create}
19669 @tab create a variable object
19670 @item @code{-var-delete}
19671 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19672 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19673 @tab set the display format of this variable
19674 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19675 @tab show the display format of this variable
19676 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19677 @tab tells how many children this object has
19678 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19679 @tab return a list of the object's children
19680 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19681 @tab show the type of this variable object
19682 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19683 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
19684 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
19685 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
19686 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19687 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19688 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19689 @tab get the value of this variable
19690 @item @code{-var-assign}
19691 @tab set the value of this variable
19692 @item @code{-var-update}
19693 @tab update the variable and its children
19694 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
19695 @tab set frozeness attribute
19696 @end multitable
19697
19698 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19699 how it can be used.
19700
19701 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19702
19703 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19704 @findex -var-create
19705
19706 @subsubheading Synopsis
19707
19708 @smallexample
19709 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19710 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19711 @end smallexample
19712
19713 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19714 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19715 register.
19716
19717 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19718 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19719 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19720 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19721 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19722
19723 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19724 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19725 frame should be used.
19726
19727 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19728 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19729
19730 @itemize @bullet
19731 @item
19732 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19733
19734 @item
19735 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19736
19737 @item
19738 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19739 @end itemize
19740
19741 @subsubheading Result
19742
19743 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19744 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19745 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19746
19747 @smallexample
19748 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19749 @end smallexample
19750
19751
19752 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19753 @findex -var-delete
19754
19755 @subsubheading Synopsis
19756
19757 @smallexample
19758 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19759 @end smallexample
19760
19761 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19762 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19763
19764 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19765
19766
19767 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19768 @findex -var-set-format
19769
19770 @subsubheading Synopsis
19771
19772 @smallexample
19773 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19774 @end smallexample
19775
19776 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19777 @var{format-spec}.
19778
19779 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19780
19781 @smallexample
19782 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19783 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19784 @end smallexample
19785
19786 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
19787 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19788 for pointers, etc.).
19789
19790 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
19791 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
19792
19793 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19794 @findex -var-show-format
19795
19796 @subsubheading Synopsis
19797
19798 @smallexample
19799 -var-show-format @var{name}
19800 @end smallexample
19801
19802 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19803
19804 @smallexample
19805 @var{format} @expansion{}
19806 @var{format-spec}
19807 @end smallexample
19808
19809
19810 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19811 @findex -var-info-num-children
19812
19813 @subsubheading Synopsis
19814
19815 @smallexample
19816 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19817 @end smallexample
19818
19819 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19820
19821 @smallexample
19822 numchild=@var{n}
19823 @end smallexample
19824
19825
19826 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19827 @findex -var-list-children
19828
19829 @subsubheading Synopsis
19830
19831 @smallexample
19832 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19833 @end smallexample
19834 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19835
19836 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19837 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19838 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19839 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19840 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19841 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19842 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19843 and unions.
19844
19845 @subsubheading Example
19846
19847 @smallexample
19848 (gdb)
19849 -var-list-children n
19850 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19851 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19852 (gdb)
19853 -var-list-children --all-values n
19854 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19855 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19856 @end smallexample
19857
19858
19859 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19860 @findex -var-info-type
19861
19862 @subsubheading Synopsis
19863
19864 @smallexample
19865 -var-info-type @var{name}
19866 @end smallexample
19867
19868 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19869 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19870 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19871
19872 @smallexample
19873 type=@var{typename}
19874 @end smallexample
19875
19876
19877 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19878 @findex -var-info-expression
19879
19880 @subsubheading Synopsis
19881
19882 @smallexample
19883 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19884 @end smallexample
19885
19886 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
19887 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
19888 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
19889
19890 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
19891 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
19892
19893 @smallexample
19894 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
19895 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
19896 @end smallexample
19897
19898 @noindent
19899 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19900
19901 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
19902 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
19903 is of limited use.
19904
19905 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
19906 @findex -var-info-path-expression
19907
19908 @subsubheading Synopsis
19909
19910 @smallexample
19911 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
19912 @end smallexample
19913
19914 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
19915 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
19916 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
19917 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
19918 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
19919 watchpoint from a variable object.
19920
19921 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
19922 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
19923 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
19924 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
19925 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
19926 @smallexample
19927 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
19928 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
19929 @end smallexample
19930
19931 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19932 @findex -var-show-attributes
19933
19934 @subsubheading Synopsis
19935
19936 @smallexample
19937 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19938 @end smallexample
19939
19940 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19941
19942 @smallexample
19943 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19944 @end smallexample
19945
19946 @noindent
19947 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19948
19949 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19950 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19951
19952 @subsubheading Synopsis
19953
19954 @smallexample
19955 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19956 @end smallexample
19957
19958 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19959 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
19960 string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
19961
19962 @smallexample
19963 value=@var{value}
19964 @end smallexample
19965
19966 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19967 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19968
19969 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19970 @findex -var-assign
19971
19972 @subsubheading Synopsis
19973
19974 @smallexample
19975 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19976 @end smallexample
19977
19978 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19979 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19980 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19981 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19982
19983 @subsubheading Example
19984
19985 @smallexample
19986 (gdb)
19987 -var-assign var1 3
19988 ^done,value="3"
19989 (gdb)
19990 -var-update *
19991 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19992 (gdb)
19993 @end smallexample
19994
19995 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19996 @findex -var-update
19997
19998 @subsubheading Synopsis
19999
20000 @smallexample
20001 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20002 @end smallexample
20003
20004 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
20005 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
20006 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
20007 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
20008 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
20009 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
20010 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
20011 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
20012 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
20013 names are printed. The possible values of this options are the same
20014 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
20015 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
20016 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
20017
20018
20019 @subsubheading Example
20020
20021 @smallexample
20022 (gdb)
20023 -var-assign var1 3
20024 ^done,value="3"
20025 (gdb)
20026 -var-update --all-values var1
20027 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20028 type_changed="false"@}]
20029 (gdb)
20030 @end smallexample
20031
20032 @anchor{-var-update}
20033 The field in_scope may take three values:
20034
20035 @table @code
20036 @item "true"
20037 The variable object's current value is valid.
20038
20039 @item "false"
20040 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
20041 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
20042 scope.
20043
20044 @item "invalid"
20045 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
20046 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
20047 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
20048 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
20049 objects.
20050 @end table
20051
20052 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
20053 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
20054
20055 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
20056 @findex -var-set-frozen
20057 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
20058
20059 @subsubheading Synopsis
20060
20061 @smallexample
20062 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
20063 @end smallexample
20064
20065 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
20066 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
20067 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
20068 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
20069 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
20070 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
20071 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
20072 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
20073 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
20074 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
20075 @code{-var-update} does.
20076
20077 @subsubheading Example
20078
20079 @smallexample
20080 (gdb)
20081 -var-set-frozen V 1
20082 ^done
20083 (gdb)
20084 @end smallexample
20085
20086
20087 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20088 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
20089 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
20090
20091 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
20092 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
20093 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
20094 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
20095
20096 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
20097 @c @subheading -data-assign
20098 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
20099 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
20100 @c set variable
20101 @c @subsubheading Example
20102 @c N.A.
20103
20104 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
20105 @findex -data-disassemble
20106
20107 @subsubheading Synopsis
20108
20109 @smallexample
20110 -data-disassemble
20111 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20112 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20113 -- @var{mode}
20114 @end smallexample
20115
20116 @noindent
20117 Where:
20118
20119 @table @samp
20120 @item @var{start-addr}
20121 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20122 @item @var{end-addr}
20123 is the end address
20124 @item @var{filename}
20125 is the name of the file to disassemble
20126 @item @var{linenum}
20127 is the line number to disassemble around
20128 @item @var{lines}
20129 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20130 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20131 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20132 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20133 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20134 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20135 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20136 are displayed.
20137 @item @var{mode}
20138 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20139 disassembly).
20140 @end table
20141
20142 @subsubheading Result
20143
20144 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20145
20146 @itemize @bullet
20147 @item Address
20148 @item Func-name
20149 @item Offset
20150 @item Instruction
20151 @end itemize
20152
20153 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20154 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
20155
20156 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20157
20158 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20159
20160 @subsubheading Example
20161
20162 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20163
20164 @smallexample
20165 (gdb)
20166 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20167 ^done,
20168 asm_insns=[
20169 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20170 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20171 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20172 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20173 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20174 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20175 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20176 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20177 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20178 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20179 (gdb)
20180 @end smallexample
20181
20182 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20183 @code{main}.
20184
20185 @smallexample
20186 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20187 ^done,asm_insns=[
20188 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20189 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20190 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20191 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20192 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20193 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20194 [@dots{}]
20195 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20196 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20197 (gdb)
20198 @end smallexample
20199
20200 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20201
20202 @smallexample
20203 (gdb)
20204 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20205 ^done,asm_insns=[
20206 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20207 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20208 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20209 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20210 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20211 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20212 (gdb)
20213 @end smallexample
20214
20215 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20216
20217 @smallexample
20218 (gdb)
20219 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20220 ^done,asm_insns=[
20221 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20222 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20223 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20224 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20225 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20226 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20227 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20228 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20229 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20230 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20231 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20232 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20233 (gdb)
20234 @end smallexample
20235
20236
20237 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20238 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20239
20240 @subsubheading Synopsis
20241
20242 @smallexample
20243 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20244 @end smallexample
20245
20246 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20247 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20248 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20249
20250 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20251
20252 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20253 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20254 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20255
20256 @subsubheading Example
20257
20258 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20259 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20260 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20261 output.
20262
20263 @smallexample
20264 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20265 211^done,value="1"
20266 (gdb)
20267 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20268 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20269 (gdb)
20270 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20271 411^done,value="4"
20272 (gdb)
20273 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20274 511^done,value="4"
20275 (gdb)
20276 @end smallexample
20277
20278
20279 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20280 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20281
20282 @subsubheading Synopsis
20283
20284 @smallexample
20285 -data-list-changed-registers
20286 @end smallexample
20287
20288 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20289
20290 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20291
20292 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20293 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20294
20295 @subsubheading Example
20296
20297 On a PPC MBX board:
20298
20299 @smallexample
20300 (gdb)
20301 -exec-continue
20302 ^running
20303
20304 (gdb)
20305 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20306 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20307 (gdb)
20308 -data-list-changed-registers
20309 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20310 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20311 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20312 (gdb)
20313 @end smallexample
20314
20315
20316 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20317 @findex -data-list-register-names
20318
20319 @subsubheading Synopsis
20320
20321 @smallexample
20322 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20323 @end smallexample
20324
20325 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20326 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20327 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20328 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20329 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20330 include empty register names.
20331
20332 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20333
20334 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20335 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20336 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20337
20338 @subsubheading Example
20339
20340 For the PPC MBX board:
20341 @smallexample
20342 (gdb)
20343 -data-list-register-names
20344 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20345 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20346 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20347 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20348 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20349 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20350 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20351 (gdb)
20352 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20353 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20354 (gdb)
20355 @end smallexample
20356
20357 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20358 @findex -data-list-register-values
20359
20360 @subsubheading Synopsis
20361
20362 @smallexample
20363 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20364 @end smallexample
20365
20366 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20367 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20368 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20369 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20370
20371 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20372
20373 @table @code
20374 @item x
20375 Hexadecimal
20376 @item o
20377 Octal
20378 @item t
20379 Binary
20380 @item d
20381 Decimal
20382 @item r
20383 Raw
20384 @item N
20385 Natural
20386 @end table
20387
20388 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20389
20390 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20391 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20392
20393 @subsubheading Example
20394
20395 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20396 don't appear in the actual output):
20397
20398 @smallexample
20399 (gdb)
20400 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20401 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20402 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20403 (gdb)
20404 -data-list-register-values x
20405 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20406 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20407 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20408 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20409 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20410 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20411 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20412 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20413 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20414 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20415 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20416 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20417 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20418 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20419 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20420 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20421 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20422 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20423 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20424 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20425 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20426 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20427 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20428 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20429 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20430 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20431 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20432 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20433 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20434 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20435 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20436 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20437 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20438 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20439 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20440 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20441 (gdb)
20442 @end smallexample
20443
20444
20445 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20446 @findex -data-read-memory
20447
20448 @subsubheading Synopsis
20449
20450 @smallexample
20451 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20452 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20453 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20454 @end smallexample
20455
20456 @noindent
20457 where:
20458
20459 @table @samp
20460 @item @var{address}
20461 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20462 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20463 quoted using the C convention.
20464
20465 @item @var{word-format}
20466 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20467 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20468 ,Output Formats}).
20469
20470 @item @var{word-size}
20471 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20472
20473 @item @var{nr-rows}
20474 The number of rows in the output table.
20475
20476 @item @var{nr-cols}
20477 The number of columns in the output table.
20478
20479 @item @var{aschar}
20480 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20481 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20482 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20483 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20484
20485 @item @var{byte-offset}
20486 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20487 @end table
20488
20489 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20490 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20491 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20492 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20493 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20494 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20495 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20496 @samp{addr}.
20497
20498 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20499 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20500 @samp{prev-page}.
20501
20502 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20503
20504 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20505 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20506
20507 @subsubheading Example
20508
20509 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20510 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20511 word. Display each word in hex.
20512
20513 @smallexample
20514 (gdb)
20515 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20516 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20517 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20518 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20519 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20520 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20521 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20522 (gdb)
20523 @end smallexample
20524
20525 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20526 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20527
20528 @smallexample
20529 (gdb)
20530 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20531 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20532 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20533 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20534 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20535 (gdb)
20536 @end smallexample
20537
20538 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20539 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20540 used as the non-printable character.
20541
20542 @smallexample
20543 (gdb)
20544 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20545 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20546 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20547 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20548 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20549 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20550 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20551 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20552 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20553 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20554 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20555 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20556 (gdb)
20557 @end smallexample
20558
20559 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20560 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20561 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20562
20563 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20564
20565 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20566
20567 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20568
20569 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20570
20571 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20572
20573 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20574
20575 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20576
20577 @c @subheading -trace-find
20578
20579 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20580
20581 @c @subheading -trace-info
20582
20583 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20584
20585 @c @subheading -trace-list
20586
20587 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20588
20589 @c @subheading -trace-save
20590
20591 @c @subheading -trace-start
20592
20593 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20594
20595
20596 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20597 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20598 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20599
20600
20601 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20602 @findex -symbol-info-address
20603
20604 @subsubheading Synopsis
20605
20606 @smallexample
20607 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20608 @end smallexample
20609
20610 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20611
20612 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20613
20614 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20615
20616 @subsubheading Example
20617 N.A.
20618
20619
20620 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20621 @findex -symbol-info-file
20622
20623 @subsubheading Synopsis
20624
20625 @smallexample
20626 -symbol-info-file
20627 @end smallexample
20628
20629 Show the file for the symbol.
20630
20631 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20632
20633 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20634 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20635
20636 @subsubheading Example
20637 N.A.
20638
20639
20640 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20641 @findex -symbol-info-function
20642
20643 @subsubheading Synopsis
20644
20645 @smallexample
20646 -symbol-info-function
20647 @end smallexample
20648
20649 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20650
20651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20652
20653 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20654
20655 @subsubheading Example
20656 N.A.
20657
20658
20659 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20660 @findex -symbol-info-line
20661
20662 @subsubheading Synopsis
20663
20664 @smallexample
20665 -symbol-info-line
20666 @end smallexample
20667
20668 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20669
20670 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20671
20672 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20673 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20674
20675 @subsubheading Example
20676 N.A.
20677
20678
20679 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20680 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20681
20682 @subsubheading Synopsis
20683
20684 @smallexample
20685 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20686 @end smallexample
20687
20688 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20689
20690 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20691
20692 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20693
20694 @subsubheading Example
20695 N.A.
20696
20697
20698 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20699 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20700
20701 @subsubheading Synopsis
20702
20703 @smallexample
20704 -symbol-list-functions
20705 @end smallexample
20706
20707 List the functions in the executable.
20708
20709 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20710
20711 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20712 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20713
20714 @subsubheading Example
20715 N.A.
20716
20717
20718 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20719 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20720
20721 @subsubheading Synopsis
20722
20723 @smallexample
20724 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20725 @end smallexample
20726
20727 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20728 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20729 ascending PC order.
20730
20731 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20732
20733 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20734
20735 @subsubheading Example
20736 @smallexample
20737 (gdb)
20738 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20739 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20740 (gdb)
20741 @end smallexample
20742
20743
20744 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20745 @findex -symbol-list-types
20746
20747 @subsubheading Synopsis
20748
20749 @smallexample
20750 -symbol-list-types
20751 @end smallexample
20752
20753 List all the type names.
20754
20755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20756
20757 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20758 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20759
20760 @subsubheading Example
20761 N.A.
20762
20763
20764 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20765 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20766
20767 @subsubheading Synopsis
20768
20769 @smallexample
20770 -symbol-list-variables
20771 @end smallexample
20772
20773 List all the global and static variable names.
20774
20775 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20776
20777 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20778
20779 @subsubheading Example
20780 N.A.
20781
20782
20783 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20784 @findex -symbol-locate
20785
20786 @subsubheading Synopsis
20787
20788 @smallexample
20789 -symbol-locate
20790 @end smallexample
20791
20792 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20793
20794 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20795
20796 @subsubheading Example
20797 N.A.
20798
20799
20800 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20801 @findex -symbol-type
20802
20803 @subsubheading Synopsis
20804
20805 @smallexample
20806 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20807 @end smallexample
20808
20809 Show type of @var{variable}.
20810
20811 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20812
20813 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20814 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20815
20816 @subsubheading Example
20817 N.A.
20818
20819
20820 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20821 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20822 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20823
20824 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20825 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20826
20827 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20828 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20829
20830 @subsubheading Synopsis
20831
20832 @smallexample
20833 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20834 @end smallexample
20835
20836 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20837 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20838 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20839 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20840 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20841 notification.
20842
20843 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20844
20845 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20846
20847 @subsubheading Example
20848
20849 @smallexample
20850 (gdb)
20851 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20852 ^done
20853 (gdb)
20854 @end smallexample
20855
20856
20857 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20858 @findex -file-exec-file
20859
20860 @subsubheading Synopsis
20861
20862 @smallexample
20863 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20864 @end smallexample
20865
20866 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20867 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20868 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20869 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20870 notification.
20871
20872 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20873
20874 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20875
20876 @subsubheading Example
20877
20878 @smallexample
20879 (gdb)
20880 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20881 ^done
20882 (gdb)
20883 @end smallexample
20884
20885
20886 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20887 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20888
20889 @subsubheading Synopsis
20890
20891 @smallexample
20892 -file-list-exec-sections
20893 @end smallexample
20894
20895 List the sections of the current executable file.
20896
20897 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20898
20899 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20900 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20901 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20902
20903 @subsubheading Example
20904 N.A.
20905
20906
20907 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20908 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20909
20910 @subsubheading Synopsis
20911
20912 @smallexample
20913 -file-list-exec-source-file
20914 @end smallexample
20915
20916 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20917 to the current source file for the current executable.
20918
20919 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20920
20921 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20922
20923 @subsubheading Example
20924
20925 @smallexample
20926 (gdb)
20927 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20928 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20929 (gdb)
20930 @end smallexample
20931
20932
20933 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20934 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20935
20936 @subsubheading Synopsis
20937
20938 @smallexample
20939 -file-list-exec-source-files
20940 @end smallexample
20941
20942 List the source files for the current executable.
20943
20944 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
20945 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20946
20947 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20948
20949 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20950 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20951
20952 @subsubheading Example
20953 @smallexample
20954 (gdb)
20955 -file-list-exec-source-files
20956 ^done,files=[
20957 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20958 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20959 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20960 (gdb)
20961 @end smallexample
20962
20963 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20964 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20965
20966 @subsubheading Synopsis
20967
20968 @smallexample
20969 -file-list-shared-libraries
20970 @end smallexample
20971
20972 List the shared libraries in the program.
20973
20974 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20975
20976 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20977
20978 @subsubheading Example
20979 N.A.
20980
20981
20982 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20983 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20984
20985 @subsubheading Synopsis
20986
20987 @smallexample
20988 -file-list-symbol-files
20989 @end smallexample
20990
20991 List symbol files.
20992
20993 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20994
20995 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20996
20997 @subsubheading Example
20998 N.A.
20999
21000
21001 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
21002 @findex -file-symbol-file
21003
21004 @subsubheading Synopsis
21005
21006 @smallexample
21007 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
21008 @end smallexample
21009
21010 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
21011 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
21012 produced, except for a completion notification.
21013
21014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21015
21016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
21017
21018 @subsubheading Example
21019
21020 @smallexample
21021 (gdb)
21022 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21023 ^done
21024 (gdb)
21025 @end smallexample
21026
21027 @ignore
21028 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21029 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
21030 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
21031
21032 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
21033
21034 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
21035
21036 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
21037
21038 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
21039
21040 @c @subheading -overlay-map
21041
21042 @c @subheading -overlay-off
21043
21044 @c @subheading -overlay-on
21045
21046 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
21047
21048 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21049 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
21050 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
21051
21052 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
21053
21054 @c @subheading -signal-handle
21055
21056 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
21057
21058 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
21059 @end ignore
21060
21061
21062 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21063 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
21064 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
21065
21066
21067 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
21068 @findex -target-attach
21069
21070 @subsubheading Synopsis
21071
21072 @smallexample
21073 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
21074 @end smallexample
21075
21076 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
21077
21078 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21079
21080 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
21081
21082 @subsubheading Example
21083 N.A.
21084
21085
21086 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
21087 @findex -target-compare-sections
21088
21089 @subsubheading Synopsis
21090
21091 @smallexample
21092 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
21093 @end smallexample
21094
21095 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
21096 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
21097
21098 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21099
21100 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
21101
21102 @subsubheading Example
21103 N.A.
21104
21105
21106 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21107 @findex -target-detach
21108
21109 @subsubheading Synopsis
21110
21111 @smallexample
21112 -target-detach
21113 @end smallexample
21114
21115 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21116 There's no output.
21117
21118 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21119
21120 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21121
21122 @subsubheading Example
21123
21124 @smallexample
21125 (gdb)
21126 -target-detach
21127 ^done
21128 (gdb)
21129 @end smallexample
21130
21131
21132 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21133 @findex -target-disconnect
21134
21135 @subsubheading Synopsis
21136
21137 @smallexample
21138 -target-disconnect
21139 @end smallexample
21140
21141 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21142 generally not resumed.
21143
21144 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21145
21146 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21147
21148 @subsubheading Example
21149
21150 @smallexample
21151 (gdb)
21152 -target-disconnect
21153 ^done
21154 (gdb)
21155 @end smallexample
21156
21157
21158 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21159 @findex -target-download
21160
21161 @subsubheading Synopsis
21162
21163 @smallexample
21164 -target-download
21165 @end smallexample
21166
21167 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21168 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21169
21170 @table @samp
21171 @item section
21172 The name of the section.
21173 @item section-sent
21174 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21175 @item section-size
21176 The size of the section.
21177 @item total-sent
21178 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21179 @item total-size
21180 The size of the overall executable to download.
21181 @end table
21182
21183 @noindent
21184 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21185 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21186
21187 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21188 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21189
21190 @table @samp
21191 @item section
21192 The name of the section.
21193 @item section-size
21194 The size of the section.
21195 @item total-size
21196 The size of the overall executable to download.
21197 @end table
21198
21199 @noindent
21200 At the end, a summary is printed.
21201
21202 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21203
21204 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21205
21206 @subsubheading Example
21207
21208 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21209 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21210
21211 @smallexample
21212 (gdb)
21213 -target-download
21214 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21215 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21216 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21217 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21218 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21219 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21220 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21221 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21222 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21223 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21224 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21225 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21226 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21227 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21228 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21229 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21230 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21231 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21232 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21233 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21234 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21235 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21236 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21237 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21238 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21239 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21240 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21241 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21242 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21243 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21244 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21245 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21246 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21247 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21248 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21249 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21250 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21251 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21252 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21253 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21254 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21255 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21256 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21257 write-rate="429"
21258 (gdb)
21259 @end smallexample
21260
21261
21262 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21263 @findex -target-exec-status
21264
21265 @subsubheading Synopsis
21266
21267 @smallexample
21268 -target-exec-status
21269 @end smallexample
21270
21271 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21272 not, for instance).
21273
21274 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21275
21276 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21277
21278 @subsubheading Example
21279 N.A.
21280
21281
21282 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21283 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21284
21285 @subsubheading Synopsis
21286
21287 @smallexample
21288 -target-list-available-targets
21289 @end smallexample
21290
21291 List the possible targets to connect to.
21292
21293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21294
21295 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21296
21297 @subsubheading Example
21298 N.A.
21299
21300
21301 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21302 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21303
21304 @subsubheading Synopsis
21305
21306 @smallexample
21307 -target-list-current-targets
21308 @end smallexample
21309
21310 Describe the current target.
21311
21312 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21313
21314 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21315 other things).
21316
21317 @subsubheading Example
21318 N.A.
21319
21320
21321 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21322 @findex -target-list-parameters
21323
21324 @subsubheading Synopsis
21325
21326 @smallexample
21327 -target-list-parameters
21328 @end smallexample
21329
21330 @c ????
21331
21332 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21333
21334 No equivalent.
21335
21336 @subsubheading Example
21337 N.A.
21338
21339
21340 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21341 @findex -target-select
21342
21343 @subsubheading Synopsis
21344
21345 @smallexample
21346 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21347 @end smallexample
21348
21349 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21350
21351 @table @samp
21352 @item @var{type}
21353 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21354 @item @var{parameters}
21355 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21356 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
21357 @end table
21358
21359 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21360 which the target program is, in the following form:
21361
21362 @smallexample
21363 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21364 args=[@var{arg list}]
21365 @end smallexample
21366
21367 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21368
21369 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21370
21371 @subsubheading Example
21372
21373 @smallexample
21374 (gdb)
21375 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21376 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21377 (gdb)
21378 @end smallexample
21379
21380 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21381 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
21382 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
21383
21384
21385 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21386 @findex -target-file-put
21387
21388 @subsubheading Synopsis
21389
21390 @smallexample
21391 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21392 @end smallexample
21393
21394 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21395 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21396
21397 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21398
21399 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
21400
21401 @subsubheading Example
21402
21403 @smallexample
21404 (gdb)
21405 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
21406 ^done
21407 (gdb)
21408 @end smallexample
21409
21410
21411 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21412 @findex -target-file-get
21413
21414 @subsubheading Synopsis
21415
21416 @smallexample
21417 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21418 @end smallexample
21419
21420 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21421 on the host system.
21422
21423 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21424
21425 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
21426
21427 @subsubheading Example
21428
21429 @smallexample
21430 (gdb)
21431 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
21432 ^done
21433 (gdb)
21434 @end smallexample
21435
21436
21437 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
21438 @findex -target-file-delete
21439
21440 @subsubheading Synopsis
21441
21442 @smallexample
21443 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
21444 @end smallexample
21445
21446 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21447
21448 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21449
21450 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
21451
21452 @subsubheading Example
21453
21454 @smallexample
21455 (gdb)
21456 -target-file-delete remotefile
21457 ^done
21458 (gdb)
21459 @end smallexample
21460
21461
21462 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21463 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21464 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21465
21466 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21467
21468 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21469 @findex -gdb-exit
21470
21471 @subsubheading Synopsis
21472
21473 @smallexample
21474 -gdb-exit
21475 @end smallexample
21476
21477 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21478
21479 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21480
21481 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21482
21483 @subsubheading Example
21484
21485 @smallexample
21486 (gdb)
21487 -gdb-exit
21488 ^exit
21489 @end smallexample
21490
21491
21492 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21493 @findex -exec-abort
21494
21495 @subsubheading Synopsis
21496
21497 @smallexample
21498 -exec-abort
21499 @end smallexample
21500
21501 Kill the inferior running program.
21502
21503 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21504
21505 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21506
21507 @subsubheading Example
21508 N.A.
21509
21510
21511 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21512 @findex -gdb-set
21513
21514 @subsubheading Synopsis
21515
21516 @smallexample
21517 -gdb-set
21518 @end smallexample
21519
21520 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21521 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21522
21523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21524
21525 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21526
21527 @subsubheading Example
21528
21529 @smallexample
21530 (gdb)
21531 -gdb-set $foo=3
21532 ^done
21533 (gdb)
21534 @end smallexample
21535
21536
21537 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21538 @findex -gdb-show
21539
21540 @subsubheading Synopsis
21541
21542 @smallexample
21543 -gdb-show
21544 @end smallexample
21545
21546 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21547
21548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21549
21550 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21551
21552 @subsubheading Example
21553
21554 @smallexample
21555 (gdb)
21556 -gdb-show annotate
21557 ^done,value="0"
21558 (gdb)
21559 @end smallexample
21560
21561 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21562
21563
21564 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21565 @findex -gdb-version
21566
21567 @subsubheading Synopsis
21568
21569 @smallexample
21570 -gdb-version
21571 @end smallexample
21572
21573 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21574
21575 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21576
21577 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21578 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21579
21580 @subsubheading Example
21581
21582 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21583 @c box in TeX.
21584 @smallexample
21585 (gdb)
21586 -gdb-version
21587 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21588 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21589 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21590 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21591 ~ certain conditions.
21592 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21593 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21594 ~ details.
21595 ~This GDB was configured as
21596 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21597 ^done
21598 (gdb)
21599 @end smallexample
21600
21601 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
21602 @findex -list-features
21603
21604 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
21605 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
21606 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
21607 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
21608 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
21609 startup.
21610
21611 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
21612 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
21613 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
21614 is given below.
21615
21616 Example output:
21617
21618 @smallexample
21619 (gdb) -list-features
21620 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
21621 @end smallexample
21622
21623 The current list of features is:
21624
21625 @itemize @minus
21626 @item
21627 @samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
21628 @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
21629 @code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
21630 @item
21631 @samp{pending-breakpoints}---indicates presence of the @code{-f}
21632 option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
21633
21634 @end itemize
21635
21636 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21637 @findex -interpreter-exec
21638
21639 @subheading Synopsis
21640
21641 @smallexample
21642 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21643 @end smallexample
21644 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21645
21646 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21647
21648 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21649
21650 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21651
21652 @subheading Example
21653
21654 @smallexample
21655 (gdb)
21656 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21657 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21658 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21659 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21660 ^done
21661 (gdb)
21662 @end smallexample
21663
21664 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21665 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21666
21667 @subheading Synopsis
21668
21669 @smallexample
21670 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21671 @end smallexample
21672
21673 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21674
21675 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21676
21677 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21678
21679 @subheading Example
21680
21681 @smallexample
21682 (gdb)
21683 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21684 ^done
21685 (gdb)
21686 @end smallexample
21687
21688 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21689 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21690
21691 @subheading Synopsis
21692
21693 @smallexample
21694 -inferior-tty-show
21695 @end smallexample
21696
21697 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21698
21699 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21700
21701 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21702
21703 @subheading Example
21704
21705 @smallexample
21706 (gdb)
21707 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21708 ^done
21709 (gdb)
21710 -inferior-tty-show
21711 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21712 (gdb)
21713 @end smallexample
21714
21715 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21716 @findex -enable-timings
21717
21718 @subheading Synopsis
21719
21720 @smallexample
21721 -enable-timings [yes | no]
21722 @end smallexample
21723
21724 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
21725 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
21726 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
21727 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
21728
21729 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21730
21731 No equivalent.
21732
21733 @subheading Example
21734
21735 @smallexample
21736 (gdb)
21737 -enable-timings
21738 ^done
21739 (gdb)
21740 -break-insert main
21741 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21742 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21743 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
21744 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
21745 (gdb)
21746 -enable-timings no
21747 ^done
21748 (gdb)
21749 -exec-run
21750 ^running
21751 (gdb)
21752 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21753 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
21754 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
21755 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
21756 (gdb)
21757 @end smallexample
21758
21759 @node Annotations
21760 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21761
21762 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21763 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21764 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21765 relatively high level.
21766
21767 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21768 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21769
21770 @ignore
21771 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21772 @end ignore
21773
21774 @menu
21775 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21776 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
21777 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21778 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21779 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21780 * Annotations for Running::
21781 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21782 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21783 @end menu
21784
21785 @node Annotations Overview
21786 @section What is an Annotation?
21787 @cindex annotations
21788
21789 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21790 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21791 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21792 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21793 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21794 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21795 cannot contain newline characters.
21796
21797 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21798 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21799 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21800 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21801 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21802 means those three characters as output.
21803
21804 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21805 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21806 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21807 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21808 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21809 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21810 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21811 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21812 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21813
21814 @table @code
21815 @kindex set annotate
21816 @item set annotate @var{level}
21817 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21818 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21819
21820 @item show annotate
21821 @kindex show annotate
21822 Show the current annotation level.
21823 @end table
21824
21825 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21826
21827 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21828
21829 @smallexample
21830 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21831 GNU gdb 6.0
21832 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21833 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21834 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21835 under certain conditions.
21836 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21837 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21838 for details.
21839 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21840
21841 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21842 (@value{GDBP})
21843 ^Z^Zprompt
21844 @kbd{quit}
21845
21846 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21847 $
21848 @end smallexample
21849
21850 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21851 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21852 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21853 output from @value{GDBN}.
21854
21855 @node Server Prefix
21856 @section The Server Prefix
21857 @cindex server prefix
21858
21859 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
21860 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
21861 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
21862 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
21863 a transparent manner.
21864
21865 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21866 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21867 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21868
21869 @node Prompting
21870 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21871
21872 @cindex annotations for prompts
21873 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21874 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21875 over, etc.
21876
21877 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21878 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21879 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21880 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21881 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21882 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21883 features the following annotations:
21884
21885 @smallexample
21886 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21887 ^Z^Zprompt
21888 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21889 @end smallexample
21890
21891 The input types are
21892
21893 @table @code
21894 @findex pre-prompt annotation
21895 @findex prompt annotation
21896 @findex post-prompt annotation
21897 @item prompt
21898 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21899
21900 @findex pre-commands annotation
21901 @findex commands annotation
21902 @findex post-commands annotation
21903 @item commands
21904 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21905 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21906
21907 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21908 @findex overload-choice annotation
21909 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
21910 @item overload-choice
21911 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21912
21913 @findex pre-query annotation
21914 @findex query annotation
21915 @findex post-query annotation
21916 @item query
21917 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21918
21919 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21920 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21921 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21922 @item prompt-for-continue
21923 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21924 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21925 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21926 presence of annotations.
21927 @end table
21928
21929 @node Errors
21930 @section Errors
21931 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21932
21933 @findex quit annotation
21934 @smallexample
21935 ^Z^Zquit
21936 @end smallexample
21937
21938 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21939
21940 @findex error annotation
21941 @smallexample
21942 ^Z^Zerror
21943 @end smallexample
21944
21945 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21946
21947 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21948 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21949 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21950 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21951 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21952 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21953 to the top level.
21954
21955 @findex error-begin annotation
21956 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21957
21958 @smallexample
21959 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21960 @end smallexample
21961
21962 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21963 message.
21964
21965 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21966 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21967 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21968
21969 @node Invalidation
21970 @section Invalidation Notices
21971
21972 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21973 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21974 changed.
21975
21976 @table @code
21977 @findex frames-invalid annotation
21978 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21979
21980 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21981 have changed.
21982
21983 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
21984 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21985
21986 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21987 deleted a breakpoint.
21988 @end table
21989
21990 @node Annotations for Running
21991 @section Running the Program
21992 @cindex annotations for running programs
21993
21994 @findex starting annotation
21995 @findex stopping annotation
21996 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21997 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21998
21999 @smallexample
22000 ^Z^Zstarting
22001 @end smallexample
22002
22003 is output. When the program stops,
22004
22005 @smallexample
22006 ^Z^Zstopped
22007 @end smallexample
22008
22009 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
22010 annotations describe how the program stopped.
22011
22012 @table @code
22013 @findex exited annotation
22014 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
22015 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
22016 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
22017
22018 @findex signalled annotation
22019 @findex signal-name annotation
22020 @findex signal-name-end annotation
22021 @findex signal-string annotation
22022 @findex signal-string-end annotation
22023 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
22024 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
22025 annotation continues:
22026
22027 @smallexample
22028 @var{intro-text}
22029 ^Z^Zsignal-name
22030 @var{name}
22031 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
22032 @var{middle-text}
22033 ^Z^Zsignal-string
22034 @var{string}
22035 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
22036 @var{end-text}
22037 @end smallexample
22038
22039 @noindent
22040 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
22041 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
22042 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
22043 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
22044 user's benefit and have no particular format.
22045
22046 @findex signal annotation
22047 @item ^Z^Zsignal
22048 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
22049 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
22050 terminated with it.
22051
22052 @findex breakpoint annotation
22053 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
22054 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
22055
22056 @findex watchpoint annotation
22057 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
22058 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
22059 @end table
22060
22061 @node Source Annotations
22062 @section Displaying Source
22063 @cindex annotations for source display
22064
22065 @findex source annotation
22066 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
22067
22068 @smallexample
22069 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
22070 @end smallexample
22071
22072 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
22073 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
22074 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
22075 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
22076 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
22077 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
22078 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
22079 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
22080 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
22081 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
22082 depend on the language).
22083
22084 @node GDB Bugs
22085 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
22086 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
22087 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
22088
22089 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
22090
22091 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
22092 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
22093 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
22094 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
22095
22096 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
22097 information that enables us to fix the bug.
22098
22099 @menu
22100 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
22101 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
22102 @end menu
22103
22104 @node Bug Criteria
22105 @section Have You Found a Bug?
22106 @cindex bug criteria
22107
22108 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
22109
22110 @itemize @bullet
22111 @cindex fatal signal
22112 @cindex debugger crash
22113 @cindex crash of debugger
22114 @item
22115 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
22116 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
22117
22118 @cindex error on valid input
22119 @item
22120 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
22121 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
22122 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
22123
22124 @cindex invalid input
22125 @item
22126 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
22127 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
22128 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
22129 for traditional practice''.
22130
22131 @item
22132 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
22133 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
22134 @end itemize
22135
22136 @node Bug Reporting
22137 @section How to Report Bugs
22138 @cindex bug reports
22139 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
22140
22141 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
22142 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
22143 contact that organization first.
22144
22145 You can find contact information for many support companies and
22146 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
22147 distribution.
22148 @c should add a web page ref...
22149
22150 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
22151 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
22152 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
22153 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
22154 be used.
22155
22156 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
22157 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
22158 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
22159 @samp{bug-gdb}.
22160
22161 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
22162 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
22163 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
22164 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
22165 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
22166 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
22167 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
22168 bug reports to the mailing list.
22169
22170 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
22171 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
22172 fact or leave it out, state it!
22173
22174 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
22175 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
22176 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
22177 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
22178 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
22179 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
22180 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
22181 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
22182 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
22183
22184 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
22185 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
22186 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
22187 self-contained.
22188
22189 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
22190 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
22191 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
22192 bugs properly.
22193
22194 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
22195
22196 @itemize @bullet
22197 @item
22198 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
22199 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
22200 version}.
22201
22202 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
22203 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
22204
22205 @item
22206 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
22207 version number.
22208
22209 @item
22210 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
22211 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
22212
22213 @item
22214 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
22215 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
22216 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
22217 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
22218 those compilers.
22219
22220 @item
22221 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
22222 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
22223 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
22224 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
22225
22226 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
22227 and then we might not encounter the bug.
22228
22229 @item
22230 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
22231 reproduce the bug.
22232
22233 @item
22234 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
22235 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
22236
22237 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
22238 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
22239 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
22240 a chance to make a mistake.
22241
22242 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
22243 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
22244 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
22245 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
22246 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
22247 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
22248 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
22249 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
22250
22251 @pindex script
22252 @cindex recording a session script
22253 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
22254 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
22255 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
22256 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
22257
22258 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
22259 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
22260
22261 @item
22262 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
22263 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
22264 it by context, not by line number.
22265
22266 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
22267 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
22268
22269 @end itemize
22270
22271 Here are some things that are not necessary:
22272
22273 @itemize @bullet
22274 @item
22275 A description of the envelope of the bug.
22276
22277 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22278 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22279 changes will not affect it.
22280
22281 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22282 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22283 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22284 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22285
22286 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22287 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22288 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22289 less time, and so on.
22290
22291 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22292 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22293
22294 @item
22295 A patch for the bug.
22296
22297 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22298 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22299 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22300 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22301
22302 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22303 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22304 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22305 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22306
22307 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22308 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22309 help us to understand.
22310
22311 @item
22312 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22313
22314 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22315 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22316 @end itemize
22317
22318 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22319 @c and consists of the two following files:
22320 @c rluser.texinfo
22321 @c inc-hist.texinfo
22322 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22323 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22324 @include rluser.texi
22325 @include inc-hist.texinfo
22326
22327
22328 @node Formatting Documentation
22329 @appendix Formatting Documentation
22330
22331 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22332 @cindex reference card
22333 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22334 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22335 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22336 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22337 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22338 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22339
22340 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22341 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22342
22343 @smallexample
22344 make refcard.dvi
22345 @end smallexample
22346
22347 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22348 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22349 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22350 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22351 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22352
22353 @cindex documentation
22354
22355 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22356 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22357 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22358 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22359 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22360 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22361
22362 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22363 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22364 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22365 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22366 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22367 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22368 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22369 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22370
22371 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22372 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22373 @code{makeinfo}.
22374
22375 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22376 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22377 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22378
22379 @smallexample
22380 cd gdb
22381 make gdb.info
22382 @end smallexample
22383
22384 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22385 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22386 Texinfo definitions file.
22387
22388 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22389 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22390 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22391 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22392 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22393 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22394 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22395
22396 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22397 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22398 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22399 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22400 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22401 directory.
22402
22403 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22404 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
22405 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22406 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22407
22408 @smallexample
22409 make gdb.dvi
22410 @end smallexample
22411
22412 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22413
22414 @node Installing GDB
22415 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22416 @cindex installation
22417
22418 @menu
22419 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22420 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
22421 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22422 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22423 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22424 @end menu
22425
22426 @node Requirements
22427 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
22428 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22429
22430 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22431 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22432
22433 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
22434 @table @asis
22435 @item ISO C90 compiler
22436 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22437 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22438
22439 @end table
22440
22441 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
22442 @table @asis
22443 @item Expat
22444 @anchor{Expat}
22445 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22446 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22447 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22448 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
22449 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22450 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22451
22452 Expat is used for:
22453
22454 @itemize @bullet
22455 @item
22456 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
22457 @item
22458 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
22459 @item
22460 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
22461 @item
22462 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
22463 @end itemize
22464
22465 @end table
22466
22467 @node Running Configure
22468 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
22469 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22470 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
22471 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22472 build the @code{gdb} program.
22473 @iftex
22474 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22475 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22476 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22477 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22478 @end iftex
22479
22480 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22481 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22482 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22483
22484 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22485 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22486
22487 @table @code
22488 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22489 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22490
22491 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22492 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22493
22494 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22495 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22496
22497 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22498 @sc{gnu} include files
22499
22500 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22501 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22502
22503 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22504 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22505
22506 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22507 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22508
22509 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22510 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22511
22512 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22513 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22514 @end table
22515
22516 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
22517 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22518 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22519
22520 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22521 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
22522 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22523 argument.
22524
22525 For example:
22526
22527 @smallexample
22528 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22529 ./configure @var{host}
22530 make
22531 @end smallexample
22532
22533 @noindent
22534 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22535 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22536 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
22537 correct value by examining your system.)
22538
22539 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22540 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22541 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22542 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22543
22544 @need 750
22545 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22546 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22547 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22548
22549 @smallexample
22550 sh configure @var{host}
22551 @end smallexample
22552
22553 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
22554 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22555 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
22556 @file{configure}
22557 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22558 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22559
22560 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
22561 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22562 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22563 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22564 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22565 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22566 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22567 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22568 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22569
22570 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22571 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22572 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22573 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22574 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22575
22576 @node Separate Objdir
22577 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
22578
22579 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22580 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22581 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22582 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22583 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22584 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22585 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22586 program specified there.
22587
22588 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
22589 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22590 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
22591 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
22592 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22593 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22594
22595 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22596 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22597
22598 @smallexample
22599 @group
22600 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22601 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22602 cd ../gdb-sun4
22603 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22604 make
22605 @end group
22606 @end smallexample
22607
22608 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22609 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22610 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22611 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22612 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22613 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22614
22615 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22616 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22617 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22618 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22619 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22620
22621 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22622 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22623 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22624 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22625 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22626 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
22627
22628 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22629 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22630 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22631
22632 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
22633 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22634 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22635 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22636 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22637
22638 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22639 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22640 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22641 with each other.
22642
22643 @node Config Names
22644 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
22645
22646 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
22647 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22648 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22649 of information in the following pattern:
22650
22651 @smallexample
22652 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22653 @end smallexample
22654
22655 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22656 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22657 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22658
22659 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22660 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22661 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22662 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22663 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22664 abbreviations---for example:
22665
22666 @smallexample
22667 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22668 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22669 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22670 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22671 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22672 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22673 % sh config.sub sun4
22674 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22675 % sh config.sub sun3
22676 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22677 % sh config.sub i986v
22678 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22679 @end smallexample
22680
22681 @noindent
22682 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22683 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22684
22685 @node Configure Options
22686 @section @file{configure} Options
22687
22688 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
22689 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
22690 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22691 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
22692
22693 @smallexample
22694 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22695 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22696 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22697 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22698 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22699 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22700 @var{host}
22701 @end smallexample
22702
22703 @noindent
22704 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22705 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22706 @samp{--}.
22707
22708 @table @code
22709 @item --help
22710 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
22711
22712 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22713 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22714 @file{@var{dir}}.
22715
22716 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22717 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22718 @file{@var{dir}}.
22719
22720 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22721 @need 2000
22722 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22723 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22724 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22725 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22726 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22727 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22728 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
22729 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22730 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
22731 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22732 @var{dirname}.
22733
22734 @item --norecursion
22735 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
22736 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22737
22738 @item --target=@var{target}
22739 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22740 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22741 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22742
22743 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22744
22745 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22746 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22747
22748 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22749 @end table
22750
22751 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22752 needed for special purposes only.
22753
22754 @node Maintenance Commands
22755 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22756 @cindex maintenance commands
22757 @cindex internal commands
22758
22759 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22760 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22761 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22762 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22763 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22764
22765 @table @code
22766 @kindex maint agent
22767 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22768 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22769 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22770 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22771
22772 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22773 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22774 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22775 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22776 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22777 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22778 is shown:
22779
22780 @table @code
22781 @item breakpoint
22782 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22783
22784 @item watchpoint
22785 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22786
22787 @item longjmp
22788 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22789 @code{longjmp} calls.
22790
22791 @item longjmp resume
22792 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22793
22794 @item until
22795 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22796
22797 @item finish
22798 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22799
22800 @item shlib events
22801 Shared library events.
22802
22803 @end table
22804
22805 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22806 @item maint check-symtabs
22807 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22808
22809 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22810 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22811 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22812
22813 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22814 @item maint cplus namespace
22815 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22816
22817 @kindex maint demangle
22818 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22819 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
22820
22821 @kindex maint deprecate
22822 @kindex maint undeprecate
22823 @cindex deprecated commands
22824 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22825 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22826 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22827 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22828 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22829 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22830 the replacement as part of the warning.
22831
22832 @kindex maint dump-me
22833 @item maint dump-me
22834 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22835 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22836 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22837 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22838
22839 @kindex maint internal-error
22840 @kindex maint internal-warning
22841 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22842 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22843 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22844 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22845 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22846 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22847 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22848 @value{GDBN} session.
22849
22850 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22851 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22852
22853 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
22854
22855 @smallexample
22856 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22857 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22858 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22859 debugging may prove unreliable.
22860 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22861 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22862 (@value{GDBP})
22863 @end smallexample
22864
22865 @kindex maint packet
22866 @item maint packet @var{text}
22867 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22868 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22869 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22870 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22871 checksum.
22872
22873 @kindex maint print architecture
22874 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22875 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22876 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22877
22878 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
22879 @item maint print c-tdesc
22880 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
22881 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
22882 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
22883
22884 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22885 @item maint print dummy-frames
22886 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22887
22888 @smallexample
22889 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22890 @dots{}
22891 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22892 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22893 58 return (a + b);
22894 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22895 @dots{}
22896 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22897 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22898 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22899 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22900 (@value{GDBP})
22901 @end smallexample
22902
22903 Takes an optional file parameter.
22904
22905 @kindex maint print registers
22906 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22907 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22908 @kindex maint print register-groups
22909 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22910 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22911 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22912 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22913 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22914
22915 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22916 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22917 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22918 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22919 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22920 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22921
22922 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22923 write the information.
22924
22925 @kindex maint print reggroups
22926 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22927 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22928 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22929 information.
22930
22931 The register groups info looks like this:
22932
22933 @smallexample
22934 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22935 Group Type
22936 general user
22937 float user
22938 all user
22939 vector user
22940 system user
22941 save internal
22942 restore internal
22943 @end smallexample
22944
22945 @kindex flushregs
22946 @item flushregs
22947 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22948
22949 @kindex maint print objfiles
22950 @cindex info for known object files
22951 @item maint print objfiles
22952 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22953 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22954 and symtabs.
22955
22956 @kindex maint print statistics
22957 @cindex bcache statistics
22958 @item maint print statistics
22959 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22960 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22961 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22962 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22963 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22964 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22965 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22966 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22967 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22968 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22969 lengths.
22970
22971 @kindex maint print target-stack
22972 @cindex target stack description
22973 @item maint print target-stack
22974 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
22975 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
22976 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
22977 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
22978 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
22979 address.
22980
22981 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
22982 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
22983
22984 @kindex maint print type
22985 @cindex type chain of a data type
22986 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22987 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22988 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22989 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22990 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22991 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22992
22993 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22994 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22995 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22996 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22997 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22998
22999 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
23000 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
23001 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
23002 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
23003 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
23004 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
23005 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
23006 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
23007 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
23008
23009 @kindex maint set profile
23010 @kindex maint show profile
23011 @cindex profiling GDB
23012 @item maint set profile
23013 @itemx maint show profile
23014 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
23015
23016 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
23017 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
23018 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
23019 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
23020 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
23021 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
23022 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
23023
23024 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
23025 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
23026
23027 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
23028 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
23029 @item maint show-debug-regs
23030 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
23031 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
23032 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
23033 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
23034 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
23035
23036 @kindex maint space
23037 @cindex memory used by commands
23038 @item maint space
23039 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
23040 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
23041 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
23042 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
23043 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23044
23045 @kindex maint time
23046 @cindex time of command execution
23047 @item maint time
23048 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
23049 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
23050 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
23051 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
23052 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23053
23054 @kindex maint translate-address
23055 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
23056 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
23057 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
23058 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
23059 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
23060 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
23061 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
23062
23063 @end table
23064
23065 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
23066 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
23067
23068 @table @code
23069 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
23070 @kindex set watchdog
23071 @cindex watchdog timer
23072 @cindex timeout for commands
23073 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
23074 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
23075 reports and error and the command is aborted.
23076
23077 @item show watchdog
23078 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
23079 @end table
23080
23081 @node Remote Protocol
23082 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
23083
23084 @menu
23085 * Overview::
23086 * Packets::
23087 * Stop Reply Packets::
23088 * General Query Packets::
23089 * Register Packet Format::
23090 * Tracepoint Packets::
23091 * Host I/O Packets::
23092 * Interrupts::
23093 * Examples::
23094 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
23095 * Library List Format::
23096 * Memory Map Format::
23097 @end menu
23098
23099 @node Overview
23100 @section Overview
23101
23102 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
23103 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
23104 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
23105 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
23106
23107 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
23108 transmitted and received data, respectively.
23109
23110 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
23111 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
23112 @cindex remote serial protocol
23113 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
23114 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
23115 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
23116 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
23117
23118 @smallexample
23119 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23120 @end smallexample
23121 @noindent
23122
23123 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
23124 @noindent
23125 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
23126 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
23127 eight bit unsigned checksum).
23128
23129 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
23130 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
23131
23132 @smallexample
23133 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23134 @end smallexample
23135
23136 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
23137 @noindent
23138 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
23139 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
23140 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
23141
23142 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
23143 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
23144 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
23145 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
23146 retransmission):
23147
23148 @smallexample
23149 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23150 <- @code{+}
23151 @end smallexample
23152 @noindent
23153
23154 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
23155 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
23156 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
23157 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
23158
23159 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
23160 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
23161 exceptions).
23162
23163 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
23164 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
23165 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
23166 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
23167
23168 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
23169 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
23170 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
23171
23172 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
23173 @anchor{Binary Data}
23174 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
23175 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
23176 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
23177 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
23178 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
23179 binary data.
23180
23181 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
23182 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
23183 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
23184 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
23185 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
23186 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
23187 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
23188 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
23189 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
23190 (described next).
23191
23192 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
23193 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
23194 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
23195 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
23196 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
23197 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
23198 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
23199 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
23200 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
23201 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
23202 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
23203 3}} more times.
23204
23205 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
23206 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
23207 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
23208 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
23209 @samp{0*"00}.
23210
23211 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
23212 error number. That number is not well defined.
23213
23214 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
23215 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
23216 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
23217 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
23218 on that response.
23219
23220 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
23221 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
23222 optional.
23223
23224 @node Packets
23225 @section Packets
23226
23227 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
23228 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
23229 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
23230 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
23231
23232 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
23233 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
23234 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
23235 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
23236 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
23237 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
23238 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
23239 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
23240 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
23241 @var{baz}.
23242
23243 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
23244 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
23245
23246 Here are the packet descriptions.
23247
23248 @table @samp
23249
23250 @item !
23251 @cindex @samp{!} packet
23252 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
23253 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
23254 debugged.
23255
23256 Reply:
23257 @table @samp
23258 @item OK
23259 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
23260 @end table
23261
23262 @item ?
23263 @cindex @samp{?} packet
23264 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
23265 step and continue.
23266
23267 Reply:
23268 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23269
23270 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
23271 @cindex @samp{A} packet
23272 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
23273 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
23274 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
23275
23276 Reply:
23277 @table @samp
23278 @item OK
23279 The arguments were set.
23280 @item E @var{NN}
23281 An error occurred.
23282 @end table
23283
23284 @item b @var{baud}
23285 @cindex @samp{b} packet
23286 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
23287 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
23288
23289 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
23290 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23291 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23292
23293 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23294 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23295 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23296 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23297 of view, nothing actually happened.}
23298
23299 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23300 @cindex @samp{B} packet
23301 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23302 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23303
23304 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23305 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23306
23307 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23308 @cindex @samp{c} packet
23309 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23310 resume at current address.
23311
23312 Reply:
23313 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23314
23315 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23316 @cindex @samp{C} packet
23317 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23318 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
23319
23320 Reply:
23321 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23322
23323 @item d
23324 @cindex @samp{d} packet
23325 Toggle debug flag.
23326
23327 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23328 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23329
23330 @item D
23331 @cindex @samp{D} packet
23332 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23333 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23334
23335 Reply:
23336 @table @samp
23337 @item OK
23338 for success
23339 @item E @var{NN}
23340 for an error
23341 @end table
23342
23343 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23344 @cindex @samp{F} packet
23345 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23346 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23347 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
23348
23349 @item g
23350 @anchor{read registers packet}
23351 @cindex @samp{g} packet
23352 Read general registers.
23353
23354 Reply:
23355 @table @samp
23356 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23357 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23358 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23359 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23360 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
23361 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
23362 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23363 @item E @var{NN}
23364 for an error.
23365 @end table
23366
23367 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23368 @cindex @samp{G} packet
23369 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23370 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23371
23372 Reply:
23373 @table @samp
23374 @item OK
23375 for success
23376 @item E @var{NN}
23377 for an error
23378 @end table
23379
23380 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
23381 @cindex @samp{H} packet
23382 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23383 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23384 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23385 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23386 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23387
23388 Reply:
23389 @table @samp
23390 @item OK
23391 for success
23392 @item E @var{NN}
23393 for an error
23394 @end table
23395
23396 @c FIXME: JTC:
23397 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23398 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23399 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23400 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23401 @c described. For example:
23402 @c
23403 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23404 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23405 @c otherwise returns current registers.
23406 @c
23407 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23408 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23409 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23410
23411 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23412 @anchor{cycle step packet}
23413 @cindex @samp{i} packet
23414 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23415 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23416 step starting at that address.
23417
23418 @item I
23419 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23420 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23421 step packet}.
23422
23423 @item k
23424 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23425 Kill request.
23426
23427 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23428 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23429 thread?)}.
23430
23431 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23432 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23433 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23434 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23435
23436 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23437 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23438 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23439 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23440 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23441 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23442 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23443 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23444
23445 Reply:
23446 @table @samp
23447 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23448 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23449 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23450 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23451 @item E @var{NN}
23452 @var{NN} is errno
23453 @end table
23454
23455 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23456 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23457 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23458 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23459 hexadecimal number.
23460
23461 Reply:
23462 @table @samp
23463 @item OK
23464 for success
23465 @item E @var{NN}
23466 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23467 written).
23468 @end table
23469
23470 @item p @var{n}
23471 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23472 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23473 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23474 register value is encoded.
23475
23476 Reply:
23477 @table @samp
23478 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23479 the register's value
23480 @item E @var{NN}
23481 for an error
23482 @item
23483 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23484 @end table
23485
23486 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23487 @anchor{write register packet}
23488 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23489 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23490 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23491 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23492
23493 Reply:
23494 @table @samp
23495 @item OK
23496 for success
23497 @item E @var{NN}
23498 for an error
23499 @end table
23500
23501 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23502 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23503 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23504 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23505 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23506 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23507
23508 @item r
23509 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23510 Reset the entire system.
23511
23512 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23513
23514 @item R @var{XX}
23515 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23516 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23517 This packet is only available in extended mode.
23518
23519 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23520
23521 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23522 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23523 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23524 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23525
23526 Reply:
23527 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23528
23529 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23530 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23531 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23532 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23533 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23534
23535 Reply:
23536 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23537
23538 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23539 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23540 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23541 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23542 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23543
23544 @item T @var{XX}
23545 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23546 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23547
23548 Reply:
23549 @table @samp
23550 @item OK
23551 thread is still alive
23552 @item E @var{NN}
23553 thread is dead
23554 @end table
23555
23556 @item v
23557 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23558 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23559
23560 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23561 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23562 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23563 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23564 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23565 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23566 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23567 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23568
23569 @table @samp
23570 @item c
23571 Continue.
23572 @item C @var{sig}
23573 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23574 @item s
23575 Step.
23576 @item S @var{sig}
23577 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23578 @end table
23579
23580 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23581 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23582
23583 Reply:
23584 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23585
23586 @item vCont?
23587 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23588 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23589
23590 Reply:
23591 @table @samp
23592 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23593 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23594 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23595 @item
23596 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23597 @end table
23598
23599 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
23600 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
23601 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
23602 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
23603
23604 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23605 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23606 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23607 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23608 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23609 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
23610 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23611 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23612 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23613 packet is received.
23614
23615 Reply:
23616 @table @samp
23617 @item OK
23618 for success
23619 @item E @var{NN}
23620 for an error
23621 @end table
23622
23623 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23624 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23625 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23626 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23627 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23628 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23629 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23630 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23631 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23632 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23633 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23634 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23635
23636
23637 Reply:
23638 @table @samp
23639 @item OK
23640 for success
23641 @item E.memtype
23642 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23643 @item E @var{NN}
23644 for an error
23645 @end table
23646
23647 @item vFlashDone
23648 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23649 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23650 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23651 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23652 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23653 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23654 request is completed.
23655
23656 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23657 @anchor{X packet}
23658 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23659 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23660 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23661 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23662
23663 Reply:
23664 @table @samp
23665 @item OK
23666 for success
23667 @item E @var{NN}
23668 for an error
23669 @end table
23670
23671 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23672 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23673 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23674 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23675 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23676 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23677 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23678 @var{length} bytes.
23679
23680 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23681 separately.
23682
23683 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23684 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23685 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23686 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23687 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23688 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23689
23690 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23691 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23692 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23693 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23694 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23695 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23696
23697 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23698 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23699 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23700 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23701 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23702
23703 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23704 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23705 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23706 target, is not defined.}
23707
23708 Reply:
23709 @table @samp
23710 @item OK
23711 success
23712 @item
23713 not supported
23714 @item E @var{NN}
23715 for an error
23716 @end table
23717
23718 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23719 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23720 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23721 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23722 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23723 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23724
23725 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23726 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23727
23728 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23729 movement.}
23730
23731 Reply:
23732 @table @samp
23733 @item OK
23734 success
23735 @item
23736 not supported
23737 @item E @var{NN}
23738 for an error
23739 @end table
23740
23741 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23742 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23743 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23744 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23745 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23746
23747 Reply:
23748 @table @samp
23749 @item OK
23750 success
23751 @item
23752 not supported
23753 @item E @var{NN}
23754 for an error
23755 @end table
23756
23757 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23758 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23759 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23760 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23761 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23762
23763 Reply:
23764 @table @samp
23765 @item OK
23766 success
23767 @item
23768 not supported
23769 @item E @var{NN}
23770 for an error
23771 @end table
23772
23773 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23774 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23775 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23776 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23777 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23778
23779 Reply:
23780 @table @samp
23781 @item OK
23782 success
23783 @item
23784 not supported
23785 @item E @var{NN}
23786 for an error
23787 @end table
23788
23789 @end table
23790
23791 @node Stop Reply Packets
23792 @section Stop Reply Packets
23793 @cindex stop reply packets
23794
23795 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23796 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23797 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23798 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23799 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23800 @value{GDBN} source code.
23801
23802 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23803 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23804 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23805 components.
23806
23807 @table @samp
23808
23809 @item S @var{AA}
23810 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23811 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23812 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23813
23814 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23815 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23816 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23817 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23818 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23819 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23820 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23821 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23822
23823 @itemize @bullet
23824 @item
23825 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23826 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23827 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23828 two-digit hex number.
23829
23830 @item
23831 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23832 hex.
23833
23834 @item
23835 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
23836 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
23837 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
23838 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
23839
23840 @item
23841 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23842 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23843 future.
23844 @end itemize
23845
23846 The currently defined stop reasons are:
23847
23848 @table @samp
23849 @item watch
23850 @itemx rwatch
23851 @itemx awatch
23852 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23853 hex.
23854
23855 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
23856 @item library
23857 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
23858 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
23859 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
23860 @end table
23861
23862 @item W @var{AA}
23863 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23864 applicable to certain targets.
23865
23866 @item X @var{AA}
23867 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23868
23869 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23870 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23871 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23872 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23873 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23874
23875 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23876 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23877 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23878 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23879 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
23880 system calls.
23881
23882 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23883 this very system call.
23884
23885 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23886 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23887 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23888 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23889 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
23890 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
23891
23892 @end table
23893
23894 @node General Query Packets
23895 @section General Query Packets
23896 @cindex remote query requests
23897
23898 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23899 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23900 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23901 sending information to and from the stub.
23902
23903 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23904 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23905 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23906 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23907 conventions:
23908
23909 @itemize @bullet
23910 @item
23911 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23912 @item
23913 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23914 letter.
23915 @item
23916 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23917 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23918 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23919 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23920 @end itemize
23921
23922 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23923 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23924 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23925 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23926 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23927 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23928 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23929 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23930 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23931 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23932 packet.}.
23933
23934 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23935 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23936 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23937 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23938 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23939
23940 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23941
23942 @table @samp
23943
23944 @item qC
23945 @cindex current thread, remote request
23946 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23947 Return the current thread id.
23948
23949 Reply:
23950 @table @samp
23951 @item QC @var{pid}
23952 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23953 @item @r{(anything else)}
23954 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23955 @end table
23956
23957 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23958 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23959 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23960 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23961 Reply:
23962 @table @samp
23963 @item E @var{NN}
23964 An error (such as memory fault)
23965 @item C @var{crc32}
23966 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23967 @end table
23968
23969 @item qfThreadInfo
23970 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23971 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23972 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23973 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23974 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23975 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23976 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23977 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23978 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23979 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23980
23981 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23982
23983 Reply:
23984 @table @samp
23985 @item m @var{id}
23986 A single thread id
23987 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23988 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23989 @item l
23990 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23991 @end table
23992
23993 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23994 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23995 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23996 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23997 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23998
23999 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
24000 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
24001 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
24002 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
24003 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
24004
24005 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
24006 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
24007
24008 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
24009 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
24010 information associated with the variable.)
24011
24012 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
24013 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
24014 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
24015 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
24016 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
24017 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
24018
24019 Reply:
24020 @table @samp
24021 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24022 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
24023 local storage requested.
24024
24025 @item E @var{nn}
24026 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24027
24028 @item
24029 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
24030 @end table
24031
24032 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
24033 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
24034 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
24035 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
24036 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
24037 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
24038 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
24039
24040 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
24041
24042 Reply:
24043 @table @samp
24044 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
24045 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
24046 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
24047 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
24048 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
24049 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
24050 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
24051 @end table
24052
24053 @item qOffsets
24054 @cindex section offsets, remote request
24055 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
24056 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
24057 image.
24058
24059 Reply:
24060 @table @samp
24061 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
24062 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
24063 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
24064 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
24065 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
24066 segments by the supplied offsets.
24067
24068 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
24069 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
24070 to the @code{Bss} section.}
24071
24072 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
24073 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
24074 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
24075 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
24076 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
24077 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
24078 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
24079 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
24080 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
24081 @end table
24082
24083 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
24084 @cindex thread information, remote request
24085 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
24086 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
24087 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
24088
24089 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
24090 (see below).
24091
24092 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
24093
24094 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
24095 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
24096 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24097 @anchor{QPassSignals}
24098 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
24099 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
24100 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
24101 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
24102 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
24103 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
24104 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
24105 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
24106 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
24107
24108 Reply:
24109 @table @samp
24110 @item OK
24111 The request succeeded.
24112
24113 @item E @var{nn}
24114 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24115
24116 @item
24117 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
24118 the stub.
24119 @end table
24120
24121 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
24122 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
24123 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24124 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24125
24126 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
24127 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
24128 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
24129 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
24130 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
24131 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
24132 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
24133 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
24134 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
24135
24136 Reply:
24137 @table @samp
24138 @item OK
24139 A command response with no output.
24140 @item @var{OUTPUT}
24141 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
24142 @item E @var{NN}
24143 Indicate a badly formed request.
24144 @item
24145 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
24146 @end table
24147
24148 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
24149 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24150 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24151 packets.)
24152
24153 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
24154 @cindex supported packets, remote query
24155 @cindex features of the remote protocol
24156 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
24157 @anchor{qSupported}
24158 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
24159 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
24160 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
24161 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
24162 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
24163 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
24164 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
24165 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
24166 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
24167 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
24168 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
24169 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
24170 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
24171 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
24172
24173 Reply:
24174 @table @samp
24175 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
24176 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
24177 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
24178 possible forms).
24179 @item
24180 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
24181 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
24182 @end table
24183
24184 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
24185 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
24186 are:
24187
24188 @table @samp
24189 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
24190 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
24191 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
24192 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
24193 @item @var{name}+
24194 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
24195 need an associated value.
24196 @item @var{name}-
24197 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
24198 @item @var{name}?
24199 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
24200 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
24201 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
24202 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
24203 @end table
24204
24205 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
24206 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
24207 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
24208 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
24209 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
24210
24211 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
24212 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
24213 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
24214 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
24215 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
24216 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
24217 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
24218 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
24219 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
24220 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
24221 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
24222 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
24223 all the features it supports.
24224
24225 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
24226 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
24227
24228 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
24229 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
24230 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
24231 form response.
24232
24233 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
24234 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
24235 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
24236 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
24237
24238 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
24239 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
24240 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
24241 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
24242 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
24243
24244 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
24245
24246 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
24247 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
24248 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
24249 @item Feature Name
24250 @tab Value Required
24251 @tab Default
24252 @tab Probe Allowed
24253
24254 @item @samp{PacketSize}
24255 @tab Yes
24256 @tab @samp{-}
24257 @tab No
24258
24259 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
24260 @tab No
24261 @tab @samp{-}
24262 @tab Yes
24263
24264 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
24265 @tab No
24266 @tab @samp{-}
24267 @tab Yes
24268
24269 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
24270 @tab No
24271 @tab @samp{-}
24272 @tab Yes
24273
24274 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
24275 @tab No
24276 @tab @samp{-}
24277 @tab Yes
24278
24279 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
24280 @tab No
24281 @tab @samp{-}
24282 @tab Yes
24283
24284 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
24285 @tab No
24286 @tab @samp{-}
24287 @tab Yes
24288
24289 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
24290 @tab No
24291 @tab @samp{-}
24292 @tab Yes
24293
24294 @end multitable
24295
24296 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
24297
24298 @table @samp
24299 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
24300 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
24301 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
24302 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
24303 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
24304 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
24305 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
24306 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
24307 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
24308 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
24309
24310 @item qXfer:auxv:read
24311 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
24312 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
24313
24314 @item qXfer:features:read
24315 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
24316 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
24317
24318 @item qXfer:libraries:read
24319 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
24320 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
24321
24322 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
24323 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
24324 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
24325
24326 @item qXfer:spu:read
24327 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
24328 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
24329
24330 @item qXfer:spu:write
24331 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
24332 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
24333
24334 @item QPassSignals
24335 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24336 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
24337
24338 @end table
24339
24340 @item qSymbol::
24341 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
24342 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
24343 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
24344 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
24345
24346 Reply:
24347 @table @samp
24348 @item OK
24349 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24350 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24351 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
24352 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
24353 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
24354 below.
24355 @end table
24356
24357 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
24358 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
24359
24360 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
24361 target has previously requested.
24362
24363 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
24364 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
24365 will be empty.
24366
24367 Reply:
24368 @table @samp
24369 @item OK
24370 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24371 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24372 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
24373 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
24374 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
24375 @end table
24376
24377 @item QTDP
24378 @itemx QTFrame
24379 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24380
24381 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
24382 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
24383 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
24384 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
24385 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
24386 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
24387 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
24388 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
24389 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24390 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24391
24392 Reply:
24393 @table @samp
24394 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24395 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24396 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24397 the thread's attributes.
24398 @end table
24399
24400 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24401 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24402 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24403 packets.)
24404
24405 @item QTStart
24406 @itemx QTStop
24407 @itemx QTinit
24408 @itemx QTro
24409 @itemx qTStatus
24410 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24411
24412 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24413 @cindex read special object, remote request
24414 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24415 @anchor{qXfer read}
24416 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24417 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24418 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
24419 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
24420 additional details about what data to access.
24421
24422 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24423 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24424 formats, listed below.
24425
24426 @table @samp
24427 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24428 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
24429 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
24430 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
24431
24432 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24433 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24434
24435 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24436 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
24437 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
24438 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
24439 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
24440
24441 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24442 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24443
24444 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24445 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
24446 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
24447 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24448 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24449
24450 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
24451 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
24452 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
24453
24454 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24455 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24456
24457 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24458 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
24459 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
24460 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24461 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24462
24463 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24464 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24465
24466 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24467 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
24468 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24469 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
24470 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24471 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24472 in that context to be accessed.
24473
24474 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24475 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24476 @end table
24477
24478 Reply:
24479 @table @samp
24480 @item m @var{data}
24481 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
24482 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
24483 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
24484 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
24485 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
24486 request.
24487
24488 @item l @var{data}
24489 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
24490 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
24491 than the @var{length} in the request.
24492
24493 @item l
24494 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
24495 There is no more data to be read.
24496
24497 @item E00
24498 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24499
24500 @item E @var{nn}
24501 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
24502 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24503
24504 @item
24505 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
24506 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
24507 @end table
24508
24509 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24510 @cindex write data into object, remote request
24511 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24512 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24513 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
24514 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24515 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
24516 to access.
24517
24518 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24519 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24520 formats, listed below.
24521
24522 @table @samp
24523 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24524 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
24525 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24526 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
24527 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24528 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24529 in that context to be accessed.
24530
24531 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24532 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24533 @end table
24534
24535 Reply:
24536 @table @samp
24537 @item @var{nn}
24538 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24539 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24540
24541 @item E00
24542 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24543
24544 @item E @var{nn}
24545 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24546 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24547
24548 @item
24549 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24550 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24551 @end table
24552
24553 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24554 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24555 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24556 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24557 must respond with an empty packet.
24558
24559 @end table
24560
24561 @node Register Packet Format
24562 @section Register Packet Format
24563
24564 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24565 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24566 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24567 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24568 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24569 most-significant - least-significant.
24570
24571 @table @r
24572
24573 @item MIPS32
24574
24575 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24576 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24577 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24578
24579 @item MIPS64
24580
24581 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24582 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24583 as @code{MIPS32}.
24584
24585 @end table
24586
24587 @node Tracepoint Packets
24588 @section Tracepoint Packets
24589 @cindex tracepoint packets
24590 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24591
24592 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24593 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24594
24595 @table @samp
24596
24597 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24598 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24599 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24600 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24601 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24602 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24603 tracepoint's actions.
24604
24605 Replies:
24606 @table @samp
24607 @item OK
24608 The packet was understood and carried out.
24609 @item
24610 The packet was not recognized.
24611 @end table
24612
24613 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24614 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24615 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24616 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24617 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24618 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24619 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24620
24621 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24622 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24623 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24624 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24625 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24626 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24627 tracepoint actions.
24628
24629 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24630 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24631 following forms:
24632
24633 @table @samp
24634
24635 @item R @var{mask}
24636 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24637 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24638 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24639 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24640 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24641
24642 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24643 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24644 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24645 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24646 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24647 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24648 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24649
24650 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24651 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24652 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24653 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24654 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24655 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24656 packet).
24657
24658 @end table
24659
24660 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24661 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24662 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24663 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24664 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24665 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24666 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24667 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24668
24669 Replies:
24670 @table @samp
24671 @item OK
24672 The packet was understood and carried out.
24673 @item
24674 The packet was not recognized.
24675 @end table
24676
24677 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24678 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24679 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24680 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24681
24682 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24683 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24684 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24685 one of the following forms:
24686
24687 @table @samp
24688 @item F @var{f}
24689 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24690 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24691 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24692
24693 @item T @var{t}
24694 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24695 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24696
24697 @end table
24698
24699 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24700 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24701 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24702 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24703
24704 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24705 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24706 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24707 is a hexadecimal number.
24708
24709 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24710 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24711 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24712 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24713 numbers.
24714
24715 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24716 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24717 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24718
24719 @item QTStart
24720 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24721 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24722
24723 @item QTStop
24724 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24725
24726 @item QTinit
24727 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24728
24729 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24730 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24731 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24732 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24733
24734 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24735 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24736 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24737 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24738
24739 @item qTStatus
24740 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24741
24742 Replies:
24743 @table @samp
24744 @item T0
24745 There is no trace experiment running.
24746 @item T1
24747 There is a trace experiment running.
24748 @end table
24749
24750 @end table
24751
24752
24753 @node Host I/O Packets
24754 @section Host I/O Packets
24755 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
24756 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
24757
24758 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
24759 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
24760 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
24761 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
24762 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
24763 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
24764 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
24765 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
24766 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
24767 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
24768
24769 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
24770 its arguments. They have this format:
24771
24772 @table @samp
24773
24774 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
24775 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
24776 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
24777 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
24778 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
24779 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
24780 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
24781 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
24782 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
24783
24784 @end table
24785
24786 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
24787
24788 @table @samp
24789
24790 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
24791 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
24792 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
24793 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
24794 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
24795 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
24796 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
24797 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
24798 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
24799 @var{attachment}.
24800
24801 @item
24802 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
24803
24804 @end table
24805
24806 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
24807
24808 @table @samp
24809 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
24810 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
24811 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
24812 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
24813 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
24814 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
24815 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
24816
24817 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
24818 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
24819 -1 if an error occurs.
24820
24821 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
24822 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
24823 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
24824 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
24825 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
24826 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
24827 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
24828 @var{count} was zero.
24829
24830 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
24831 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
24832 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
24833 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
24834 some characters were escaped.
24835
24836 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
24837 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
24838 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
24839 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
24840 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
24841 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
24842 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
24843 error occurred.
24844
24845 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
24846 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
24847 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
24848
24849 @end table
24850
24851 @node Interrupts
24852 @section Interrupts
24853 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24854
24855 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24856 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24857 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24858 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24859
24860 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24861 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24862 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24863 interfaces.
24864
24865 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24866 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24867 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24868 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24869 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24870 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24871 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24872 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24873
24874 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24875 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24876 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24877 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24878 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24879 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24880 program is stopped will be discarded.
24881
24882 @node Examples
24883 @section Examples
24884
24885 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24886 does not get any direct output:
24887
24888 @smallexample
24889 -> @code{R00}
24890 <- @code{+}
24891 @emph{target restarts}
24892 -> @code{?}
24893 <- @code{+}
24894 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24895 -> @code{+}
24896 @end smallexample
24897
24898 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24899
24900 @smallexample
24901 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24902 <- @code{+}
24903 -> @code{s}
24904 <- @code{+}
24905 @emph{time passes}
24906 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24907 -> @code{+}
24908 -> @code{g}
24909 <- @code{+}
24910 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24911 -> @code{+}
24912 @end smallexample
24913
24914 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24915 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24916 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24917
24918 @menu
24919 * File-I/O Overview::
24920 * Protocol Basics::
24921 * The F Request Packet::
24922 * The F Reply Packet::
24923 * The Ctrl-C Message::
24924 * Console I/O::
24925 * List of Supported Calls::
24926 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
24927 * Constants::
24928 * File-I/O Examples::
24929 @end menu
24930
24931 @node File-I/O Overview
24932 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24933 @cindex file-i/o overview
24934
24935 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24936 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24937 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24938 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24939 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24940 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24941
24942 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24943 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24944 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24945 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24946 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24947
24948 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24949 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24950 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24951 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24952 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24953 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24954 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24955
24956 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24957 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24958 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24959 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24960 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24961
24962 @smallexample
24963 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24964 <- target requests 'system call X'
24965 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24966 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
24967 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
24968 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24969 @end smallexample
24970
24971 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24972 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24973 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24974 system are not supported by this protocol.
24975
24976 @node Protocol Basics
24977 @subsection Protocol Basics
24978 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24979
24980 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24981 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24982 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24983 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24984 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24985 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24986 to call the appropriate host system call:
24987
24988 @itemize @bullet
24989 @item
24990 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24991
24992 @item
24993 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24994 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24995 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24996 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
24997
24998 @end itemize
24999
25000 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
25001
25002 @itemize @bullet
25003 @item
25004 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
25005 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
25006 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
25007 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
25008 packet.
25009
25010 @item
25011 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
25012 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
25013
25014 @item
25015 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
25016
25017 @item
25018 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
25019
25020 @item
25021 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
25022 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
25023 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
25024 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
25025 packet.
25026
25027 @end itemize
25028
25029 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
25030 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
25031
25032 @itemize @bullet
25033 @item
25034 Return value.
25035
25036 @item
25037 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
25038
25039 @item
25040 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
25041
25042 @end itemize
25043
25044 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
25045 the latest continue or step action.
25046
25047 @node The F Request Packet
25048 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
25049 @cindex file-i/o request packet
25050 @cindex @code{F} request packet
25051
25052 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
25053
25054 @table @samp
25055 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
25056
25057 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
25058 This is just the name of the function.
25059
25060 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
25061 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
25062 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
25063 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
25064 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
25065 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
25066 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
25067
25068 @end table
25069
25070
25071
25072 @node The F Reply Packet
25073 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
25074 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
25075 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
25076
25077 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
25078
25079 @table @samp
25080
25081 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
25082
25083 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
25084
25085 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
25086 representation.
25087 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
25088
25089 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
25090 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
25091 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
25092
25093 @smallexample
25094 F0,0,C
25095 @end smallexample
25096
25097 @noindent
25098 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
25099
25100 @smallexample
25101 F-1,4,C
25102 @end smallexample
25103
25104 @noindent
25105 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
25106
25107 @end table
25108
25109
25110 @node The Ctrl-C Message
25111 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
25112 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
25113
25114 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
25115 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
25116 the target should behave as if it had
25117 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
25118 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
25119 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
25120 packet.
25121
25122 It's important for the target to know in which
25123 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
25124
25125 @itemize @bullet
25126 @item
25127 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
25128
25129 @item
25130 The system call on the host has been finished.
25131
25132 @end itemize
25133
25134 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
25135 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
25136 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
25137 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
25138 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
25139 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
25140
25141 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
25142 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
25143 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
25144 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
25145 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
25146 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
25147 or the full action has been completed.
25148
25149 @node Console I/O
25150 @subsection Console I/O
25151 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
25152
25153 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
25154 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
25155 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
25156 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
25157 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
25158 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
25159 conditions is met:
25160
25161 @itemize @bullet
25162 @item
25163 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
25164 @code{read}
25165 system call is treated as finished.
25166
25167 @item
25168 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
25169 newline.
25170
25171 @item
25172 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
25173 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
25174
25175 @end itemize
25176
25177 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
25178 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
25179 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
25180 is stopped at the user's request.
25181
25182
25183 @node List of Supported Calls
25184 @subsection List of Supported Calls
25185 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
25186
25187 @menu
25188 * open::
25189 * close::
25190 * read::
25191 * write::
25192 * lseek::
25193 * rename::
25194 * unlink::
25195 * stat/fstat::
25196 * gettimeofday::
25197 * isatty::
25198 * system::
25199 @end menu
25200
25201 @node open
25202 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
25203 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
25204
25205 @table @asis
25206 @item Synopsis:
25207 @smallexample
25208 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
25209 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
25210 @end smallexample
25211
25212 @item Request:
25213 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
25214
25215 @noindent
25216 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25217
25218 @table @code
25219 @item O_CREAT
25220 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
25221 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
25222 are concerned.
25223
25224 @item O_EXCL
25225 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
25226 an error and open() fails.
25227
25228 @item O_TRUNC
25229 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
25230 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
25231 truncated to zero length.
25232
25233 @item O_APPEND
25234 The file is opened in append mode.
25235
25236 @item O_RDONLY
25237 The file is opened for reading only.
25238
25239 @item O_WRONLY
25240 The file is opened for writing only.
25241
25242 @item O_RDWR
25243 The file is opened for reading and writing.
25244 @end table
25245
25246 @noindent
25247 Other bits are silently ignored.
25248
25249
25250 @noindent
25251 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25252
25253 @table @code
25254 @item S_IRUSR
25255 User has read permission.
25256
25257 @item S_IWUSR
25258 User has write permission.
25259
25260 @item S_IRGRP
25261 Group has read permission.
25262
25263 @item S_IWGRP
25264 Group has write permission.
25265
25266 @item S_IROTH
25267 Others have read permission.
25268
25269 @item S_IWOTH
25270 Others have write permission.
25271 @end table
25272
25273 @noindent
25274 Other bits are silently ignored.
25275
25276
25277 @item Return value:
25278 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
25279 occurred.
25280
25281 @item Errors:
25282
25283 @table @code
25284 @item EEXIST
25285 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
25286
25287 @item EISDIR
25288 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
25289
25290 @item EACCES
25291 The requested access is not allowed.
25292
25293 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25294 @var{pathname} was too long.
25295
25296 @item ENOENT
25297 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25298
25299 @item ENODEV
25300 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
25301
25302 @item EROFS
25303 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
25304 write access was requested.
25305
25306 @item EFAULT
25307 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
25308
25309 @item ENOSPC
25310 No space on device to create the file.
25311
25312 @item EMFILE
25313 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
25314
25315 @item ENFILE
25316 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
25317 has been reached.
25318
25319 @item EINTR
25320 The call was interrupted by the user.
25321 @end table
25322
25323 @end table
25324
25325 @node close
25326 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
25327 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
25328
25329 @table @asis
25330 @item Synopsis:
25331 @smallexample
25332 int close(int fd);
25333 @end smallexample
25334
25335 @item Request:
25336 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
25337
25338 @item Return value:
25339 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
25340
25341 @item Errors:
25342
25343 @table @code
25344 @item EBADF
25345 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
25346
25347 @item EINTR
25348 The call was interrupted by the user.
25349 @end table
25350
25351 @end table
25352
25353 @node read
25354 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
25355 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
25356
25357 @table @asis
25358 @item Synopsis:
25359 @smallexample
25360 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
25361 @end smallexample
25362
25363 @item Request:
25364 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25365
25366 @item Return value:
25367 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
25368 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
25369 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
25370
25371 @item Errors:
25372
25373 @table @code
25374 @item EBADF
25375 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25376 reading.
25377
25378 @item EFAULT
25379 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25380
25381 @item EINTR
25382 The call was interrupted by the user.
25383 @end table
25384
25385 @end table
25386
25387 @node write
25388 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
25389 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
25390
25391 @table @asis
25392 @item Synopsis:
25393 @smallexample
25394 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
25395 @end smallexample
25396
25397 @item Request:
25398 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25399
25400 @item Return value:
25401 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
25402 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
25403 is returned.
25404
25405 @item Errors:
25406
25407 @table @code
25408 @item EBADF
25409 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25410 writing.
25411
25412 @item EFAULT
25413 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25414
25415 @item EFBIG
25416 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
25417 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
25418
25419 @item ENOSPC
25420 No space on device to write the data.
25421
25422 @item EINTR
25423 The call was interrupted by the user.
25424 @end table
25425
25426 @end table
25427
25428 @node lseek
25429 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
25430 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
25431
25432 @table @asis
25433 @item Synopsis:
25434 @smallexample
25435 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
25436 @end smallexample
25437
25438 @item Request:
25439 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
25440
25441 @var{flag} is one of:
25442
25443 @table @code
25444 @item SEEK_SET
25445 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
25446
25447 @item SEEK_CUR
25448 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
25449 bytes.
25450
25451 @item SEEK_END
25452 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
25453 bytes.
25454 @end table
25455
25456 @item Return value:
25457 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
25458 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
25459 value of -1 is returned.
25460
25461 @item Errors:
25462
25463 @table @code
25464 @item EBADF
25465 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
25466
25467 @item ESPIPE
25468 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
25469
25470 @item EINVAL
25471 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
25472
25473 @item EINTR
25474 The call was interrupted by the user.
25475 @end table
25476
25477 @end table
25478
25479 @node rename
25480 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
25481 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
25482
25483 @table @asis
25484 @item Synopsis:
25485 @smallexample
25486 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
25487 @end smallexample
25488
25489 @item Request:
25490 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
25491
25492 @item Return value:
25493 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25494
25495 @item Errors:
25496
25497 @table @code
25498 @item EISDIR
25499 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
25500 directory.
25501
25502 @item EEXIST
25503 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
25504
25505 @item EBUSY
25506 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
25507 process.
25508
25509 @item EINVAL
25510 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
25511 of itself.
25512
25513 @item ENOTDIR
25514 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
25515 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
25516 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
25517
25518 @item EFAULT
25519 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
25520
25521 @item EACCES
25522 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25523
25524 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25525
25526 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
25527
25528 @item ENOENT
25529 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
25530
25531 @item EROFS
25532 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25533
25534 @item ENOSPC
25535 The device containing the file has no room for the new
25536 directory entry.
25537
25538 @item EINTR
25539 The call was interrupted by the user.
25540 @end table
25541
25542 @end table
25543
25544 @node unlink
25545 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
25546 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
25547
25548 @table @asis
25549 @item Synopsis:
25550 @smallexample
25551 int unlink(const char *pathname);
25552 @end smallexample
25553
25554 @item Request:
25555 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
25556
25557 @item Return value:
25558 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25559
25560 @item Errors:
25561
25562 @table @code
25563 @item EACCES
25564 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25565
25566 @item EPERM
25567 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
25568
25569 @item EBUSY
25570 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
25571 being used by another process.
25572
25573 @item EFAULT
25574 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25575
25576 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25577 @var{pathname} was too long.
25578
25579 @item ENOENT
25580 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25581
25582 @item ENOTDIR
25583 A component of the path is not a directory.
25584
25585 @item EROFS
25586 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25587
25588 @item EINTR
25589 The call was interrupted by the user.
25590 @end table
25591
25592 @end table
25593
25594 @node stat/fstat
25595 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
25596 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
25597 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
25598
25599 @table @asis
25600 @item Synopsis:
25601 @smallexample
25602 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
25603 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
25604 @end smallexample
25605
25606 @item Request:
25607 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
25608 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
25609
25610 @item Return value:
25611 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25612
25613 @item Errors:
25614
25615 @table @code
25616 @item EBADF
25617 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
25618
25619 @item ENOENT
25620 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
25621 path is an empty string.
25622
25623 @item ENOTDIR
25624 A component of the path is not a directory.
25625
25626 @item EFAULT
25627 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25628
25629 @item EACCES
25630 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25631
25632 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25633 @var{pathname} was too long.
25634
25635 @item EINTR
25636 The call was interrupted by the user.
25637 @end table
25638
25639 @end table
25640
25641 @node gettimeofday
25642 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
25643 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
25644
25645 @table @asis
25646 @item Synopsis:
25647 @smallexample
25648 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
25649 @end smallexample
25650
25651 @item Request:
25652 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25653
25654 @item Return value:
25655 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25656
25657 @item Errors:
25658
25659 @table @code
25660 @item EINVAL
25661 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25662
25663 @item EFAULT
25664 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25665 @end table
25666
25667 @end table
25668
25669 @node isatty
25670 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25671 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25672
25673 @table @asis
25674 @item Synopsis:
25675 @smallexample
25676 int isatty(int fd);
25677 @end smallexample
25678
25679 @item Request:
25680 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25681
25682 @item Return value:
25683 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25684
25685 @item Errors:
25686
25687 @table @code
25688 @item EINTR
25689 The call was interrupted by the user.
25690 @end table
25691
25692 @end table
25693
25694 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25695 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25696 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25697 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25698 needed.
25699
25700
25701 @node system
25702 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25703 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25704
25705 @table @asis
25706 @item Synopsis:
25707 @smallexample
25708 int system(const char *command);
25709 @end smallexample
25710
25711 @item Request:
25712 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25713
25714 @item Return value:
25715 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25716 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25717 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25718 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25719 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25720 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25721 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25722
25723 @item Errors:
25724
25725 @table @code
25726 @item EINTR
25727 The call was interrupted by the user.
25728 @end table
25729
25730 @end table
25731
25732 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25733 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25734 the host is simplified before it's returned
25735 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25736 is discarded, and the return value consists
25737 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25738
25739 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25740 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25741 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25742
25743 @table @code
25744 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25745 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25746 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25747 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25748
25749 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25750 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25751 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25752 protocol.
25753 @end table
25754
25755 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25756 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25757 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25758
25759 @menu
25760 * Integral Datatypes::
25761 * Pointer Values::
25762 * Memory Transfer::
25763 * struct stat::
25764 * struct timeval::
25765 @end menu
25766
25767 @node Integral Datatypes
25768 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
25769 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25770
25771 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25772 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25773 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25774
25775 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25776 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25777
25778 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25779
25780 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25781 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25782
25783 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25784
25785 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25786 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25787 byte order.
25788
25789 @node Pointer Values
25790 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
25791 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25792
25793 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25794 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25795 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25796 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25797
25798 @smallexample
25799 @code{1aaf/12}
25800 @end smallexample
25801
25802 @noindent
25803 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25804 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25805 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25806 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25807
25808 @smallexample
25809 @code{123456/d}
25810 @end smallexample
25811
25812 @node Memory Transfer
25813 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
25814 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25815
25816 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25817 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
25818 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25819 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25820 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25821 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25822 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25823
25824
25825 @node struct stat
25826 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25827 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25828
25829 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25830 is defined as follows:
25831
25832 @smallexample
25833 struct stat @{
25834 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25835 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25836 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25837 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25838 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25839 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25840 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25841 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25842 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25843 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25844 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25845 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25846 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25847 @};
25848 @end smallexample
25849
25850 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25851 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25852 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25853
25854 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25855 range of values.
25856
25857 @table @code
25858
25859 @item st_dev
25860 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25861
25862 @item st_ino
25863 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25864
25865 @item st_mode
25866 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25867 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25868
25869 @item st_uid
25870 @itemx st_gid
25871 @itemx st_rdev
25872 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25873
25874 @item st_atime
25875 @itemx st_mtime
25876 @itemx st_ctime
25877 These values have a host and file system dependent
25878 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25879 support exact timing values.
25880 @end table
25881
25882 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25883 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25884 continuing.
25885
25886 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25887 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25888 get truncated on the target.
25889
25890 @node struct timeval
25891 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25892 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25893
25894 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25895 is defined as follows:
25896
25897 @smallexample
25898 struct timeval @{
25899 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25900 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25901 @};
25902 @end smallexample
25903
25904 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25905 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25906 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25907
25908 @node Constants
25909 @subsection Constants
25910 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25911
25912 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25913 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25914 values before and after the call as needed.
25915
25916 @menu
25917 * Open Flags::
25918 * mode_t Values::
25919 * Errno Values::
25920 * Lseek Flags::
25921 * Limits::
25922 @end menu
25923
25924 @node Open Flags
25925 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
25926 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25927
25928 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25929
25930 @smallexample
25931 O_RDONLY 0x0
25932 O_WRONLY 0x1
25933 O_RDWR 0x2
25934 O_APPEND 0x8
25935 O_CREAT 0x200
25936 O_TRUNC 0x400
25937 O_EXCL 0x800
25938 @end smallexample
25939
25940 @node mode_t Values
25941 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
25942 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25943
25944 All values are given in octal representation.
25945
25946 @smallexample
25947 S_IFREG 0100000
25948 S_IFDIR 040000
25949 S_IRUSR 0400
25950 S_IWUSR 0200
25951 S_IXUSR 0100
25952 S_IRGRP 040
25953 S_IWGRP 020
25954 S_IXGRP 010
25955 S_IROTH 04
25956 S_IWOTH 02
25957 S_IXOTH 01
25958 @end smallexample
25959
25960 @node Errno Values
25961 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
25962 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25963
25964 All values are given in decimal representation.
25965
25966 @smallexample
25967 EPERM 1
25968 ENOENT 2
25969 EINTR 4
25970 EBADF 9
25971 EACCES 13
25972 EFAULT 14
25973 EBUSY 16
25974 EEXIST 17
25975 ENODEV 19
25976 ENOTDIR 20
25977 EISDIR 21
25978 EINVAL 22
25979 ENFILE 23
25980 EMFILE 24
25981 EFBIG 27
25982 ENOSPC 28
25983 ESPIPE 29
25984 EROFS 30
25985 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25986 EUNKNOWN 9999
25987 @end smallexample
25988
25989 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25990 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25991
25992 @node Lseek Flags
25993 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
25994 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25995
25996 @smallexample
25997 SEEK_SET 0
25998 SEEK_CUR 1
25999 SEEK_END 2
26000 @end smallexample
26001
26002 @node Limits
26003 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
26004 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
26005
26006 All values are given in decimal representation.
26007
26008 @smallexample
26009 INT_MIN -2147483648
26010 INT_MAX 2147483647
26011 UINT_MAX 4294967295
26012 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
26013 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
26014 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
26015 @end smallexample
26016
26017 @node File-I/O Examples
26018 @subsection File-I/O Examples
26019 @cindex file-i/o examples
26020
26021 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26022 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
26023
26024 @smallexample
26025 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
26026 @emph{request memory read from target}
26027 -> @code{m1234,6}
26028 <- XXXXXX
26029 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
26030 -> @code{F6}
26031 @end smallexample
26032
26033 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26034 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
26035
26036 @smallexample
26037 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26038 @emph{request memory write to target}
26039 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26040 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
26041 -> @code{F6}
26042 @end smallexample
26043
26044 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
26045 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
26046
26047 @smallexample
26048 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26049 -> @code{F-1,9}
26050 @end smallexample
26051
26052 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
26053 host is called:
26054
26055 @smallexample
26056 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26057 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
26058 <- @code{T02}
26059 @end smallexample
26060
26061 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
26062 host is called:
26063
26064 @smallexample
26065 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26066 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26067 <- @code{T02}
26068 @end smallexample
26069
26070 @node Library List Format
26071 @section Library List Format
26072 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
26073
26074 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
26075 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
26076 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
26077 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
26078 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
26079 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
26080 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26081 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
26082 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
26083 are loaded.
26084
26085 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
26086 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
26087 associated name and one or more segment base addresses, which report
26088 where the library was loaded in memory. The segment bases are start
26089 addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not depend on the library's
26090 link-time base addresses.
26091
26092 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26093 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
26094
26095 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
26096 offset, looks like this:
26097
26098 @smallexample
26099 <library-list>
26100 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
26101 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
26102 </library>
26103 </library-list>
26104 @end smallexample
26105
26106 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
26107
26108 @smallexample
26109 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
26110 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
26111 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
26112 <!ELEMENT library (segment)*>
26113 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26114 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
26115 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26116 @end smallexample
26117
26118 @node Memory Map Format
26119 @section Memory Map Format
26120 @cindex memory map format
26121
26122 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
26123 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
26124 memory map.
26125
26126 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
26127 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
26128 lists memory regions.
26129
26130 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26131 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
26132
26133 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
26134
26135 @smallexample
26136 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26137 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
26138 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
26139 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
26140 <memory-map>
26141 region...
26142 </memory-map>
26143 @end smallexample
26144
26145 Each region can be either:
26146
26147 @itemize
26148
26149 @item
26150 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
26151 bytes from there:
26152
26153 @smallexample
26154 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26155 @end smallexample
26156
26157
26158 @item
26159 A region of read-only memory:
26160
26161 @smallexample
26162 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26163 @end smallexample
26164
26165
26166 @item
26167 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
26168 bytes in length:
26169
26170 @smallexample
26171 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
26172 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
26173 </memory>
26174 @end smallexample
26175
26176 @end itemize
26177
26178 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
26179 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
26180 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
26181
26182 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
26183
26184 @smallexample
26185 <!-- ................................................... -->
26186 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
26187 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
26188 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
26189 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
26190 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
26191 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
26192 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
26193 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
26194 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
26195 and its type, or device. -->
26196 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
26197 start CDATA #REQUIRED
26198 length CDATA #REQUIRED
26199 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
26200 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
26201 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
26202 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26203 @end smallexample
26204
26205 @include agentexpr.texi
26206
26207 @node Target Descriptions
26208 @appendix Target Descriptions
26209 @cindex target descriptions
26210
26211 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
26212 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
26213 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
26214
26215 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
26216 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
26217 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
26218 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
26219 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
26220 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
26221 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
26222
26223 @itemize @bullet
26224 @item
26225 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
26226 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
26227 @item
26228 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
26229 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
26230 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
26231 @item
26232 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
26233 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
26234 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
26235 @end itemize
26236
26237 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
26238 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
26239 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
26240 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
26241 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
26242
26243 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26244 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
26245
26246 @menu
26247 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
26248 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
26249 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
26250 descriptions.
26251 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
26252 @end menu
26253
26254 @node Retrieving Descriptions
26255 @section Retrieving Descriptions
26256
26257 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
26258 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
26259 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
26260 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
26261 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
26262 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
26263 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
26264 Format}.
26265
26266 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
26267 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
26268 specify a file are:
26269
26270 @table @code
26271 @cindex set tdesc filename
26272 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
26273 Read the target description from @var{path}.
26274
26275 @cindex unset tdesc filename
26276 @item unset tdesc filename
26277 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
26278 will use the description supplied by the current target.
26279
26280 @cindex show tdesc filename
26281 @item show tdesc filename
26282 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
26283 @end table
26284
26285
26286 @node Target Description Format
26287 @section Target Description Format
26288 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
26289
26290 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
26291 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
26292 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
26293 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
26294 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
26295 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
26296 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
26297
26298 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
26299 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
26300 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
26301 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
26302
26303 Here is a simple target description:
26304
26305 @smallexample
26306 <target version="1.0">
26307 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
26308 </target>
26309 @end smallexample
26310
26311 @noindent
26312 This minimal description only says that the target uses
26313 the x86-64 architecture.
26314
26315 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
26316 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
26317 are explained further below.
26318
26319 @smallexample
26320 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26321 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
26322 <target version="1.0">
26323 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
26324 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
26325 </target>
26326 @end smallexample
26327
26328 @noindent
26329 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
26330 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
26331 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
26332 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
26333 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
26334 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
26335 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
26336 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
26337 the version mismatch.
26338
26339 @subsection Inclusion
26340 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
26341 @cindex XInclude
26342 @ifnotinfo
26343 @cindex <xi:include>
26344 @end ifnotinfo
26345
26346 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
26347 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
26348 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
26349 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
26350 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
26351
26352 @smallexample
26353 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
26354 @end smallexample
26355
26356 @noindent
26357 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
26358 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
26359 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
26360 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
26361 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
26362 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
26363 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
26364 original description.
26365
26366 @subsection Architecture
26367 @cindex <architecture>
26368
26369 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
26370
26371 @smallexample
26372 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
26373 @end smallexample
26374
26375 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
26376 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
26377 Debugging Target}).
26378
26379 @subsection Features
26380 @cindex <feature>
26381
26382 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
26383 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
26384 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
26385 has this form:
26386
26387 @smallexample
26388 <feature name="@var{name}">
26389 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
26390 @var{reg}@dots{}
26391 </feature>
26392 @end smallexample
26393
26394 @noindent
26395 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
26396 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
26397 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
26398 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
26399
26400 @subsection Types
26401
26402 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
26403 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
26404 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
26405 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
26406 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
26407
26408 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
26409 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
26410 Types must be defined before they are used.
26411
26412 @cindex <vector>
26413 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
26414 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
26415 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
26416 @var{count}:
26417
26418 @smallexample
26419 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
26420 @end smallexample
26421
26422 @cindex <union>
26423 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
26424 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
26425 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
26426 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
26427
26428 @smallexample
26429 <union id="@var{id}">
26430 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
26431 @dots{}
26432 </union>
26433 @end smallexample
26434
26435 @subsection Registers
26436 @cindex <reg>
26437
26438 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
26439
26440 @smallexample
26441 <reg name="@var{name}"
26442 bitsize="@var{size}"
26443 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
26444 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
26445 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
26446 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
26447 @end smallexample
26448
26449 @noindent
26450 The components are as follows:
26451
26452 @table @var
26453
26454 @item name
26455 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
26456
26457 @item bitsize
26458 The register's size, in bits.
26459
26460 @item regnum
26461 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
26462 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
26463 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
26464 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
26465 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
26466 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
26467 in order of increasing register number.
26468
26469 @item save-restore
26470 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
26471 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
26472 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
26473 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
26474 ABI.
26475
26476 @item type
26477 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
26478 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
26479 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
26480 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
26481 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
26482 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
26483
26484 @item group
26485 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
26486 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
26487 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
26488 in @code{info registers}.
26489
26490 @end table
26491
26492 @node Predefined Target Types
26493 @section Predefined Target Types
26494 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
26495
26496 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
26497 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
26498 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
26499 types. The currently supported types are:
26500
26501 @table @code
26502
26503 @item int8
26504 @itemx int16
26505 @itemx int32
26506 @itemx int64
26507 @itemx int128
26508 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26509
26510 @item uint8
26511 @itemx uint16
26512 @itemx uint32
26513 @itemx uint64
26514 @itemx uint128
26515 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26516
26517 @item code_ptr
26518 @itemx data_ptr
26519 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
26520 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
26521 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
26522 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
26523 may be marked as data pointers.
26524
26525 @item ieee_single
26526 Single precision IEEE floating point.
26527
26528 @item ieee_double
26529 Double precision IEEE floating point.
26530
26531 @item arm_fpa_ext
26532 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
26533
26534 @end table
26535
26536 @node Standard Target Features
26537 @section Standard Target Features
26538 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
26539
26540 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
26541 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
26542 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
26543 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
26544 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
26545 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
26546 can recognize them.
26547
26548 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
26549 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
26550 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
26551 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
26552 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
26553 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
26554 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
26555 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
26556
26557 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
26558 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
26559 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
26560
26561 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
26562 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
26563 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
26564 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
26565
26566 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
26567 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
26568 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
26569
26570 @menu
26571 * ARM Features::
26572 * M68K Features::
26573 @end menu
26574
26575
26576 @node ARM Features
26577 @subsection ARM Features
26578 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
26579
26580 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
26581 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
26582 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
26583
26584 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
26585 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
26586
26587 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
26588 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
26589 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
26590 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
26591
26592 @subsection MIPS Features
26593 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
26594
26595 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
26596 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
26597 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
26598 on the target.
26599
26600 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
26601 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
26602 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26603
26604 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
26605 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
26606 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
26607 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26608
26609 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
26610 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
26611 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
26612
26613 @node M68K Features
26614 @subsection M68K Features
26615 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
26616
26617 @table @code
26618 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
26619 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
26620 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
26621 One of those features must be always present.
26622 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
26623 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
26624 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
26625 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
26626
26627 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
26628 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
26629 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
26630 @samp{fpiaddr}.
26631 @end table
26632
26633 @subsection PowerPC Features
26634 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
26635
26636 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
26637 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
26638 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
26639 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26640
26641 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
26642 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
26643
26644 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
26645 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
26646 and @samp{vrsave}.
26647
26648 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
26649 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
26650 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
26651 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
26652 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
26653 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
26654 user.
26655
26656 @include gpl.texi
26657
26658 @raisesections
26659 @include fdl.texi
26660 @lowersections
26661
26662 @node Index
26663 @unnumbered Index
26664
26665 @printindex cp
26666
26667 @tex
26668 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
26669 % meantime:
26670 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
26671 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
26672 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
26673 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
26674 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
26675 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
26676 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
26677 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
26678 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
26679 \page\colophon
26680 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
26681 @end tex
26682
26683 @bye
This page took 0.551915 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.